72066
72066
72066
Sensors Sensors
Control Control
Motors Motors
Our in-depth knowledge of your business combined with our unrivalled expertise ensure that you benefit from an innovative range of customised products.
www.crouzet.com
Control Contents
Crouzet, the Control specialist ..............................................................................................04 How to order ............................................................................................................................06 The Crouzet offer ....................................................................................................................07
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
Temperature controllers................................................................................................
Micro-PLCs ..................................................................................................................
www.crouzet.com
An acknowledged specialist
With 30 years experience and extensive technical and industrial expertise, Crouzet is a key player in the Control market. Already world leader in time management functions and management of physical values, Crouzet is determined to keep forging ahead. It is not by chance that we have won the confidence of many manufacturing companies. Confidence which Crouzets workforce strive to maintain and develop on a daily basis.
A technological advance
From pure Research and Development to simply improving a standard product, our policy of constant re-evaluation means that we can offer customised products without ever ceasing to innovate: the Millenium II+ logic controller is a perfect illustration of this approach.
A brand which
To order
www.crouzet.com
See back page for details of your local Crouzet office
Standard products
Give the reference in white.
Warning:
The technical information in this catalogue is given for information only and does not constitute a contractual obligation. CROUZET Automatismes and its subsidiaries reserve the right to make any modifications without notice. It is essential to contact us for any special use/application of our products, and it is the responsibility of the purchaser to check, in particular using all appropriate tests, that the product used is suitable for the application. Our guarantee may under no circumstances be invoked, nor our responsibility sought for any application of our products such as, amongst others, modification, addition, use in combination with other electrical or electronic components, circuits or mounting systems, or any other inappropriate equipment or substance which has not been expressly approved by us prior to the finalisation of the sale.
Motors
DC motors, brushless motors, Linear motors, Synchronous motors, Stepper motors, Asynchronous motors, Fans
Sensors
Limit switches, Microswitches, Inductive proximity sensors, Capacitive proximity sensors, Photoelectric sensors, Readout modules
Pneumatic
Electro-pneumatic miniature control valves, Intrinsically safe miniature solenoid valves, Multi-fluid solenoid valves, Position detectors, Man / Machine Interface components, Pressure switches and amplifiers, Pneumatic logic components, Vacuum handling components
Senior products
www.crouzet.com/OLC
To meet your maintenance requirements, the senior products site contains a selection of products which no longer appear in this catalogue. To assist your search, this webspace will help you find the technical and price characteristics to enable you to procure these products. And of course, your Crouzet contact is always on hand to help fill in the information required, or to suggest the optimum replacement solution.
www.crouzet.com
Selection guide
Inputs Outputs Voltage 12 VDC LCD display With Without With Without With Without With Without With Without With Without With Without Type SA 12 EC 12 SA 12 EC 12 SA 12 EC 12 SA 12 EC 12 SA 12 EC 12 SA 12 EC 12 SA 12 EC 12 SA 20 XT 20 EC 20 SA 20 XT 20 EC 20 EX 20 SA 20 XT 20 EC 20 EX 20 SA 20 XT 20 EC 20 EX 20 SA 20 XT 20 EC 20 SA 20 XT 20 EC 20 EX 20 SA 20 XT 20 EC 20 EX 20
24 VAC
12 VDC
24 VDC
1
8 NPN
(2 analogue)
4 relays 8A
24 VDC
12 VDC
EC 12 series
With
12 PNP
(8 analogue)
230 VAC
Without
Without
With 12 NPN
(4 analogue)
8 relays 8A
24 VDC Without
Power supplies
230 VAC / 12 VDC 230 VAC / 24 VDC 22 W 30 W 1.9 A 1.3 A Page 22 Page 22
10
Adjacent extensions
Inputs Outputs Voltage 12 VDC 4 PNP 2 relays 8A 24 VDC 100 to 240 VAC 24 VAC 4 NPN 2 relays 8 A 24 VDC AS-i exchange unit 24 VDC MODBUS exchange unit 24 VDC XC 01 XC 02 XC 03 Page 20 Page 21 XC 01 Page 20 Type
XC 01
XC 02 Page 21 XC 03
Local extensions
M2-M2 local link (2 modules) 4 Digital/PWM solid state outputs 0.7 A 2 relay outputs XL 01 XL 05 XL 06 Page 20 Page 20 Page 20 XL 01 / XL 05
Starter kit
Inputs 8 PNP Outputs 4 relays Voltage 24 VDC 100 to 240 VDC LCD display With Type KIT SA 12 Page 14
Each kit consists of: - a standard or expandable Millenium II (24 VDC or 100 to 240 VAC versions) - a PC/Millenium II programming cable - an interactive CD ROM including the software workshop, the tutorial, the application library and technical brochures.
Each kit consists of: 1 SA12 + programming software + programming cable + level sensor adaptor + 4 level sensors S7 Type Temperature control KIT Designation Heating, cooling and air conditioning Page 14
Each kit consists of: 1 SA12 + programming software + programming cable + PS24 power supply + temperature sensor + solid state relay with heatsink
Accessories
Programming cable USB MODEM KIT STN MODEM KIT GSM Waterproof adaptor EC12/SA12 Waterproof adaptor SA20/XT20/EC20/EX20 Waterproof adaptor SA20/XT20/EC20/EX20 + 1 extension module Temperature sensor (-40C/+20C) PWM/0-10V convertor 4-20mA/0-10V convertor Programming software on CD ROM EEPROM memory module Programming cable Panel mounting adaptor EC12/SA12 Panel mounting adaptor EC20/SA20/XT20/EX20 Ambient temperature sensor (-10 to +40C) Duct temperature sensor (-10 to +40C) Outside temperature sensor (-10 to +40C) Remote/Submersible temperature sensor (-10 to +150C)
For more information www.crouzet.com
Page 23 Page 21 Page 21 Page 23 Page 23 Page 23 Page 24 Page 23 Page 23 Page 23 Page 23 Page 23 Page 23 Page 23 Page 24 Page 24 Page 24 Page 24
11
Blind Temperature sensors Bare board Power supply Local extensions Accessories Adjacent extensions Communication modules
Power supply 12 V DC
Operating voltage Operating limits 12 V DC +30% -15% +30% -11% for XT20 relay 88 950 065 10.2 V DC 15.6 V DC 10.68 VDC 15.6 V DC for XT 20 relay 88 950 065 1 ms 6A SA12-EC12-CN12 : 2.2 W SA20-EC20-CN20 : 4.5 W XT20-EX20 : 5.5 W 100 - 240 (+10 % / -15 %) 50/60 Hz 700 80 40 50 On LCD screen for SA12, SA20 and XT20 24 (+10 % / -15 %) 50/60 Hz 4 15 5 50 ms On LCD screen for SA12, SA20 and XT20 4 inputs from I5 to I8 8 inputs from I5 to I12 (0 10 V) or (0 V power supply) 8 bits 10 ms 28.8 V DC > 22 +/- 5 % +/- 3 LSB 2.2 k / 0.5 W 24 (+20 % -15 %) V DC 3.2 mA / 5.5 mA max. 6.8 k 15 V DC 5 V DC 10 ms No Contact or 3-wire PNP or 3-wire NPN On LCD screen for SA12, SA20 and XT20
Programming method Program size Program memory Removable memory Data memory LCD display Real-time clock
Storage temperature (0C) Operating temperature (o C) Relative humidity (no condensation) Dimensions (l x h x w)
7 M 0 industrial / II domestic casing None IP20 / Terminal block IP40 IP00 for CN12 and CN20 CE, UL, cUL EN 60947-1 EN 60730-1 EN 60601-1 Function blocks/SFC 128 blocks Flash EEPROM EEPROM 256 bits / 64 words backed up for 10 years Display with 4 lines of 12 characters Drift < 1 min/month at 25 C with user-definable correction of drift Data retention : 10 years (lithium battery) -40 +70 -5 +55 90 95 % SA12-EC12 : 72 x 90 x 60 mm SA20-XT20 : 125 x 90 x 60 mm EC20-EX20 CN12 : 72 x 90 x 42 mm CN20 : 125 x 90 x 42 mm
Immunity from micro power cuts Maximum Inrush current Max. absorbed power
24 V AC input
Input voltage (V AC) Supply frequency range Input impedance (k) Pull-in voltage at logic state 1 (V AC) Drop-out voltage at logic state 0 (V AC) Response time Status indicator
Power supply 24 V AC
Operating voltage Operating limits Immunity from micro power cuts Maximum inrush current Max. absorbed power
24 V DC input
Current drain Input current Input impedance Pull-in voltage at logic state 1 Drop-out voltage at logic state 0 Response time Galvanic isolation Sensor type Status indicator
Power supply 24 V DC
Operating voltage Operating limits Immunity from micro power cuts Maximum inrush current Max. absorbed power
12
12 V DC input
Input voltage Input current Input impedance Pull-in voltage at logic state 1 Drop-out voltage at logic state 0 Response time Sensor type Galvanic isolation Status indicator 12 (+30 % -15 %) V DC (except XT20R +30 % -11 %) 1.9 mA / 2.3 mA max. 6.45 k 8 V DC 3 V DC 10 ms Contact or PNP or 3-wire NPN No On LCD screen for SA12, SA20 and XT20 4 inputs I5 to I8 8 inputs I5 to I8 0 10 V 8 bits 10 15.6 V DC > 10 (14 typically) 5% 3 LSB 2.2 k / 0.5 W 250 V AC / 30 V DC 8A 8 A / 250 V AC resistive (100 000 operations) 10 mA to 5 V DC 10 ms On LCD screen for SA12, SA20 and XT20 SA12-EC12-CN12 : O1 to O4 SA20-XT20-EC20-CN20 : O1 to O6 5-28.8 V DC 0.7 A / 5-28.8 V DC 1 mA 0.7 A 0.1 A 0.1 mA / 24 V DC 1 ms No 120 Hz to 1920 Hz (user-definable) 0 to 100 % (256 steps) < 5 % (from 15 % to 85 %) load at 10 mA < 10 % (from 20 % to 80 %) load at 10 mA On LCD screen for SA12, SA20 and XT20
Relay output
Max. breaking voltage Breaking current Service life Minimum load Response time Status indicator
13
Millenium II +
Starter kit
Discover the benefits of Millenium II+ Each kit includes :
- a standard or expandable Millenium II+ - a PC/Millenium progrmming cable - an interactive CD-Rom including the software workshop, tutorial, application library and technical brochures.
Specifications
Type KIT SA 12 Kit SA 20 Kit XT 20 Input 8 8 12 12 12 12 Output 4 relays 4 relays 8 relays 8 relays 8 relays 8 relays Supply 24 V DC 100 - 240 V AC 24 V DC 100 - 240 VAC 24 V DC 100 - 240 V AC Code 88 950 070 88 950 071 88 950 072 88 950 073 88 950 074 88 950 075
Specifications
Type Level control KIT Temperature control KIT Designation Level control Heating, cooling and air conditioning Supply 24 V AC 24 V DC Code 88 950 076 88 950 077
14
Millenium II +
Level detection
Intuitive programming via function block (FBD) or Function : timing, counting, etc Application-specific functions : rotation, cam timers,
calculation, etc Discrete, analogue or potentiometer inputs Relay, solid state or PWM outputs Backlit LCD display Program password protection Integral calender and clock User-definable from the front panel Non-expandable grafcet (SFC)
Specifications
Type SA 12 + level sensor adaptor Input 8 Output 4 relays Supply 24 V AC Code 88 950 813
Dimensions
SA 12
72 mm
L1 N I1 I2 I3 I4 I5 I6 I7 I8
90 mm
82 mm
45
Esc
OK
O1 O 2 O3 O4
59,2 mm
60 mm
60 5,5
81
15
Millenium II +
Standard
Intuitive programming via function block (FBD) or Function : timing, counting, etc Application-specific functions : rotation, cam timers,
calculation, etc Discrete, analogue or potentiometer inputs Relay, solid state or PWM outputs Backlit LCD display Program password protection Integral calender and clock User-definable from the front panel Non-expandable grafcet (SFC)
Specifications
Type SA 12 Input 8 PNP 8 8 8 PNP 8 PNP 8 PNP 8 NPN 12 PNP 12 12 12 PNP 12 PNP 12 PNP 12 NPN Output 4 relays 4 relays 4 relays 4 solid state 4 relays 4 solid state 4 relays 8 relays 8 relays 8 relays 8 solid state 8 relays 8 solid state 8 relays Supply 24 VDC 100 - 240 VAC 24 VAC 24 VDC 12 V DC 12 V DC 24 VDC 24 VDC 100 - 240 VAC 24 VAC 24 VDC 12 V DC 12 V DC 24 VDC Code 88 950 041 88 950 043 88 950 044 88 950 042 88 950 045 88 950 046 88 950 049 88 950 051 88 950 053 88 950 054 88 950 052 88 950 055 88 950 056 88 950 059
SA 20
Dimensions
SA 12
72 mm
L1 N I1 I2 I3 I4 I5 I6 I7 I8
SA 20
125 mm
L1 N I1 I2 I3 I4 I5 I6 I7 I8 I9 I10 I11 I12
90 mm
82 mm
Esc
OK
90 mm
82 mm
Esc
OK
O1 O 2 O3 O4
59,2 mm
60 mm
112,6 mm
60 mm
General characteristics
see page 23
16
Millenium II +
Expandable
Expandable : communication, inputs/outputs, etc Intuitive programming via function block (FBD) or Function : timing, counting, etc Application-specific functions : rotation, cam timers,
calculation, etc Discrete, analogue or potentiometer inputs Relay, solid state or PWM outputs Backlit LCD display Program password protection Integral calender and clock User-definable from the front panel Can take an XC adjacent extension and an XL local extension grafcet (SFC)
Specifications
Type XT 20 Input 12 PNP 12 PNP 12 PNP 12 PNP 12 PNP 12 PNP 12 NPN 12 PNP 12 12 12 PNP 12 NPN Output 8 relays 8 relays 8 relays 8 solid state 8 relays 8 solid state 8 relays 8 relays 8 relays 8 relays 8 solid state 8 relays Supply 24 VDC 100 - 240 VAC 24 VAC 24 VDC 12 V DC 12 V DC 24 VDC 24 V DC 100 - 240 V AC 24 V AC 24 V DC 24 V DC Code 88 950 061 88 950 063 88 950 064 88 950 062 88 950 065 88 950 066 88 950 069 88 950 831 88 950 833 88 950 834 88 950 832 88 950 839
EX 20
Dimensions
XT 20
125 mm
L1 N I1 I2 I3 I4 I5 I6 I7 I8 I9 I10 I11 I12
EX 20
125 mm
L1 N I1 I2 I3 I4 I5 I6 I7 I8 I9 I10 I11 I12
90 mm
82 mm
Esc
OK
112,6 mm
60 mm
90 mm
82 mm
112,6 mm
60 mm
General characteristics
see page 23
17
Millenium II +
Blind
No display or parameter-setting buttons Intuitive programming via function block (FBD) or Function : timing, counting, etc Application-specific functions : rotation, cam timers,
calculation, etc Discrete, analogue or potentiometer inputs Relay, solid state or PWM outputs Program protected by a password Integral calendar and clock grafcet (SFC)
Specifications
Type EC12 Input 8 PNP 8 8 8 PNP 8 PNP 8 PNP 8 NPN 12 PNP 12 12 12 PNP 12 PNP 12 PNP 12 NPN Output 4 relays 4 relays 4 relays 4 solid state 4 relays 4 solid state 4 relays 8 relays 8 relays 8 relays 8 solid state 8 relays 8 solid state 8 relays Supply 24 VDC 100 - 240 VAC 24 VAC 24 VDC 12 V DC 12 V DC 24 VDC 24 VDC 100 - 240 VAC 24 VAC 24 VDC 12 V DC 12 V DC 24 VDC Code 88 950 021 88 950 023 88 950 024 88 950 022 88 950 025 88 950 026 88 950 029 88 950 031 88 950 033 88 950 034 88 950 032 88 950 035 88 950 036 88 950 039
EC 20
Dimensions
EC 12
72 mm
L1 N I1 I2 I3 I4 I5 I6 I7 I8 L1 N I1 I2 I3 I4 I5 I6 I7 I8
EC 20
125 mm
I9 I10 I11 I12
90 mm
82 mm
O1 O 2 O3 O4
90 mm
82 mm
59,2 mm
60 mm
112,6 mm
60 mm
General characteristics
see page 23
18
Millenium II +
Bare board
For mass-production applications Intuitive programming via function block (FBD) or Function : timing, counting, etc Application-specific functions : rotation, cam timers,
calculation, etc Discrete, analogue or potentiometer inputs Relay, solid state or PWM outputs Program protected by password Integral calendar and clock grafcet (SFC)
1
Output 4 relays 4 relays 4 relays 4 solid state 4 relays 4 solid state 4 relays 8 relays 8 relays 8 relays 8 solid state 8 relays 8 solid state 8 relays Supply 24 V DC 100 - 240 V AC 24 V AC 24 V DC 12 V DC 12 V DC 24 V DC 24 V DC 100 - 240 V AC 24 V AC 24 V DC 12 V DC 12 V DC 24 V DC Code 88 950 001 88 950 003 88 950 004 88 950 002 88 950 005 88 950 006 88 950 009 88 950 011 88 950 013 88 950 014 88 950 012 88 950 015 88 950 016 88 950 019
Specifications
Type CN 12 Input 8 PNP 8 8 8 PNP 8 PNP 8 PNP 8 NPN 12 PNP 12 12 12 PNP 12 PNP 12 PNP 12 NPN
CN 20
Dimensions
CN 12
72 mm
CN 20
125 mm
90 mm
82 mm
90 mm
82 mm
59,2 mm
42 mm
112,6 mm
42 mm
General characteristics
see page 23
19
Millenium II +
Local extensions
For XT 20 only (1 local extension per module) Millenium - Millenium local link Doubles the hardware and software capacities Transparent communication between two XT 20 units Max. distance between two XT 20 units : 10 metres Cable type : screened twisted pair
Specifications
Type XL 01 XL 05 XL 06 Designation M2 - M2 local link (2 modules) 4 solid state outputs 2 relay outputs Supply universal universal 100 240 V AC Code 88 950 200 88 950 204 88 950 810
Adjacent extensions
For XT 20 only (one adjacent extension per module) 4 or 6 additional inputs/outputs
Specifications
Type XC 01 Designation 4 inputs PNP 2 relay outputs 4 inputs relay outputs 4 inputs 2 relay outputs 4 inputs 2 relay outputs 4 inputs NPN 2 relay outputs Supply 24 V DC 24 V AC 100 - 240 V AC 12 V DC 24 V DC Code 88 950 210 88 950 211 88 950 212 88 950 215 88 950 219
Dimensions
XC 01
36 mm 60 mm
90 mm
82 mm
XC01
24 mm
20
Millenium II +
Communication modules
For XT 20 only (one adjacent extension per module) Communication using MODBUS or AS-i protocol
(Slave module)
Specifications
Type XC 02 XC 03 Modems Designation AS-i communication module 24 V DC MODBUS communication module 24 V DC RTC GSM Supply 24 V DC 24 V DC Code 88 950 213 88 950 214 88 950 106 88 950 107
Dimensions
xc02/xc03 modem
36 mm
60 mm
55 mm
110 mm
90 mm
82 mm
XC01
24 mm
62 mm
75 mm
21
Power supply
The output voltage can be adjusted from 100 to 120 %
with a potentiometer in order to compensate for possible voltage drops. Output voltage existance is indicated by a continuously lit LED. A flashing LED indicates an autoprotection mode. Regulated, power surge and short circuit safe, the new switching power supplies easily fit into control panels.
Specifications
Type PS Voltage 12 V DC 24 V DC Nominal power 22 W 30 W Code 88 950 300 88 950 301
General characteristics
Input voltage Output voltage Nominal power Technology Short-circuit protection Overload protection Reset after overload Status indication Mounting Conformity to standards 100 240 V AC single phase 88 950 300 : 12 V DC 88 950 301 : 24 V DC ajustable de 100 120 % 88 950 300 : 22W 88 950 301 : 30W Electronic with primary decoupling
Certifications
automatic Output LED DIN rail EN 50022 EN 50081-1 EN 50082-1 CEI 61000-8-2 CEI 950 CE, UL-CSA, TV, CTick
Dimensions
PS
66,6 mm
90 mm 110 mm
51,6 mm 56,1 mm
4 mm
60 mm 72 mm
22
90 mm 100 mm
Accessories
Specifications
Type Front panel adaptor Waterproof panel Designation Front panel adaptor for EC12-SA12 Front panel adaptor for EC20-SA20-XT20-EX20 Waterproof panel adaptor for SA12-EC12 Waterproof panel adaptor for SA20-XT20-EC20-EX20 Waterproof panel adaptor for SA20-XT20-EC20-EX20 + 1 extension Code 89 750 103 89 750 109 89 750 160 89 750 161 89 750 162
Interconnection cables
Specifications
Type Programming cables Modem cable Designation Programming cable 9-pin D connector Programming cable USB Code 88 950 102 88 950 105 88 950 111
Programming tools
Specifications
Type Software Module Designation Programming software on CD ROM Modem installation software EEPROM memory module Code 88 950 100 88 950 113 88 950 101
Convertors
Specifications
Type Convertor 0-20 mA / 0-10 V Convertor PWM / 0-10V
To order, see page 6
Input 4 1
Output 4 1
23
Temperature sensors
Temperature sensors
Built-in converter : 0-10 V DC output Applications : Industrial and domestic
Specifications
Type Zone Ventilation duct Outdoor Remote/submersible probe Outdoor Range -10 +40 C -10 +40 C -10 +40 C -10 +150 C -40 +20 C Accuracy -0.2 C +1.2 C -0.2 C +1.9 C -0.2 C +1.2 C -0.2 C +1.2 C -0.2C +1.9C Protection casing IP30 IP65 IP65 IP65 IP65 Protection probe IP30 IP67 IP67 Code 89 750 150 89 750 151 89 750 152 89 750 153 89 750 155
Accessories
Accessories Copper protective sleeve for 89 750 153 Stainless steel (316) protective sleeve for 89 750 153 Heat transfer compound Operating temperature (o C) -20 +100 -20 +400 Operating pressure (bar) 10 16 Code 89 750 146 89 750 147 18 372 112
General characteristics
Supply voltage Output Temperature coefficients Derating Temperature coefficients Offset Ambient temperature (oC) Ambient humidity Material housing 24 V DC (10 %) 0 10 V DC 0.01 % / C of full scale 1.5 mV / C -10 +60 5 95 % RH Self-extinguishing
24
Dimensions
89 750 150
1
89 750 151
93 mm 74 mm 4 mm
6 mm 32 mm 98 mm
80 mm 85 mm
2
85 mm 70 mm 80 mm
150 mm 85 mm
3
70 mm
67 mm
67 mm
32 mm 98 mm
85 mm
98 mm
32 mm 85 mm
67 mm 150 mm 1m
6 mm
B Screw M4
25
26
www.crouzet.com
27
Selection guide
Function Casing 17.5 mm
Delay on energisation (A)
35 mm
Timing on impulse (one shot)
(B)
22.5 mm
1 relay
17.5 mm
MONO-FUNCTION
Delay on de-energisation
22.5 mm
memory (At)
memory (Ht)
17.5 mm
Cyclic timing
28
1 relay 17.5 mm
Solid state
MULTI-FUNCTION
1 relay 12 to 240 VAC/DC memory (At) Timing on impulse (one shot) Shaping (B) Timing after impulse 24 VDC 22.5 mm Off-delay timer (C) 24 to 240 VAC Timing on energisation (H) Timing on energisation with 12 VAC/DC memory (Ht) Cyclic timing Pause start (D) 24 VDC 2 relays Cyclic timing Pulse start (Di) 24 to 240 VAC Pulse output (adjustable) (Bw) Timing after closing and 12 to 230 VAC opening of control contact (Ac) 12 VAC/DC 1 relay 12 to 240 VAC/DC 24 VDC 24 to 240 VAC 2 relays 12 VAC/DC 12 to 240 VAC/DC
Delay on energisation by
Plug-in
17.5 mm
MXR1
Page 36
switch (non resettable) (Ah) 1 relay Safe-guard (N) Delayed safe-guard (O) Delayed fixed-length pulse (P) Impulse counter (delay on) (Pt) 22.5 mm Impulse relay (TL) Timed impulse relay (Tt) 2 relays Timing after pulse on control contact (W)
Screw terminals
TXR1
8A Page 38
TX2R1
29
SAS
0,7 A
Page 50
SAS P
0,7 A
Page 50
SAS D
0,7 A
Page 50
2
Ai 60 min
220-240 VAC 12 VDC 24 VAC 48 VAC 110 VAC 220-240 VAC 24 VAC B 60 min 48 VAC 110 VAC 230 VAC 24 VAC MONO-FUNCTION Bp 100 s 48 VAC 110 VAC 230 VAC 24 VAC Bd 60 min 48 VAC 110 VAC 230 VAC 24 VAC C 60 min 48 VAC 110 VAC 230 VAC 24 VAC Cp 100 s 48 VAC 110 VAC 230 VAC 24 VAC Cd 60 min 48 VAC 110 VAC 230 VAC 24 VAC E 10 min 48 VAC 110 VAC 230 VAC 24 VAC Ep 10 min 48 VAC 110 VAC 230 VAC 24 VAC Ed 10 min 48 VAC 110 VAC 230 VAC Faston connectors 6.35 mm SDS BD 0,7 A Page 56 Faston connectors 6.35 mm SDS BP 0,7 A Page 56 Faston connectors 6.35 mm SDS B 0,7 A Page 56 Faston connectors 6.35 mm SCS D 0,7 A Page 53 Faston connectors 6.35 mm SCS P 0,7 A Page 53 Faston connectors 6.35 mm SCS 0,7 A Page 53 Faston connectors 6.35 mm SBS D 0,7 A Page 52 Faston connectors 6.35 mm SBS P 0,7 A Page 52 Faston connectors 6.35 mm SBS 0,7 A Page 52 Faston connectors 6.35 mm
SAS I
0,7 A
Page 50
30
Function E1
Connection Faston connectors 6.35 mm Faston connectors 6.35 mm Faston connectors 6.35 mm
E2
1s
0,7 A
Page 56
H (2 wire)
60 min
SHS B
0,7 A
Page 54
Hp (2 wire)
100 s
SHS BP
0,7 A
Page 54
Hd (2 wire)
60 min
SHS BD
0,7 A
Page 54
2
SHI S 0,7 A Page 54
Hi (4 wire)
60 min
H (3 wire)
100 s
SHS
0,7 A
Page 54
MONO-FUNCTION
H (3 wire)
60 min
SHS P
0,7 A
Page 54
Hp (3 wire)
60 min
SHS D
0,7 A
Page 54
10 min
SAS X
0,7 A
Page 60
10 min
SAS C
0,7 A
Page 60
SAS CB
0,7 A
Page 60
SGS
0,7 A
Page 58
SGS I
0,7 A
Page 58
SFS
0,7 A
Page 59
31
90 min
90 to 260 VAC
NFR
1 relay
Page 62
NFR
2-3-4
1 relay
6 min to 12 h
32
Basic principles
Timers
A timer is a control component which, after a preset time, energises an output contact. The start of a timing cycle, single or repetitive, is produced by timer energisation or by maintained or pulse control contacts with, as a result, a large number of potential functions. There are two types of presentation:
Insulation to standard VDE 110 group C, IEC 255.5 and IEC 664
Spcifications pour le dimensionnement des lignes de fuite et distance dans l'air du matriel lectrique.
Protection
To IEC 529: classification of the levels of protection obtained by casings, terminal against solid matter against liquids
Panel-mounted
Product designed to be fitted on a panel in order to be accessible by the user. There are two types of output: Timed contacts dependent on the value of the set time. Instantaneous contacts operating simultaneously with the energisation or de-energisation of the product in instantaneous fashion (excluding certain cases, for example: memory).
Note:
Electro-mechanical timers with automatic reset are fitted with: either a standard clutch : during timing, the electro-clutch is energised or a reversed clutch : during timing the electro-clutch is de-energised. Timers with manual reset require "manual" intervention for the commencement of a new cycle which involves resetting the timing selector.
Electromagnetic compatibility
Electromagnetic compatibility tests measure the degree of immunity which a piece of equipment shows to various types of disturbance as defined in IEC standards.
Definitions
Minimum control contact time
This is the minimum pulse time required to effect timing control.
Controls
Quality control
Our products are quality controlled systematically during assembly and on completion. The overseeing of control checks in the workshop, the use of collected data and any resulting product assessments form the essential role of Quality Control. All our products undergo a final check, either 100% or on a selective basis according to French standard X 06-022, which provides for a classification of possible defects in three groups : critical, major, minor.
Accuracy
This is the maximum difference between the selected and the actual timing of the cycle chosen. It is expressed as a percentage of the maximum value of the timing range considered within normal operating parameters.
Note:
According to customer requirements and for certain product ranges which must meet particular requirements expressed in a specification, it is always possible to create or to modify a quality standard on the basis of a normal or special existing product and to vary the level of inspection. It can happen that the tolerance level is set at zero for certain parameters directly linked to the completion of a function for which total success must be assured: a defect is therefore fatal. Such specific requirements do, however, entail a significant increase in product costs.
Thermal intensity
Current limit in continuous duty for a circuit with the highest possible level of current which a previously closed contact circuit can tolerate at all times in specified conditions.
Contact rating
This is the value of the current that can be switched by a contact in certain specified conditions.
www.crouzet.com
33
FUNCTIONS
U : Supply R : Output or load relay T : Timing C (Y1) : Control contact : indefinite
1 relay
U R T U R1/R2
U C R1/R2 T R2 Inst.
R2 INST T
The output changes states at the end of the set time T1, for a period T2. Both T1 and T2 independently adjustable.
A output relay R (or the load) changes state, and remains in the changed-over state for the timing period, both when control contact C (Y1) closes and when it opens.
U C R T U T
R T T
U C
R1/R2 R2 Inst.
After energisation, once the control contact is closed the output state changes. Timing will only begin on the re-opening of this control contact (one shot). Relay R returns to its initial position at the end of the timing period.
2 relays timed or 1 relay timed and 1 instantaneous
U C R1/R2
R2 inst. T
Function D ou Di : Flip-flop
Repetitive cycle which switches the output alternately between the rest and operating position for equal time bases. T1 + T2 = T total Function D: the cycle begins with the output in rest position. Pause start.
2 relays timed or 1 relay timed and 1 instantaneous 1 relay
U R T T U R1/R2 T T R2 Inst.
1 relay
Function Di: the cycle begins with the output in the operating position. Pulse start.
U R T T U
R1/R2 T T R2 Inst.
1 relay
U R T
U C R1/R2 R2 Inst.
R1/R2 T R2 Inst.
34
Function Ht :
Provides a cumulative time for contact opening. On energisation, the output changes state, remains in that state for the duration of timing and resets at the end of the single cycle.
U C R t1 t2 T = t1+t2
U C
R1/R2 R2 Inst.
Calculates the total opening time of a contact. At the end of timing, the output is energised for approximately 500 ms.
U C R t2 t1 T= t1+t2 P
Function Q : "Star-delta"
At the end of timing, the output is not energised. It remains "open" (not conducting) and will only change state after the fixed time of Ti has elapsed. Dwell time selectable
U R T Ti
U R1/R2 T1 T2
b - energisation by supply voltage The timer sums the times for which the supply voltage (U) is on. Reset is by the reset signal (C2) only
Function T :
Impulse relay
U C R
8 8 8
U R1/R2 T1 T2
After power-up, pressing or holding down the switch closes the relay. Pressing the switch a second time opens the relay.
Function N : "Safe-guard"
At the first control pulse the output is energised. To complete the timing the interval between the two control pulses must be greater than the timing set.
U C R T
Function Tt :
After power-up, pressing or holding down the switch closes the relay and starts timing. The relay opens at the end of timing or when the switch is pressed a second time.
35
Chronos 2 timers
Specifications
Type MUR1 MAR1 MBR1 MCR1 MHR1 MLR1 MUR4 MUR3 MURc3 MXR1 MUS2 MAS5 MHS2 MLS2
Output 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay Solid state Solid state Solid state Solid state
Connections Screw terminals Screw terminals Screw terminals Screw terminals Screw terminals Screw terminals Screw terminals Screw terminals Spring terminals Screw terminals Screw terminals Screw terminals Screw terminals Screw terminals
Supply voltage 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC 24 V DC / 24 240 VAC 24V DC / 24 240 V AC 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC 12 V DC / AC 12 240V AC / DC 12 240 V AC/DC 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC 24 240 V AC 24 240V AC / DC 24 240 V AC 24 240 V AC
Code 88 826 105 88 826 115 88 826 125 88 826 135 88 826 145 88 826 155 88 826 100 88 826 103 88 826 503 88 826 185 88 826 004 88 826 014 88 826 044 88 826 054
Connections
1 changeover relay output
U +
A1
A1
Y1
15 R
A1
Y1
15 R
A2
MULTI
Y1
A2 16 18
A2 16 15
18 R
Y1
A1
Y1
Li - L
Solid state output
U A1 A2 Y1
A2 R
18 R
A2
Y1
A/H
L / Li
General characteristics
see page 45
36
Dimensions
3,5 44
17,5
45
60
5,5
Curves
Function A
U R T
81
Function Ac
U C R T T
Function Ad
U C R T T
Delay on energisation
Function Ah
U C R1/R2 R2 Inst. T T T
T
Safe-guard
Function Pt
U C R t1 t2 T= t1+t2
P
Delayed safe-guard
Function Tl
U C R
8 8 8
Impulse relay
37
Chronos 2 timers
Specifications
Type TUR1 TAR1 TBR1 TCR1 THR1 TLR1 TQR1 TUR4 TUR3 TURc3 TXR1 TU2R1 TA2R1 TK2R1 TU2R4 TQR6 TU2R3 TX2R1
Functions A - At - B - C - H - Ht - Di - D - Ac - Bw A - At B C H - Ht Li - L Q A - At - B - C - H - Ht - Di - D - Ac - Bw A - At - B - C - H - Ht - Di - D - Ac - Bw A - At - B - C - H - Ht - Di - D - Ac - Bw Ad - Ah - N - O - P- Pt - TL - Tt - W A - At - B - C - H - Ht - Di - D - Ac -Bw
Output 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay 1 change over relay 2 timed changeover relays including 1 instantaneous A - At 2 changeover relays K 2 change over relays A - At - B - C - H - Ht - Di - D - Ac - Bw 2 timed changeover relays including 1 instantaneous Q : Star / Delta 1 change over relay A, B, C, H, Di, Ac, Bw + (At, Ht, D) 2 timed changeover relays including 1 instantaneous Ad - Ah - N - O - P - Pt - TL - Tt - W 2 timed changeover relays including 1 instantaneous
Nominal rating 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A
Connections Screw terminals Screw terminals Screw terminals Screw terminals Screw terminals Screw terminals Screw terminals Screw terminals Screw terminals Spring terminals Screw terminals Screw terminals
Supply voltage 24V DC / 24 240 V AC 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC 24 V DC/ 24 240 V AC 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC 24V DC / 24 240 V AC 12 240 V AC/ DC 12 240 V AC / DC 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC
Code 88 865 105 88 865 115 88 865 125 88 865 135 88 865 145 88 865 155 88 865 175 88 865 100 88 865 103 88 865 503 88 865 185 88 865 305
Screw terminals 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC 88 865 215 Screw terminals 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC 88 865 265 Screw terminals 12 V AC / DC 88 865 300 Screw terminals 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC 88 865 176 Screw terminals 12 230 V AC 88 865 303 Screw terminals 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC 88 865 385
Connections
1 changeover relay output
U +
A1
Y1
15 R
A1
Y1
15 R
A1
15 R
A2 16 18
A2 16 15
A2 28 18
A1
Y1
Li - L
2 changeover relay outputs
U
+
A1
Y1
15 R1
25/21 R2
A1
R1
15
25
R2
A2
A2 16 18 26/22 28/24
16 18
26 28
A - At - B - C - H - Ht - Di - D - Ac - Bw - Ad Ah - N - O - P - Pt - TL - Tt - W
General characteristics
see page 45
38
Dimensions
32 3,5 63 22,5
A1 15 Y1
57
78
18 16 A2
95 5
Curves
Function A
U R T
Function A
U R1/R2 R2 Inst. T
Function Ac
U C R T T
Delay on energisation
Function Ac
U C R1/R2
R2 Inst.
R1/R2 R2 Inst. T T T
T
Timing after closing and opening of control contact 2 timers or 2 relays, including 1 instantaneous
Function At
U C R t1 t2 T = t1+t2
Timing on energisation with memory with 2 timed outputs or 1 timed and 1 instantaneous
Function Bw
U C R
Function Bw
U C R
R2 Inst.
Timing on impulse one shot with 2 timed outputs or 1 timed and 1 instantaneous
Function C
U C R T
R2 Inst.
39
Function H
U R T
Function H
U R1/R2 T
R2 Inst.
Function Ht
U C R t1 t2 T = t1+t2
Function Ht
U C R1/R2 t1 R2 Inst. T = t1+t2 t2
U R1 R2 T
U R T1 T2
Delay on energisation with memory with 2 timed outputs or 1 timed and 1 instantaneous
Function Li
U
R T1 T2
C R T
R T
Safe-guard
Function Pt
U C R t1 t2 T= t1+t2
P
Delayed safe-guard
Function Q
U R T Ti
Star-delta
Function W
U C R T
40
41
Chronos 2 timers
Plug-in
Multi-function or mono-function Multi-range Multi-voltage Relay output 1 or 2 : 8 A - 250 V (10 A UL) LED status indicator Option of connecting an external power supply to the control input 3-wire sensor control option
Specifications
Type OUR1 OA2R1 OCR1 OLR1 OUR4 OUR3 PU2R1 Output 1 changeover relay 2 changeover relays 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay 2 timed changeover relays including 1 instantaneous PA2R1 A - At 2 changerover relays PC2R1 C 2 changeover relays PL2R1 Li - L 2 changeover relays PU2R4 A - At - B - C - H - Ht - Di - D - Ac - Bw 2 timed changeover relays including 1 instantaneous PU2R3 A - At - B - C - Ht - Di - D - Ac - Bw 2 timed changeover relays including 1 instantaneous Functions A - At - B - C - H - Ht - Di - D - Ac - Bw A C Li - L A - At - B - C - H - Ht - Di - D - Ac - Bw A - At - B - C - H - Ht - Di - D - Ac - Bw A - At - B - C - H - Ht - Di - D - Ac - Bw Nominal rating 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A Connections 8-pin 8-pin 8-pin 8-pin 8-pin 8-pin 11-pin 11-pin 11-pin 11-pin 11-pin 11-pin Supply voltage 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC 12 V AC / DC 12 240 V AC / DC 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC 24 V DC / 24 240 V AC 12 V AC / DC 12 240 V AC / DC Code 88 867 105 88 867 215 88 867 135 88 867 155 88 867 100 88 867 103 88 867 305 88 867 415 88 867 435 88 867 455 88 867 300 88 867 303
Accessories
8-pin connector base 11-pin connector base (for the whole range) Code 25 622 128 25 622 077
Connections
8-pin 1 relay output
+
U 4
3 5 6
Y1
U 4 3 R1 2 1 8
R
2 1 8 7
Functions A - At / H - Ht/ B / C / Di - D / Ac / Bw
11-pin 2 relay outputs
+ U 5 4 R1
3 2 1 11
Function A
11-pin 2 relay outputs
+
Functions Li - L
Y1 6 7 8 R2
9
10
U
5 6 7 8
4 R1
3 2 1 11
R2
9
10
Functions A - At / H - Ht / B / C / Di - D / Ac / Bw
Functions L - Li
General characteristics
see page 45
42
Dimensions
Accessories
74,5 3,5 12,5 35
Curves
Function A
U R T
45
Function A
U R1/R2 T
Function A
U R1/R2 R2 Inst. T
Function Ac
U C R T T
Function Ac
U C R1/R2
R2 Inst.
2
U C R t1 t2 T = t1+t2
Timing after closing and opening of control contact with 2 timed outputs or 1 timed and 1 instantaneous
Function B
U C R T
R2 Inst.
Timing on energisation with memory with 2 timed outputs or 1 timed and 1 instantaneous
Function Bw
U C R T T
Timing on impulse one shot with 2 timed outputs or 1 timed and 1 instantaneous
Function C
Function Bw
U C R T T
U C R T
R2 Inst.
43
Function H
U R1/R2 T
R2 Inst.
Function Ht
U C R t1 t2 T = t1+t2
Function Ht
U C R1/R2 t1 R2 Inst. T = t1+t2 t2
Function L
U R1/R2 T1 T2
U R T1 T2
44
Other characteristics
Conforming to standards IEC 1812-1, EN 50081-1/2, EN 50082-1/ 2, LV directives (73/23/EEC + 93/ 68/EEC (CE marking) + EMC (89/ 336/EEC + IEC 669-2-3 (17.5 mm) ) Approvals UL - CSA - cUL pending Temperatures limits use (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Installation category (acc. to IEC 664-1) Creepage distance and clearance acc. to IEC 664-1 Protection (IEC 529) Terminal Protection (IEC 529) Housing Degree of protection acc. to IEC 529 Front face (except Tk2R1) Vibration resistance acc. to IEC 68-2-6 Relative humidity no condensation acc. to 68-2-3 Electromagnetic compatibility Immunity to electrostatic discharges acc to IEC 1000-42 Immunity to electrostatic fields acc. ENV 50140/204 (IEC 1000-4-3) Immunity to rapid transient bursts acc. to IEC 1000-4-4 Immunity to shock waves on power supply acc. to IEC 1000-4-5 Immunity to radiofrequency in common mode acc. to ENV (CEI 1000-4-6) Immunity to voltage dips and breaks acc. to IEC 1000-4-11 Mains-borne and radiated emissions acc. to EN 55022 (EN 55011 Group 1) Fixing : Symmetrical DIN rail (EN 50022) Connection capacity - without ferrule Connection capacity - with ferrule Spring terminals, 2 terminals per connection point - flexible wire Spring terminals, 2 terminals per connection point - rigid wire Material housing Weight : casing 17.5 mm Weight : casing 22.5 mm Weight : plug-in casing
-20 +60 -30 +60 Voltage surge category 4 kV / 3 IP 20 IP 40 IP 50 f = 10 - 55 Hz A = 0.35 mm 93 % without condensation Level III (Air 8 KV / Contact 6 KV)
350 ms
> 10 ms
Supply
Multi-voltage power supply Frequency (Hz) Operating range Operator factor Max. absorbed power Depending on version 50 / 60 85 to 110 % Un (85 to 120 % Un for 12V AC/DC) 100 % 0.6 W 24 V AC/DC 1.5 W 230 V AC 32 VA 230 V AC
Level III 10V/m (80 MHz to 1 GHz) Level III (direct 2kV / Capacitive coupling clamp 1 KV) Level III (2 KV / common mode 2 KV/residual current mode 1KV) Level III (10V rms : 0.15 MHz to 80 MHz) 30 %/10 ms 60 %/100 ms > 95 %/5 s Class B
0.7 A AC/DC 20 C (0.5 A UL) 5 mA / C 20 A 10 ms 10 mA < 5 mA 250 V AC/V DC 3 wire 4V - 2 wire 8V 108 108 2.5 kV to 1 mA / 1 min Volt-free contact 3-wire PNP output control option residual voltage : 0.4V whatever the timer power supply 1 s - 10 s - 1 min - 10 min - 1 h - 10 h - 100 h
45
Plug-IN
Miniature plug-in timer (21 x 27 mm) Function A : Delay on energisation Multi-range 0.1 s to 10 h Excellent noise resistance Relay output, 2 or 4 changeover contacts
Specifications
Type RTMA2 Functions A A A A A A A A A A Relay outputs 2 timed changeover 2 timed changeover 2 timed changeover 2 timed changeover 2 timed changeover 4 timed changeover 4 timed changeover 4 timed changeover 4 timed changeover 4 timed changeover Nominal rating 5 A AC 5 A AC 5 A AC 5 A AC 5 A AC 3 A AC 3 A AC 3 A AC 3 A AC 3 A AC Supply voltage 12 VDC 24 VDC 24 VAC 110 VAC 230 VAC 12 V DC 24 V DC 24 V AC 127 V AC 230 V AC Absorbed power (W) 1.5 1.2 1.7 2.6 3 1.5 1.2 1.7 2.6 3 Code 88 895 201 88 895 202 88 895 203 88 895 206 88 895 207 88 896 201 88 896 202 88 896 203 88 896 206 88 896 207
2
RTMA4
Accessories
PCB base RTMA2 Base for DIN rail mounting RTMA2 Spring clips for DIN rail mounting base Spring clips for PCB base PCB base RTMA4 Base for DIN rail mounting RTMA4 Code 26 532 709 26 532 707 26 532 702 26 532 704 26 532 708 26 532 706
Connections
RTMA 2
+ 14 9 12
RTMA4
+ 14 9 10 11 12
- 13
- 13
1 6
2 7
3 8
1 5
9 13
4 8
12 14
1 5 9 13
2 6
3 7
4 8
10 11 12 14
(-)
(+)
(-)
(+)
46
General characteristics
Timing ranges 0.1 1s 1 10s 0.1 1 min 1 10 min 0.1 1h 1 10 h 10 100 h -0 % / + 10 % at 25 C of full scale, according to CEI/EN61812 0.5 % 0.05 %/C 0.2 %/V 50 ms 250 ms 15 % of supply (AC) 10 % of supply (DC) 50/60 Hz 1 Hz < 5 ms 10 % (DC) 100 % 1250 VA / 120 W 100 mA 250 V AC AgNi 600 105 107 2 kV at 1 mA / 1 min / 50 Hz Green : power on yellow : output on CEI/EN61812-1, CEI/EN60601-1, EN50081-2, EN61000-6-2, CEI/ EN60601-1-2, Directives BT (73/23/CEE + 93/68/CEE (CE marking) ) + CEM (89/336/CEE) UL - cUL -20 +60 -40 +70 4 kV / surge category 3 IP 50 (casing) f = 10 55 Hz A = 0.35 mm 95 % max (CEI 60068-2-3) Class 2 according to EN61812-1/A11 Level III (Air 8 K : contact 6kV) Level III (10 V/m : 26 MHz to 1 GHz / 900 MHz) Level III (Direct 2 kV : coupled 1kV) Level III (10 V (rms) : 0.15 MHz to 80 Mhz) AC : level III (common mode 2 kV, differential mode : 1 kV DC : MC/MD : 0.5 kV 30 % / 10 ms 60 % / 100 ms / 1 s > 95 % 5 s Class B Self-extinguishing 55
Display accuracy Repetition accuracy (with constant parameters) Drift Temperature Drift Voltage Maximum reset time by de-energisation during timed delay Maximum reset time by de-energisation after timing Operating range Frequency (Hz) Immunity from micro power cuts : typical Ripple Operator factor Output specification Maximum power rating (resistive) Minimum current Maximum breaking voltage Type of contacts Max. permitted number of operations at 1 max 250 V AC resistive per hour Electrical life at I max., 250 V AC resistive (number of operations) Mechanical life (operations) Breakdown voltage conforming to IEC/EN 61812-1 and 60601-1 Function and use Display of output state by LED Conformity to standards
Approvals Temperatures limits use (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Insulation coordination (IEC 60664-1) Degree of protection IEC 60529 Vibration resistance acc. to IEC 68-2-6 Relative humidity (no condensation) Electromagnetic compatibility Immunity to electrostatic discharges acc. IEC/EN 61000-4-2 Immunity to electrostatic fields acc. ENV 50140/204 (IEC 1000-4-3) Immunity to rapid transient bursts acc. to IEC 1000-4-4 Immunity to radio frequency in common mode acc. to ENV (CEI 1000-4-6) Immunity to shock waves according to IEC/EN 61000-4-5 Immunity to voltage dips and breaks acc. to IEC 1000-4-11
Mains-borne and radiated emissions acc. to EN 55022 (EN 55011 Group 1) Material housing Weight (g)
47
Dimensions
Base for DIN rail mounting RTMA2 - 26 532 707
30
24
68
4,1
11,5
= 3x4,4
29,5
25,5
1,5
13,5
29,5
25,5
29,5
1,5
6,5
13,5
= 21,5
RTMA2 - RTMA4
21 3,5 65,5 21
7,5
4,1
27
Un
59,5
2,8
0,3 1,2
Curves
RTMA2 RTMA4
3-7-11 4-8-12 T
2 relays
4 relays
Other information
For single-range versions, please consult us.
48
27
0,55
2x6,3
5,3
49
S/SE timers
Delay on energisation
Solid state output Mono-function Mono-range-timing fixed, or adjustable by external or built-in potentiometer Mono-voltage Solid state output 0.7 A at 20 C Versions : 2 or 3 wire Fully sealed for protection by encapsulation in polyurethane resin Connection by 6.35 mm Faston blade terminals
Specifications
Voltage
12 V DC 24 V AC DC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC DC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC50/60 Hz DC 220 240 V AC 50/60 Hz DC SASP 88 870 1 12 V DC 24 V AC DC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC DC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz DC 220 240 V AC 50/60 Hz DC SASD 88 870 1 12 V DC 24 V AC DC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC DC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz DC 220 240 V AC 50/60 Hz DC SAIS 88 870 1 12 V DC 24 V AC DC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC DC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz DC 220 240 V AC 50/60 Hz DC
Functions Maximum timing (to be specified or ordering) A 60 min A 60 min A 60 min A 60 min A 60 min Ap 100 s Ap 100 s Ap 100 s Ap 100 s Ap 100 s Ad 60 min Ad 60 min Ad 60 min Ad 60 min Ad 60 min Ai 60 min Ai 60 min Ai 60 min Ai 60 min Ai 60 min
Features Timing, series connection Timing, series connection Timing, series connection Timing, series connection Timing, series connection Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer Timing, parallel connection Timing, parallel connection Timing, parallel connection Timing, parallel connection Timing, parallel connection
Code
General characteristics
Accuracy Repetition accuracy (with constant parameters) Variation according to VDE 0435 Reset time during timed delay Reset time after timing Immunity from micro power cuts Nominal current - I max at 20 C Nominal current - I min Maximum admissible current Leakage current at 20 o C Voltage drop at terminals Derating Electrical life (number of operations) Weight (g) Function A, Ai, Ad : 10 % Function Ap : -10 % +30 % 0.5 % 0 +40 C : 3 % -20 +60 C : 5 % 150 ms 25 ms < 20 ms 0.7 A 10 mA 20 A < 0.01 s 5 mA 3.5 V 5 mA /C > 108 SAS, SASP, SASD : 55 g SAIS : 60 g
To order, see page 6. Accessories, dimensions, function and use, Other information, see page 61.
50
Connections
SAS SASP SASD
SAIS
2
Curves
Function A Function Ap Function Ad
Function Ai
To order, see page 6. Accessories, dimensions, function and use, Other information, see page 61.
51
S/SE timers
Specifications
Type Voltage
SBS 88 870 2
24 V AC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz 230 V AC 50/60 Hz SBSP 88 870 2 24 V AC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz 230 V AC 50/60 Hz SBSD 88 870 2 24 V AC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz 230 V AC 50/60 Hz
Functions Maximum timing (to be specified or ordering) B 60 min B 60 min B 60 min B 60 min Bp 100 s Bp 100 s Bp 100 s Bp 100 s Bd 60 min Bd 60 min Bd 60 min Bd 60 min
Features Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer
Code
General characteristics
Accuracy Repetition accuracy (with constant parameters) Variation according to VDE 0435 Min. control pulse Reset time during timed delay Immunity from micro power cuts Nominal current - I max at 20 C Nominal current - I min Maximum admissible current Leakage current at 20 o C Voltage drop at terminals Derating Electrical life (number of operations) Weight (g) Function B, Bd : 10 % Function Bp : -10 % +30 % 0.5 % 0 +40 C : 3 % -20 +60 C : 5 % 20 ms 800 ms < 20 ms 0.7 A 5 mA 20 A < 0.01 s 2 mA 3.5 V 5 mA / C > 108 55
Curves
Function B Function Bp Function Bd
Connections
SBS SBSP SBSD
To order, see page 6. Accessories, dimensions, function and use, Other information, see page 61.
52
S/SE timers
Specifications
Type SCS 88 870 3 Voltage Functions Maximum timing (to be specified or ordering) C 60 min C 60 min C 60 min C 60 min Cp 100 s Cp 100 s Cp 100 s Cp 100 s Cd 60 min Cd 60 min Cd 60 min Cd 60 min Features Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer Code
24 V AC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz 230 V AC 50/60 Hz SCSP 88 870 3 24 V AC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz 230 V AC 50/60 Hz SCSD 88 870 3 24 V AC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz 230 V AC 50/60 Hz
General characteristics
Accuracy Repetition accuracy (with constant parameters) Variation according to VDE 0435 Min. control pulse Reset time during timed delay Immunity from micro power cuts Nominal current - I max at 20 C Nominal current - I min Maximum admissible current Leakage current at 20 o C Voltage drop at terminals Derating Electrical life (number of operations) Function C, Cd : 10 % Function Cp : -10 % +30 % 0.5 % 0 +40 C : 3 % -20 +60 C : 5 % 20 ms 800 ms < 20 ms 0.7 A 5 mA 20 A < 0.01 s 2 mA 3.5 V 5 mA / C > 108
Curves
Function C Function Cp Function Cd
Connections
SCS SCSP SCSD
To order, see page 6. Accessories, dimensions, function and use, Other information, see page 61.
53
S/SE timers
Timing on energisation
Solid state output Mono-funtion Mono-range-timing fixed, or adjustable by external or built-in potentiometer Mono-voltage Solid state output 0.7 A at 20 C Versions : 2 or 3 wire Fully sealed for protection by encapsulation in polyurethane resin Connection by 6.35 mm Faston blade terminals
Specifications
Voltage
24 V AC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz 230 V AC 50/60 Hz SHSBP 88 870 4 24 V AC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz 230 V AC 50/60 Hz SHSBD 88 870 4 24 V AC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz 230 V AC 50/60 Hz SHIS 88 870 4 24 V AC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz 230 V AC 50/60 Hz SHS 88 870 4 24 V AC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz 230 V AC 50/60 Hz SHSP 88 870 4 24 V AC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz 230 V AC 50/60 Hz SHSD 88 870 4 24 V AC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz 230 V AC 50/60 Hz
Functions Maximum timing (to be specified or ordering) H (2 wire) 60 min H (2 wire) 60 min H (2 wire) 60 min H (2 wire) 60 min Hp (2 wire) 100 s Hp (2 wire) 100 s Hp (2 wire) 100 s Hp (2 wire) 100 s Hd (2 wire) 60 min Hd (2 wire) 60 min Hd (2 wire) 60 min Hd (2 wire) 60 min Hi (4 wire) 60 min Hi (4 wire) 60 min Hi (4 wire) 60 min Hi (4 wire) 60 min H (3 wire) 100 s H (3 wire) 100 s H (3 wire) 100 s H (3 wire) 100 s H (3 wire) 100 s H (3 wire) 100 s H (3 wire) 100 s H (3 wire) 100 s Hp (2 wire) 60 min Hp (2 wire) 60 min Hp (2 wire) 60 min Hp (2 wire) 60 min
Features Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer
Code
General characteristics
Accuracy Repetition accuracy (with constant parameters) Variation according to VDE 0435 Reset time during timed delay Reset time after timing Immunity from micro power cuts Nominal current - I max at 20 C Nominal current - I min Maximum admissible current Leakage current at 20 o C Voltage drop at terminals Derating Electrical life (number of operations) Weight (g) Function H, Hd, Hi : 10 % Function Hp : -10 % +30 % 0.5 % 0 +40 C : 3 % -20 +60 C : 5 % 150 ms 150 ms < 20 ms 0.7 A Function H, Hi : 5 mA Function HB : 15 mA 20 A < 0.01 s Function H, Hi : 2 mA Function HB : 6 mA Function H, Hi : 3.5 V Function HB : 8 V 5 mA / C > 10 8 H, Hd, Hp : 50 Hi : 60
To order, see page 6. Accessories, dimensions, function and use, Other information, see page 61.
54
Curves
Function Hb Function Hp Function Hd
Function Hi
Function H
Connections
SHSB SHSBP SHSBD
2
SHIS SHS SHSP
~
S A2 18 A1
~
SHSD
To order, see page 6. Accessories, dimensions, function and use, Other information, see page 61.
55
S/SE timers
Specifications
Type Voltage 24 V AC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz 230 V AC 50/60 Hz 24 V AC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz 230 V AC 50/60 Hz 24 V AC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz 230 V AC 50/60 Hz 10 50 V AC 50/60 Hz 40 240 V AC 50/60 Hz 10 50 V AC 50/60 Hz 40 240 V AC 50/60 Hz
SDSB 88 870 5
SDSBP 88 870 5
SDSB 88 870 5
Functions Maximum timing (to be specified or ordering) E 10 min E 10 min E 10 min E 10 min Ep 10 min Ep 10 min Ep 10 min Ep 10 min Ed 10 min Ed 10 min Ed 10 min Ed 10 min E1 1s E1 1s E2 1s E2 1s
Features Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with integral potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer Adjustable timing with remote potentiometer Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing
Code
General characteristics
Accuracy Repetition accuracy (with constant parameters) Variation according to VDE 0435 Reset time during timed delay Immunity from micro power cuts Nominal current - I max at 20 C Nominal current - I min Maximum admissible current Leakage current at 20 o C Voltage drop at terminals Derating Electrical life (number of operations) Weight (g) Functions E, Ed : 10 % Functions Ep, E1, E2 : -10 % +30 % 0.5 % (E, Ep, Ed) 0 +40 C : 3 % -20 +60 C : 5 % 150 ms < 20 ms Functions E, Ed, Ep : 0.7 A Functions E1, E2 : 1 A Functions E, Ed, Ep : 15 mA Functions E1, E2 : 10 mA 20 A < 0.01 s 6 mA Functions E, Ed, Ep : 8 V Functions E1, E2 : 5 V Functions E, Ed, Ep : 5 mA / C Functions E1, E2 : 10 mA / C > 108 E, Ed, Ep : 50 E1, E2 : 60
To order, see page 6. Accessories, dimensions, function and use, Other information, see page 61.
56
Connections
SDSB SDSBP SDSBD
SDS1A or 2A
2
Curves
Function E Function Ep Function Ed
Function E1
Function E2
To order, see page 6. Accessories, dimensions, function and use, Other information, see page 61.
57
S/SE timers
Specifications
SGSI 88 870 7
Voltage 24 V AC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz 230 V AC 50/60 Hz 24 V AC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz 230 V AC 50/60 Hz
Functions La : cyclic, pause start La : cyclic, pause start La : cyclic, pause start La : cyclic, pause start L : cyclic, pulse start L : cyclic, pulse start L : cyclic, pulse start L : cyclic, pulse start
Maximum timing (to be specified or ordering) T on : 60 min / T off : 60 min T on : 60 min / T off : 60 min T on : 60 min / T off : 60 min T on : 60 min / T off : 60 min T on : 60 min / T off : 60 min T on : 60 min / T off : 60 min T on : 60 min / T off : 60 min T on : 60 min / T off : 60 min
Features Code Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing
General characteristics
Precision Repetition accuracy (with constant parameters) Variation according to VDE 0435 Reset time during timed delay Reset time after timing Immunity from micro power cuts Output specification Nominal current - I max at 20 C Nominal current - I min Maximum admissible current Leakage current at 20 o C Voltage drop at terminals Derating Electrical life (number of operations) Weight (g) 0.5 % 0 +40 C : 3 % -20 +60 C : 5 % 200 ms 200 ms (SFS) < 20 ms 0.7 A 5 mA 20 A < 0.01 s 5 mA 3.5 V 5 mA / C > 108 55
Curves
Function La Function L
Connections
SGS - SGSI
58
S/SE timers
Percentage timer
Solid state output Mono-funtion Mono-range-timing fixed Mono-voltage Solid state output 0.7 A at 20 C Percentage timer Fully sealed for protection by encapsulation in polyurethane resin Connection by 6.35 mm Faston blade terminals
Specifications
Type SFS 88 870 9 Voltage 24 V AC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz 230 V AC 50/60 Hz Functions X X X X Maximum timing (to be specified or ordering) T1 : 60 min / T2 : 60 min T1 : 60 min / T2 : 60 min T1 : 60 min / T2 : 60 min T1 : 60 min / T2 : 60 min Features Code Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing
General characteristics
Accuracy Repetition accuracy (with constant parameters) Variation according to VDE 0435 Reset time during timed delay Reset time after timing Immunity from micro power cuts Nominal current - I max at 20 C Nominal current - I min Maximum admissible current Leakage current at 20 o C Voltage drop at terminals Derating Electrical life (number of operations) Weight (g) 10 % 0.5 % 0 +40 C : 3 % -20 +60 C : 5 % 200 ms 200 ms (SFS) < 20 ms 0.7 A 5 mA 20 A < 0.01 s 5 mA 3.5 V 5 mA / C > 108 55
Curves
Function X
Connections
SFS
59
S/SE timers
Compressor timer
Solid state output Mono-funtion Mono-range-timing fixed Mono-voltage Solid state output 0.7 A at 20 C Specially suitable for compressors and heat pumps Fully sealed for protection by encapsulation in polyurethane resin Connection by 6.35 mm Faston blade terminals
Specifications
Type Voltage Functions ACC1 : Anti-short cycle special compressor model ACC1 : Anti-short cycle special compressor model ACC1 : Anti-short cycle special compressor model ACC1 : Anti-short cycle special compressor model ACC2 : Anti-short cycle special compressor model ACC2 : Anti-short cycle special compressor model ACC2 : Anti-short cycle special compressor model ACC2 : Anti-short cycle special compressor model ACC3 : Anti-short cycle special compressor model ACC3 : Anti-short cycle special compressor model ACC3 : Anti-short cycle special compressor model ACC3 : Anti-short cycle special compressor model
SASX 88 870 8
24 V AC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz 230 V AC 50/60 Hz SASC 88 870 0 24 V AC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz 230 V AC 50/60 Hz SASCB 88 870 6 24 V AC 50/60 Hz 48 V AC 50/60 Hz 110 V AC 50/60 Hz 230 V AC 50/60 Hz
Maximum timing (to be specified or ordering) 10 min 10 min 10 min 10 min 10 min 10 min 10 min 10 min 180 s - 240 s - 330 s 180 s - 240 s - 330 s 180 s - 240 s - 330 s 180 s - 240 s - 330 s
Features Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing Fixed timing
Code
General characteristics
Accuracy Repetition accuracy (with constant parameters) Variation according to VDE 0435 Reset time during timed delay Reset time after timing Immunity from micro power cuts Nominal current - I max at 20 C Nominal current - I min Maximum admissible current Leakage current at 20 o C Voltage drop at terminals Derating Electrical life (number of operations) Weight (g) 88 870 8 / 88 870 0 : 10 % 88 870 6 : 30 % 88 870 8 / 88 870 0 : 0.5 % 88 870 6 : 4 % 0 +40 C 88 870 8 / 88 870 0 : 3 % 0 +40 C 88 870 6 : 10 % 88 870 8 / 88 870 0 : 100 ms 25 ms < 20 ms 0.7 A 10 mA 20 A < 0.01 s 6 mA 88 870 8 / 88 870 0 : 3.5 V, 88 870 6 : 8 V 5 mA / C > 108 60
Curves
Function ACC1 Function ACC2 Function ACC3
Connections
SASX SASC SASCB
60
Accessories
TRPe compatible potentiometer for remote setting of timing period Code 79 238 250
Dimensions
IP40
Other information
Non stocked, minimum order quantity 100 units
61
NFR
Frost formation monitored by tamperature probe. Choice of defrosting time.
Specifications
Type NFR Code 88 899 204
General characteristics
Supply voltage Maximum frequency variations Choice of total compressor operating time before defrosting (using switch on underside of unit) Defrosting time Temperature 01 Temperature 02 Probe Length of temperature probe cable Absorbed power Weight (g) Relay outputs Type of contacts Breaking capacity Maximum breaking current Minimum breaking current Max. breaking voltage Electrical life (number of operations) Mechanical life (operations) Terminals Temperature limits (use) according to IEC 62.2.14 - Casing Temperature limits (use) according to IEC 62.2.14 - Probe Relative humidity (acc. to IEC 68.2.30) Temperature limits (stored) for casing and probe acc. to IEC 68.2.1/2 Degree of protection (IEC 529) Front face Protection (IEC 529) Housing Electromagnetic compatibility 90 260 V AC 50/60 Hz 1 Hz 25 min, 50 min, 75 min, 90 min 10 min 10 % -3 C +18 C KTY - 1 k 1.6 m 36 VA 155 1 changeover AgNi - cadmium-free 2000 VA AC resistive ; 80 W 8 V AC DC 10 mA AC DC 250 VAC 105 at 2000 VA resistive 20 x 106 faston type 6.35 mm 0 +55 C -20 +70 C 93 % -25 +70 C IP 20 IP 40 IEC 255.22.1 class III IEC 1000.4.2/3/4/5/6 level 3 IEC 1000.4.II EN 55022 class B 2.5 kV AC / 1 min / 1 mA / 50 Hz < 100 M at 500 V DC 5 kV / wave 1.2 / 50 s IEC 664-1
Breakdown voltage according to IEC 255-5 Insulation resistance (IEC 255.5) Shock resistance according to IEC 664-1/225.5 with the unit switched off Insulation coordination
Dimensions
NFR
77 5
78,5
72 22,5
62
Connections B Auxiliary power supply contact C Compressor control thermostat D Compressor contactor coil E Compressor control F Probe G Power supply H Defrost control
1
Th
4
B1 B1
Z1 Z2
Z1 Z2 A1 A2 11 R 14 12
2
3
6
7
A1 A2 11 14 12
Principles
Operating principle
S1
S2
+18C -3 C t1 ON OFF T= t1 + t2 + t3 t2 t3
The NFR defrost relay can be used to optimize the operation of the exchanger in air-conditioning or refrigeration unit. Compact in size, and with IP20 protection, it is easy to install using screws or by fixing on a DIN rail. The temperature probe supplied with the NFR relay can be disconnected, and should be placed on the exchanger. The standard length of the cable between the probe and the NFR relay is 1.6 m. Other lengths are available to order depending on quantity. With a choice of different defrosting times, the unit is easily adapted to the particular installation conditions. Operating mode
10mn
In an air-conditioning system, when the surface temperature of the exchanger between the cooling fluid and the air is too low, frost forms on the surface and the exchanger performs less efficiently. Defrosting is then necessary by reversing the cycle or using heating resistors. When the the total operating time of the set reaches time T (eg : 50 min) while the surface temperature of the exchanger is below 01 (- 3 C) , the defrost cycle is determined as time t (10 min). The defrost cycle stops before the end of this time period if the temperature of the cold exchanger exceeds 02 (18 C). If pressed for more than 2 seconds, the button on the top initiates a defrost cycle (if the probe temperature is below 18 C). This stops automatically at the end of 10 minutes or immediately if one of the power supply wires (terminals A1 or A2) or probe wires (terminals Z1 or Z2) is disconnected momentarily.
63
TOP 2000
Multi-function Multi-range Mono-voltage 1 timed changeover + 1 instantaneous contact Elapsed time can be saved mechanically in the event of a break in supply Progress of a cycle displayed Housing for DIN rail mounting
Specifications
Type 6 s - 12 min
Functions Multi-function : 2 - 3 - 4
Code 88 225 013 88 225 019 88 225 012 88 225 011 88 225 016 88 225 017 88 225 015 88 225 014
6 min - 12 h
Multi-function : 2 - 3 - 4
Options
Inverter for DC supply 24 - 48 V Inverter for DC supply 110 . 127 V Code 84 861 501 84 861 503
Dimensions
1 2
B Fixing holes 5
64
General characteristics
Precision Precision limit error Repetition accuracy Reset time Output specification Timed two-pole Instantaneous single pole Thermal rating Rating (cos = 0.41) 104 operations Function and use Voltage variation at maximum temperature of 55 oC according to IEC 255 100 Absorbed power-motor Operator factor Temperature limit operation (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Environmental protection Tropicalised to IEC 68-2-10 Vibration withstand on 3 axes (Veritas standard) Dielectric test voltage according to IEC 255 5 or VDE 0435 Insulation according to standard VDE 0110 group C Protection Housing Protection Terminal Conformity to standards NFC 45250 - VDE 0110 - 0435 - 0660 or ICE 255 - 1 - 00 Connection : By screws in front face with self-lifting grips Terminal capacity Single-wire Terminal capacity : Multi-wire with self-crimping ferrules Mounting by screw Mounting : on symmetrical DIN rail 35 mm (EN 50002) Weight (g) 2 % (5 % / 6 s) 1.5 % (4 % / 6 s) 0.20 s 1 1 6.3 A 5 A - 230 V 24 V +10 % - 42 V -15 % - 48 V +10 % - 110 V -20 % - 127 V 0 % - 220 V 20 % - 240 V 0 % 3 VA cos 0.7 100 % -10 +55 C -20 +70 C
185
Connections
Function 2
23 15 16
Function 3
MI AR A1 MS A2
Function 4
23 24
MA A1
MS
MI AR
23
24
24 18
A2
15 18 16 MS
Function 4 : On energisation, chance of contact bounce on instantaneous contact for 250 ms Internal layout Terminal identification
Curves
Function 2 Function 3 Function 4
Other information
For 60 Hz frequency please consult us
65
Machine safety
Our products are compatible with standard EN 60204-1 (IEC 201-1) concerning the safety of electrical equipment for machinery.
Approval markings
National approvals Conformity
UL
ASE CSA BV VDE
Switzerland Canada
United States
France
Germany
66
www.crouzet.com
67
Selection guide
Function Output Voltage 12 to 240 VDC 24 to 240 VAC 2 relays 24 VAC/DC 110 VAC 220 to 240 VAC MONO-FUNCTION 8-pin TIMER 812 LCD display Connection Designation TMR 48 A
0.1 s to 1 s 0.5 s to 10 s A 100 to 240 VAC/DC MBA 2F 22 mm Screw terminals MBA 3F 22 mm 400 mA 3 s to 60 s 0.5 min to 10 min Solid state 3 min to 60 min 0.1 s to 1 s 0.5 s to 10 s 24 VDC 200 mA 3 s to 60 s 0.5 min to 10 min 3 min to 60 min 12 to 240 VDC 24 to 240 VAC 12 to 240 VDC 24 to 240 VAC 12 to 240 VDC 24 to 240 VAC 12 VDC / 24 VDC A-Ab-B-C D-Di-H-T 1 relay 24 VAC / 42 to 48 VAC 100 to 127 VAC / 220 to 240 VAC 12 VDC / 24 to 48 VAC/DC 24 VAC/DC / 110 to 240 VAC 24 VAC/DC / 48 VAC/DC A-B-C D Di-H 1 relay 24 VAC/DC / 110 VAC 8-pin 11-pin 8-pin 11-pin 8-pin 11-pin 8-pin 11-pin 11-pin 8-pin TIMER 814 LCD display 8A 11-pin TIMER 815 LCD display 0.01 s to 999.9 h Page 82 TIMER 816 TIMER 816 LCD display TOP 948 8A 0.01 s to 999.9 h Page 86 TIMER 814 LCD display Page 82 11-pin TOP 948 LCD display 5A 0.01 s to 999.9 h Page 78 MBA Page 90 TIMER 812
A-B-C-WG-Ac-Bw
2 relays
11-pin
TMR 48 U
5A
0.02 s to 300 h
Page 74
8-pin
TMR 48 X
5A
0.02 s to 300 h
Page 74
8-pin
TMR 48 L
5A
0.02 s to 300 h
Page 74 TMR 48
MULTI-FUNCTION
24 VAC/DC / 220 to 240 VAC 12 VDC / 24 to 48 VAC/DC 24 VAC/DC / 110 to 240 VAC A1-A2-AM AMt 2 relays 12 VDC / 42 to 48 VAC/DC 24 VDC / 220 to 240 VAC 24 VAC/DC / 110 VAC
68
1 relay
2 relays
3 relays
Function
Output
Voltage
Designation
Rated current
Timing 6 s to 12 min
Connection Screw terminals 8-pin Screw terminals 8-pin Page 92 Screw terminals TOP 2000 8-pin
24 VAC
MULTI-FUNCTION
2-3-4
1 relay
69
Basic principles
Timers
A timer is a control component which, after a preset time, energises an output contact. The start of a timing cycle, single or repetitive, is produced by timer energisation or by maintained or pulse control contacts with, as a result, a large number of potential functions. There are two types of presentation:
Insulation to standard VDE 110 group C, IEC 255.5 and IEC 664
Spcifications pour le dimensionnement des lignes de fuite et distance dans l'air du matriel lectrique.
Protection
To IEC 529: classification of the levels of protection obtained by casings, terminal against solid matter against liquids
Panel-mounted
Product designed to be fitted on a panel in order to be accessible by the user. There are two types of output: Timed contacts dependent on the value of the set time. Instantaneous contacts operating simultaneously with the energisation or de-energisation of the product in instantaneous fashion (excluding certain cases, for example: memory).
Note:
Electro-mechanical timers with automatic reset are fitted with: either a standard clutch : during timing, the electro-clutch is energised or a reversed clutch : during timing the electro-clutch is de-energised. Timers with manual reset require "manual" intervention for the commencement of a new cycle which involves resetting the timing selector.
Electromagnetic compatibility
Electromagnetic compatibility tests measure the degree of immunity which a piece of equipment shows to various types of disturbance as defined in IEC standards.
Definitions
Minimum control contact time
This is the minimum pulse time required to effect timing control.
Controls
Quality control
Our products are quality controlled systematically during assembly and on completion. The overseeing of control checks in the workshop, the use of collected data and any resulting product assessments form the essential role of Quality Control. All our products undergo a final check, either 100% or on a selective basis according to French standard X 06-022, which provides for a classification of possible defects in three groups : critical, major, minor.
Accuracy
This is the maximum difference between the selected and the actual timing of the cycle chosen. It is expressed as a percentage of the maximum value of the timing range considered within normal operating parameters.
Note:
According to customer requirements and for certain product ranges which must meet particular requirements expressed in a specification, it is always possible to create or to modify a quality standard on the basis of a normal or special existing product and to vary the level of inspection. It can happen that the tolerance level is set at zero for certain parameters directly linked to the completion of a function for which total success must be assured: a defect is therefore fatal. Such specific requirements do, however, entail a significant increase in product costs.
Thermal intensity
Current limit in continuous duty for a circuit with the highest possible level of current which a previously closed contact circuit can tolerate at all times in specified conditions.
Contact rating
This is the value of the current that can be switched by a contact in certain specified conditions.
70
Machine safety
Our products are compatible with standard EN 60204-1 (IEC 201-1) concerning the safety of electrical equipment for machinery.
Approval markings
National approvals Conformity
3
BV VDE
UL
ASE CSA
Switzerland Canada
United States
France
Germany
71
FUNCTIONS
U : Supply R : Output or load relay T : Timing C (Y1) : Control contact : indefinite
1 relay
U C R T U C R1/R2
1 relay
U R T U R1/R2
R2 INST T
T R2 Inst.
A output relay R (or the load) changes state, and remains in the changed-over state for the timing period, both when control contact C (Y1) closes and when it opens.
U C R T U T
R T T
U C
R1/R2 R2 Inst.
After energisation, once the control contact is closed the output state changes. Timing will only begin on the re-opening of this control contact (one shot). Relay R returns to its initial position at the end of the timing period.
2 relays timed or 1 relay timed and 1 instantaneous
U C R T
U C R1/R2
R2 inst. T
Function D ou Di : Flip-flop
Repetitive cycle which switches the output alternately between the rest and operating position for equal time bases. T1 + T2 = T total Function D: the cycle begins with the output in rest position. Pause start.
2 relays timed or 1 relay timed and 1 instantaneous 1 relay
U R T T U R1/R2 T T R2 Inst.
1 relay
Function Di: the cycle begins with the output in the operating position. Pulse start.
U R T T U
R1/R2 T T R2 Inst.
U R1/R2 T R2 Inst.
72
Function Ht :
Provides a cumulative time for contact opening. On energisation, the output changes state, remains in that state for the duration of timing and resets at the end of the single cycle.
U C R t1 t2 T = t1+t2
U C
R1/R2 R2 Inst.
Calculates the total opening time of a contact. At the end of timing, the output is energised for approximately 500 ms.
U C R t2 t1 T= t1+t2 P
Function Q : "Star-delta"
At the end of timing, the output is not energised. It remains "open" (not conducting) and will only change state after the fixed time of Ti has elapsed. Dwell time selectable
U R T Ti
U R1/R2 T1 T2
b - energisation by supply voltage The timer sums the times for which the supply voltage (U) is on. Reset is by the reset signal (C2) only
Function T :
Impulse relay
U C R
8 8 8
U R1/R2 T1 T2
After power-up, pressing or holding down the switch closes the relay. Pressing the switch a second time opens the relay.
Function N : "Safe-guard"
At the first control pulse the output is energised. To complete the timing the interval between the two control pulses must be greater than the timing set.
U C R T
Function Tt :
After power-up, pressing or holding down the switch closes the relay and starts timing. The relay opens at the end of timing or when the switch is pressed a second time.
73
Analogue TMR 48
TMR 48
Multi-function or mono-function Multi-range from 0.02 s to 300 h Multi-voltage 12 to 240 VDC / 24 to 240 V AC Time setting displayed on dial 2 changeover relays 5 A / 250 VAC Display of power and output states by 2 LEDs Housing 48 x 48 mm
Specifications
Type TMR 48 U TMR 48 A TMR 48 X TMR 48 L Functions A, B, C, W, G, Ac, Bw A A1, A2, H1, H2, Q1, Q2, D-Di L, Li, G, Gi Relay outputs 2 timed changeover 2 timed changeover Max. breaking current 5 A / 250 VAC 5 A / 250 VAC Supply voltage 12 240 VDC 24 240 VAC 12 240 VDC 24 240 VAC 12 240 VDC 24 240 VAC 12 240 VDC 24 240 VAC Connection Plug-in 11 way Plug-in 8 way Plug-in 8 way Plug-in 11 way Code 88 886 016 88 886 106 88 886 116 88 886 516
2 changeover or 1 timed 5 A / 250 VAC and 1 instantaneous 2 timed changeover 5 A / 250 VAC
3
Accessories
11-pin connector base 8-pin connector base Spring clips (packet of 2) Black front face. For grey and other colours
General characteristics
Supply voltage Un Operating range Frequency Power consumption 12 240 VDC 24 240 V AC 10 % DC supply - 15 % / + 10 % AC supply 50 / 60 Hz 4.8 VA / 230 VAC 2.5 VA / 110 VAC 1.1 VA / 24 VAC 0.5 W / 24 VDC 0.8 W / 12 VDC 0,02 1,2 s 0,2 12 min. 0,2 12 h 0,5 30 min. 0,5 30 h 0,05 3 s 2 120 min. 2 120 h 0,2 12 s 5 300 min. 5 300 h 0,5 30 s 2 120 s 5 300 s 0.5 % of full scale at 25C (typical with constant parameters) 0.05 % of full scale 5 % of full scale at 25C 25 ms 60 ms 60 ms 50 ms 2x5A 250 VAC 2000 VA 10 mA 105 30 x 106 Green : power ON, flashing during timing Yellow : ON output ON, OFF output OFF -20 +55 -40 +70 2 KV IP 50 IP 40 self-extinguishing 140
Repetition accuracy Temperature drift according to CEI/EN 61812 Display accuracy Minimum pulse duration START Minimum pulse duration GATE Minimum pulse duration RESET Start-up delay after power cut (START linked) Output specification Nominal rating Nominal insulation voltage Rated power (resistive load) Minimum current Electrical life at I max. 250 V AC resistive (number of operations) Mechanical life (operations) Function and use Display of output state by 2 LEDs Operating temperature range (C) Storage temperature range (C) Breakdown voltage Protection class (IEC 60529) - Panel-mounted Protection class (IEC 60529) - Casing Material housing Weight (g)
To order, see page 6
74
Dimensions
TMR 48 U / A / X / L
44,4
39
6,8
64,5 96,8
15,5 48
48
Panel cut-out
45
68,2 52 7,8
1,1 1,5
B 7 31 8 4 1 3 2
35
6,4
30 38
24,2
Connections
TMR 48 U TMR 48 A TMR 48 X
45
3,5
15
~
+
U Reset Start Gate 5 4 3 R1 2 1 R2 10 11 6 7 8 9
~
+
U 4 3 R1 2 1 R2 8 5 6 7
~
+
U 4 3 2 R1 1 R2 8 5 6 7
~
TMR 48 L
~
+
U
Gate
R1
2
R2
10 1 11
7
L G
Curves
Function A (TMR 48 A) Delay on energisation
U (2
R2 ( 5 R1 ( 1
7
)
) )
T T
)
) )
T T
)
) )
6 8 3 4
6 8 3 4
6 8 3 4
Function Q1 Star-delta
U (2 R2 ( 5 R1 ( 1
7
) )
) )
) ) ) T Ti
6 8
R1 ( 1
3 4
) T T
R1 ( 1
3 4
) T T
3 4
T Ti
75
Function Q2 Star-delta 2
U (2
7
R2 ( 5 R1 ( 1
6 8
3 4
) )
R2 ( 5 R1 ( 1
6 8
3 4
) )
T Ti
T Ti
T T
T T
)
)
)
)
3 4
3 4
9 11 )
R2 ( 8
9 11 )
t1
t2
T= t1+t2
t1 t2 T= t1+t2
) )
) )
) ) ) )
9 11 )
9 11 )
t1 t2 T=t1+t2
t1 t2 T=t1+t2
) ) ) ) T P T P T T t2 P t3 t4 P P = t1+t3+t4 T = t1+t2 t1
) ) ) )
3 4
9 11 )
9 11 )
t1 t2 t1 t2 T=t1+t2 T=t1+t2
)
)
)
)
5
7
3 4
9 11 )
t1 t2 T=t1+t2
t1 T=t1+t2
t2
Li
Gi
) ) ) )
3 4
9 11 )
Ton
Ton
Ton t1 t2 t1 t2
Ton P
Ton P t1
t2 t3
Ton T
Toff Toff
76
77
TOP 948
Relay output digital timer Multi-voltage (voltage range) 1 changeover relay Elapsed time can be saved in the event of a break in supply Optional locking via keyboard of Reset key and access to timing values Connection by 11-pin base Housing 48 x 48 mm
Specifications
Type TOP 948 Functions A - Ab - B - C - D - Di - H - T A - Ab - B - C - D - Di - H - T A - Ab - B - C - D - Di - H - T Relay outputs 1 timed changeover 1 timed changeover 1 timed changeover Supply voltage 12/24 V DC 24 / 42.48 VAC 110.127/220.240VAC Nominal rating 5 A AC 5 A AC 5 A AC Code 88 857 502 88 857 504 88 857 508
Accessories
3
11-pin connector socket 11-pin rear base 11-pin solder-connected plug Asymmetrical adaptor Spring clips
Code 25 622 077 79 694 002 25 622 076 79 694 005 79 237 790
Dimensions
Panel cut-out 11-pole rear base 79 694 002 Panel-mounted
47 25 20,5 7
47
47
8,7
33
48
PR
48
78
General characteristics
Display Number of digits Height of digits Precision Timing ranges (7 programmable ranges) Repetition accuracy (even with variation of temperature) * if start T ON Display accuracy Reset time by de-energisation Reset time by control contact Reset time by reset to zero Input specification Control and zero-reset input - By contact Control and zero-reset input - Solid state PNP Level 0 Control and zero-reset input - Solid state PNP Level 1 Impedance Min. control pulse Output specification Nominal rating Nominal insulation voltage Maximum power rating (resistive) Electrical life at I max., 250 V AC resistive (cycles) Mechanical life (operations) Max. permitted number of operations per hour at 5 A 250VAC resistive Function and use Functions and EEPROM configuration stored for (years) Voltage variation Immunity from micro power cuts Maximum power consumption 4 8 mm 99.99 s - 999.9 s - 99 min 59 s - 99.99 min - 999.9 min - 99 h 59 min 999.9 h 0.005 % 20 ms 50 ms * 0.05 % 20 ms 0.05 s 0.05 s 0.05 s
0 1 V 4 30 V 10 k 10 % 50 ms 5 A V AC 1 A V DC 250 V AC DC 1250 VA - 30 W 10 5 2 x 10 7 360 10 + 10 % - 15 % 3 ms 0.5 W/12 V DC 1 W/24 V DC 1.3 VA/24 V AC 4 VA/48 V AC 8 VA/115 V AC 17 VA/230 V AC -10 +50 -25 +70
Temperatures limits use (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Protection class according to NFC C 20010-IEC 529-DIN 40050 Panelmounted Insulation according to standard VDE 0110-IEC 255 group C Breakdown voltage according to IEC 255-5 Test on power supply (IEC-801-4 level 3) Test on input signal (IEC-801-4 level 3) Damped oscillatory wave (IEC-255-4) Impulse voltage (IEC 255 5) Electrostatic discharge on face (IEC 801-2) Degree of protection front face Mounting Front panel, by clip Mounting base-mounted on socket Weight (g)
250 V AC DC 3 kV 2 kV 1 kV 3 kV 5 kV 15 kV IP 65
100
Connections
1
u
+
+ +
Start
RST
4 3 2
2
5 6 7
1 1 1
8 9 1 0
79
Curves
Function A Function Ab
Delay on energisation
2-10 2-5 2-7 1 3 4
t
t2
Cyclic timing
2-10 2-5 2-7 1 3 4
t
t
Cyclic timing
2-10 2-5 2-7 1 3 4
t1
t2
t
t
Timing on energisation
2-10 2-5 2-7 1 3 4
t
t1
t2
t1
t2
t1
t2
80
81
Specifications
Type Timer 812 Functions A A A A, B, C, D, Di, H A1, A2, AM, AMt A1, A2, AM, AMt A, B, C, D, Di, H A1, A2, AM, AMt A1, A2, AM, AMt A1, A2, AM, AMt Connections 8-pin plug-in 8-pin plug-in 8-pin plug-in 8-pin plug-in 11-pin plug-in 11-pin plug-in 11-pin plug-in 11-pin plug-in 11-pin plug-in 11-pin plug-in Relay outputs 1 double timed changeover 1 double timed changeover 1 double timed changeover 1 timed changeover 1 timed changeover or instantaneous 1 timed changeover or instantaneous 1 timed changeover 1 timed changeover or instantaneous 1 timed changeover or instantaneous 1 timed changeover or instantaneous Supply voltage 24 V AC DC 110 V AC 220 240 V AC 12 VDC/24 to 48V ACDC 24 V AC/110 to 240V AC 12 VDC/24 to 48V ACDC 24 V AC/110 to 240 V AC 12 V DC / 42 to 48 V AC DC 24 V AC DC / 110 V AC 24 V DC / 220 to 240 V AC Nominal rating 2x5A 2x5A 2x5A 8A 2x8A 2x8A 8A 2x8A 2x8A 2x8A Code 88 857 409 88 857 406 88 857 400 88 857 003 88 857 005 88 857 103 88 857 105 88 857 302 88 857 307 88 857 301
Timer 814
Timer 815
Accessories
Asymmetrical adaptor A 8-pin solder-connected plug 11-pin solder-connected plug Spring clips 11-pin connector socket 8-pin connector socket 11-pole rear base Code 79 694 005 25 622 301 25 622 076 79 237 790 25 622 077 25 622 128 79 694 002
Curves
Function A
2-10 1-3-4 T
Function A1
2-10
Function A2
2-10 1-3-4
1-3-4
8-9-11
8-9-11
t1<T t2<T T
t1<T t2<T
T=t1+t2
t1
t2
T=t1+t2
Flip-flop
Flip-flop
Timing or energisation
To order, see page 6
82
General characteristics
Display Number of digits Height of digits Precision Timing ranges Repetition accuracy (with constant parameters) Display accuracy Min. control pulse Maximum reset time by de-energisation during timed delay Maximum reset time by de-energisation after timing Output specification Nominal rating Max. breaking voltage Maximum power rating (resistive) Maximum admissible current Minimum current Electrical life at I max., 250 V AC resistive (cycles) Max. permitted number of operations at 1 max 250 V AC resistive per hour Mechanical life (operations) Function and use Voltage variation Immunity from micro power cuts Max. absorbed power 4 8 mm 99 99 s / 999 9 s / 9999 s / 99 mn 59 s / 99 99 mn / 999 9 mn 9999 mn / 99 h 59 mn / 99 99 h / 999 9 h / 9999 h 0.03 % 20 ms 0.03 % 20 ms 50 ms 50 ms 50 ms TIMER 814 - 815 : 8 A AC 8 A DC, TIMER 812 : 5 A AC 5 A DC 250 AC 30 V DC TIMER 814-815 : 2000 VA - 190 W, TIMER 812 : 1250 VA - 120 W 15 A < 0.01 s 100 mA 105 600 5 x 106 TIMER 814 : + 10 % -15 % < 0.03 s 0.5 W / 12 V 1 VA / 24 V 0.5 W / 24 V 3.5 VA / 110 V 1 W / 48 V 11 VA / 220 V -10 C +60 C -30 C +70 C IP65
Temperatures limits use (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Degree of protection front face Insulation according to standard VDE 0110-IEC 255 group C Protection class according to UTE C 20010 - IEC 529 - DIN 40050 Conformity to standards ICE 255 - VDE 0435 - 2021 Mounting Front panel, by clip Mounting base-mounted on socket Material Weight (g)
83
Dimensions
Panel cut-out
1
48
VALID
MODE
9,7 74,2 16
48
35,5
30,2
47
47
8,7
33
84
Connections
Timer 812 - 11-pin
2
Start
4 6
4 3
5 6 7
5 6 7 4 3 2 1 11 8 9 10
2-7 Supply 1-3-4 Timed output contact 8-5-6 Timed output contact
1
~
~ -
U
Start
-10
-7
4 3 2
5 6 7
1
~
2-10 Supply (2-11) Bridge 2-5 Control contact or reset 1-3-4 Timed output contact
2-7 Supply (2-8) Bridge 2-6 Control contact reset 1-3-4 Timed output contact
Reset
5 6 7 4 3 2 1 11 8 9 10
-10
4 9
2-10 / 2-7 Supply (2-7) Bridge 1-3-4 Timed output contact 8-9-11 Timed or instantaneous output contact
85
816
Relay output Multi-range Multi-voltage 1 relay output Access to programming locked Up or down timing mode Internal power supply by battery (10 years / 20C)
Specifications
Type Timer 816 Functions A, B, C, D, Di, H A, B, C, D, Di, H A, B, C, D, Di, H A, B, C, D, Di, H A, B, C, D, Di, H A, B, C, D, Di, H Connections 8-pin plug-in 8-pin plug-in 8-pin plug-in 11-pin plug-in 11-pin plug-in 11-pin plug-in Relay outputs 1 timed changeover 1 timed changeover 1 timed changeover 1 timed changeover 1 timed changeover 1 timed changeover Supply voltage 24 V AC DC/48 V AC DC 24 V AC DC/110 V AC 24 V AC DC/220.240 V AC 24 V AC DC/48 V AC DC 24 V AC DC/48 V AC DC 24 V AC DC/220. 240 V AC Nominal rating 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A 8A Code 88 857 604 88 857 607 88 857 601 88 857 704 88 857 707 88 857 701
Accessories
Asymmetrical adaptor A 8-pin solder-connected plug 11-pin solder-connected plug 8-pin solder-connected base Spring clips 11-pin connector socket 8-pin connector socket 11-pin rear base Code 79 694 005 25 622 301 25 622 076 79 694 016 79 237 790 25 622 077 25 622 128 79 694 002
Connections
Timer 816 - 11-pin
~ +
U
Start
U
Start
5 6 7 4 3 2 1 11 8 9 10
-10
5 6 7
3 2
~ -
1
~
2-10 Supply (2-11) Bridge for 24 V supply 2-5 Control contact reset 1-3-4 Timed output contact
-7
2-7 Supply (2-8) Bridge for 24 V supply 2-6 Control contact reset 1-3-4 Timed output contact
86
General characteristics
Display Number of digits Height of digits Precision Timing ranges 4 7 mm 99 99 s 999 9 s 9999 s 99 mn 59 s 99 99 mn 999 9 mn 9999 mn 99 h 59 mn 99 99 h 999 9 h 9999 h 0.03 % 20 ms 0.03 % 20 ms 50 ms 50 ms 50 ms 8 A AC 8 A DC 250 AC 30 V DC 2000 VA - 190 W 15 A < 0.01 s 100 mA 105 600 5 x 106 + 10 % - 15 % < 0.03 s 0.5 W/24 V 1.5 W/48 V 1 VA/24 V 1, 5, VA/48 V 4 VA/110 V 12 VA/230 V -10 +60 -30 +70 IP65
Repetition accuracy (with constant parameters) Display accuracy Min. control pulse Maximum reset time by de-energisation during timed delay Maximum reset time by de-energisation after timing Output specification Nominal rating Max. breaking voltage Maximum power rating (resistive) Maximum admissible current Minimum current Electrical life at I max., 250 V AC resistive (cycles) Max. permitted number of operations at 1 max 250 V AC resistive per hour Mechanical life (operations) Function and use Voltage variation Immunity from micro power cuts Maximum power consumption
Temperatures limits use (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Degree of protection front face Insulation according to standard VDE 0110-IEC 255 group C Protection class according to UTE C 20010 - IEC 529 - DIN 40050 Conformity to standards ICE 255 - VDE 0435 - 2021 Mounting Front panel, by clip Mounting base-mounted on socket Material Weight (g)
Curves
Function A
2-10 1-3-4 T
Function B
2-10 2-5/6
1-3-4
Function C
2-10 2-5/6 1-3-4
T
Flip-flop
Flip-flop
Timing or energisation
87
Dimensions
Panel cut-out
1
48
VALID
MODE
9,7 74,2 16
48
47
47
8,7
33
5,2
B 2 holes
Connector socket11-pin 25 622 077 8-pin 25 622 128
88
29
89
MBA
Solid state output Panel-mounted pushbutton-type timer Function A delay on energisation 10 timing ranges : 0.05 s to 60 min Supply 24 V DC and 110 240 V DC AC 50 60 Hz Fast adjustment of timing period on PLCs (compatible with IEC1131) IP 65
Specifications
Type MBA2F Functions A A A A A A A A A A Time ranges 0.1 s 1 s 0.5 s 10 s 3 s 60 s 0.5 min 10 min 3 min 60 min 0.1 s 1 s 0.5 s 10 s 3 s 60 s 0.5 min 10 min 3 min 60 min Output State State State State State State State State State State Supply voltage 100 240 V AC/DC 100 240 V AC/DC 100 240 V AC/DC 100 240 V AC/DC 100 240 V AC/DC 24 V DC 24 V DC 24 V DC 24 V DC 24 V DC Nominal rating 400 mA 400 mA 400 mA 400 mA 400 mA 200 mA 200 mA 200 mA 200 mA 200 mA Code 88 901 308 88 901 328 88 901 348 88 901 378 88 901 398 88 901 302 88 901 322 88 901 342 88 901 372 88 901 392
MBA3F
General characteristics
Precision Repetition accuracy (with constant parameters) Display accuracy Maximum reset time by de-energisation MBA3F during timed delay Maximum reset time by de-energisation MBA3F after timing Maximum reset time by de-energisation MBA2F after timing Maximum reset time by de-energisation MBA2F after timing Output specification Solid state open collector PNP output Voltage drop at terminals Nominal rating Leakage current Electrical life (number of operations) Protection against polarity inversions Protection against load short circuits Immunity from micro power cuts Function and use Display of output state by LED : output in operation Display of output state by LED : Power on Dielectric strength Ripple Consumption Temperatures limits use (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Varistor protection against overvoltage Drift Temperature Drift Voltage Conformity to standards VDE 0435 / ICE 255 / ICE 1131 / ICE 801 4 Protection class according to NFC C 20010-IEC 529-DIN 40050 Panelmounted Protection class according to NFC C 20010 - IEC 529 - DIN 40050 Terminal Material housing Terminal capacity Single-wire Terminal capacity Multi-wire with ferrule Terminal screws Tightening torque (Nm) Weight (g) +/-0.2 % 5% 7 ms 5 ms 60 ms 30 ms
MBA2F : 5 V AC MBA3F : 3 V DC MBA2F : 400 mA at 200C (derating 5 mA/C) MBA3F : 200 mA at 20 C (derating 1.5 mA/C) MBA2F : 5 mA AC MBA3F : 0.1 mA DC > 108 MBA3F MBA3F
1500 V / 50 Hz / 1 min 10 %
IP65 IP10
90
Dimensions
Panel cut-out
14,5
1
2
A 22,3mm - 0
+0,4
29
1 . 8 mm
47,5
50 min.
22
30 min.
Version 24 V DC on relay
+
18 A1 A2
Version 24 V DC on PLC
+ E S -
1
-
18 A1 A2
1 2
1
(+) (-)
B Load
B Load
B Input C Output
91
Top 2000
Relay output Mono-voltage 1 timed changeover and 1 instantaneous contact Elapsed time can be saved mechanically in the event of a break in supply Progress of cycle displayed Housing 48 x 48 mm Connection by screw-terminal base or 8-pin base
Specifications
Type 6 s - 12 mm Relay outputs 1 time changeover 5 A 1 instantaneous Functions Multi-function 2 - 3 - 4 Voltages 24 V AC 42 48 V AC 110 127 V AC 220 240 V AC 24 V AC 42 48 V AC 110 127 V AC 220 240 V 24 V AC - 50 Hz 24 VAC 50 Hz 42 48 V AC - 50 Hz 42 48 VAC 50 Hz 110 127 V AC - 50 Hz 110 127 VAC 50 Hz 220 240 V AC - 50 Hz 220 240 VAC 50 Hz Code 88 226 013 88 226 019 88 226 012 88 226 011 88 226 501 88 226 502 88 226 503 88 226 504 88 226 016 88 226 505 88 226 017 88 226 506 88 226 015 88 226 507 88 226 014 88 226 508
3
6 min - 12 h 1 timed changeover 5 A 1 instantaneous Multi-function 2 - 3 - 4
Accessories
Solder tag connector 8-pin 8-pin connector base Invertor for DC supply CC24 148 V DC Invertor for DC supply CC110 1127 V DC Code 25 622 301 25 622 128 84 861 501 84 861 503
Curves
Function 2 Function 3 Function 4
92
General characteristics
Precision Precision limit error Repetition accuracy Selection precision Reset time Output specification Timed two-pole Instantaneous single pole Thermal rating Rating (cos = 0.41) 104 operations Function and use Absorbed power--motor Voltage variation at maximum temperature of 55 oC according to IEC 255 100 2 % ( 5 %/6 s) 1.5 % ( 4 %/6 s) See "timing ranges" table for scale graduation 0.20 s 1 1 6.3 A 5 A - 230 V 3 VA cos 0.8 24 V +10 % - 42 V -15 % 48 V +10 % - 110 V -20 % 127 V 0 % - 220 V -20 % 240 V 0 % 100 % -10 +55 -20 70
Operator factor Temperatures limits use (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Environmental protection Tropicalised to IEC 68-2-10 Vibration withstand on 3 axes (Veritas standard) Dielectric test voltage according to IEC 255 5 or VDE 0435 Insulation according to standard VDE 0110 group C Protection Housing Protection Terminal Conformity to standards NFC 45250 - VDE 0110 - 0435 - 0660 or ICE 529 Connection : Screw/saddle Terminal capacity Single-wire 1 or 2 leads Multi-wire Terminal capacity Multi-wire 1 or 2 leads Mounting : Base mounting on 8-pin socket Weight (g)
185
Dimensions
88 226 0 88 226 5 Panel cut-out
B Fixing holes 5
Screw terminal or connector socket 26 622 128 - 8-pin
93
Connections
Function 2
23 15 16
Function 3
MI AR A1 MS A2
Function 4
23 24
MA A1
MS
MI AR
23
24
24 18
A2
15 18 16 MS
3
2-7 Supply 8-5-6 Timed contact 3-1 Instantaneous contact
94
95
Manual reset
Relay output Mono-function Mono-range Mono-voltage Manual reset Progress of cycle displayed Output : 1.2 or 3 changeover contacts (max of 16 A per contact) Mounting option
Specifications
Type 882564 Voltage 127/230 V AC 50 Hz Relay outputs Breaking capacity per contact 1 timed 16 A Version Maximum available timing 5 min 15 min 30 min 60 min 120 min 5h 15 h 30 h 5 min 15 min 30 min 60 min 120 min 5h 15 h 30 h 5 min 15 min 30 min 60 min 120 min 5h 15 h 30 h 4 min 40 s 14 min 28 min 56 min 1 h 53 min 4 h 43 min 14 h 10 min 28 h 20 min 4 min 40 s 14 min 28 min 56 min 1 h 53 min 4 h 43 min 14 h 10 min 28 h 20 min 4 min 40 s 14 min 28 min 56 min 1 h 53 min 4 h 43 min 14 h 10 min 28 h 20 min Dial graduation 15 s 30 s 1 min 2 min 30 s 5 min 5 min 30 min 1h 15 s 30 s 1 min 2 min 30 s 5 min 5 min 30 min 1h 15 s 30 s 1 min 2 min 30 s 5 min 5min 30 min 1h Code 88 256 401 88 256 402 88 256 403 88 256 404 88 256 405 88 256 406 88 256 407 88 256 408 88 256 506 88 256 507 88 256 508 88 256 509 88 256 510 88 256 511 88 256 512 88 256 513 88 256 906 88 256 907 88 256 908 88 256 909 88 256 910 88 256 911 88 256 912 88 256 913
3
882565 127/230 V AC 50 Hz 2 timed 16 A
882569
127/230 V AC 50 Hz
3 timed
16 A
Accessories
Invertor for DC supply 24 . 48 V Invertor for DC supply 110 . 127 V Code 88 861 501 88 861 503
General characteristics
Precision Precision limit error Output specification Timed two-pole Thermal rating Mechanical life (operations) Rating (cos = 0.41) 104 operations Function and use Voltage variation at maximum temperature of 55 oC according to IEC 255 100 Absorbed power--motor Operator factor Temperatures limits use (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Environmental protection Protected metal components - Insulated motor coil Vibration withstand on 3 axes (Veritas standard) Dielectric test voltage according to IEC 255-5 or VDE 0435 Insulation according to standard VDE 0110 group C Protection : terminal Operating position- any Connection : Tags Connection : Motor leads Mounting by screw Weight (g) 4% 1 or 2 or 3 20 A > 107 16 A - 230 V +10 % -15 % Un 3.1 VA cos 0.8 100 % -5 +70 -40 +80
96
Dimensions
Panel cut-out Inverter for DC supply 84 861 501 : 24 - 48 V DC 84 861 503 : 110 - 127 V DC Weight 150 g
B Fixing holes 5
Connections
1 pole
1 3 2
2 poles
1 3 2
3 poles
1 3 2
MS
MS
MS
U1
U2
2 poles
1
2
MS
U1
U2
Curves
1 pole 2 poles 3 poles
97
98
www.crouzet.com
99
100
Selection guide
Control function Output relay 1 changeover Loss or inversion of one of the phases 2 changeovers Total phase failure Phase sequence Voltage drop on one or more phases Total phase failure Phase sequence Voltage drop on one or more phases Asymmetry between phases of 5 to 15% 3 x 230 V AC 2 changeovers 3 x 400 V AC 3 x 230 V AC 2 changeovers 3 x 400 V AC 180 to 260 V AC 310 to 440 V AC Phase sequence Loss of one or more phases Undervoltage Supply voltage setpoint adjustable by potentiometer 320 to 460 V AC 2 changeovers 330 to 480 V AC 350 to 510 V AC 380 to 550 V AC 460 to 660 V AC 1 changeover 0.8 to 1.2 x supply voltage 2 changeovers FWA2 3 x 400 V AC FWA 3 x 400 V AC FW EWA2 3 x 400 V AC 3 x 230 V AC 3 x 380 V AC 3 x 400 V AC 3 x 415 V AC 3 x 440 V AC 3 x 480 V AC 3 x 575 V AC 3 x 230 V AC Asymmetry between phases of 5 to 20 % Phase sequence Loss of one or more phases with 95% regenerated supply voltage EW2 3 x 400 V AC 3 x 230 V AC 3 x 230 to 440 V AC EWS2 3 x 230 V AC Operating range Designation EWS Power supply
3 x 200 to 500 V AC
Page 120
Page 122
Page 124
3 x 230 V AC
4
VOLTAGE control relays
Supply configuration Self-powered Measurement range 0.2 to 60 V DC EUL 0.2 to 60 V AC/DC 120 V AC 230 V AC Page 138 15 to 600 V DC EUH 15 to 600 V AC/DC No 0.2 to 60 V DC HDU-L LCD Display 24 V DC 24 V AC 120 V AC 230 V AC Page 130 15 to 600 V DC HDU-H LCD Display 24 V DC 24 V AC 120 V AC 230 V AC 12 V DC EUS Yes 20 to 80 V AC/DC 65 to 260 V AC/DC EUSF 2 thresholds (high/low) 65 to 260 V AC/DC F3US - Phase-to-phase control 3-phase Yes F3USN - Control between phase and neutral 3 x 230 V AC 3 x 400 V AC Page 142 3 x 230 V AC 3 x 400 V AC F3US 45 mm casing 20 to 80 V AC/DC Page 140 HDU-L. HDU-H 36 mm casing LCD Display 120 V AC 230 V AC 24 V DC 24 V AC EUL 22.5 mm casing Designation Power supply 24 V DC 24 V AC
Single-phase
0.2 to 60 V AC/DC
15 to 600 V AC/DC
101
Page 134
24 V DC 24 V DC 24 V AC 24 V DC 24 V AC
EIL 2 to 500 mA HDI-L LCD Display ALTERNATING and DIRECT current EIH 0.1 to 10 A
Page 136
120 V AC 230 V AC
Page 130
)
Designation Power supply 3 x 230 V AC
Output relay
Controlling motor under/overload by measuring the phase shift between the voltage and the current ( )
FFP 45 mm casing
FRL 45 mm casing
102
230 VAC
1 relay
8A
Page 152
VRT 300
103
Level control
Specifications
Type ENR Characteristics Monitoring filling (UP) Monitoring emptying (DOWN) Voltages 24 V AC 48 V AC 120 V AC 230 V AC Code 84 870 201 84 870 202 84 870 203 84 870 204
General characteristics
Operating range Maximum power consumption Adjustable sensitivity Measurement accuracy (at maximum sensitivity) Electrode voltage (max) Electrode current (maximum) Maximum cable capacity Response time high level Response time low level Output relay (according to AC1 resistive load) Galvanic isolation via transformer (4 kV, 8 mm creepage distance) Isolation of contacts and electrodes from power supply Operating temperature range (C) Storage temperature range (C) Weight (g) 0.85 1.10 x Un 3 VA 5 k 100 k 30 % 24 V AC (50/60 Hz) 1 mA (50/60 Hz) 10 nF 300 ms 500 ms 1 AgNi changeover relay 8 A AC max. Class II VDE 0551 2.5 kV AC -20 +50C -40 +70C 150
Dimensions
ENR
32 3,5 63 22,5
A1 15 Y1
57
78
18 16 A2
95 5
Connections
ENR
U A1 C Min Max 11
A2
12
14
104
Principles
Monitoring filling or emptying ENR
Un
1
2
Down Up
Operating principle Monitoring maximum and/or minimum levels of conductive liquids (tap water, sea water, waste water, chemical solutions, coffee, etc). The principle is based on measuring the apparent resistance of the liquid between two submerged probes. When this value is lower than the preset threshold displayed on the units front panel, the output relay changes state. To prevent any occurrences of electrolysis, an AC current is passed through the probes. Areas of application include the agri-food, chemical and other industries. Adjusting two levels : Minimum/Maximum The output relay changes state when the level of liquid reaches the maximum electrode, with the minimum electrode submerged. It returns to its initial state when the minimum probe is no longer in contact with the liquid. Note If the power break T lasts for 1 second or more, the relay reenergises instantly when in "UP" mode and is de-energised when in "DOWN" mode.
Other information
The probe cable (maximum length 100 metres) does not have to be screened, but avoid mounting it in parallel with the power supply cables. A screened cable can be used with the screening connected to the common terminal.
105
Level control
Specifications
Type ENRM Characteristics Monitoring filling (UP) Monitoring emptying (DOWN) Voltages 24 V AC 48 V AC 120 V AC 230 V AC Code 84 870 211 84 870 212 84 870 213 84 870 214
General characteristics
Operating range Maximum power consumption Adjustable sensitivity Measurement accuracy (at maximum sensitivity) Electrode voltage (max) Electrode current (maximum) Maximum cable capacity Response time high level Response time low level Output relay (according to AC1 resistive load) Galvanic isolation via transformer (4 kV, 8 mm creepage distance) Isolation of contacts and electrodes from power supply Operating temperature range (C) Storage temperature range (C) Weight (g) 0.85 1.10 x Un 3 VA 250 1 M 30 % 24 V AC (50/60 Hz) 1 mA (50/60 Hz) 10 nF 300 ms 500 ms 1 AgNi changeover relay 8 A AC max. Class II VDE 0551 2.5 kV AC -20 +50C -40 +70C 150
Dimensions
ENRM
32 3,5 63 22,5
A1 15 Y1
57
78
18 16 A2
95 5
106
Connections
Adjusting two levels Monitoring filling "Up"
R S T N S
A1 11 C 11 12 14
Min Max 14 12 A2
Max 14 12 A2
2 3
M P
Max. Min.
Max.
Principles
Operating principle General principle : The ENRM monitors the levels of conductive liquids. The principle is based on measuring the apparent resistance of the liquid between two submerged probes. When this value is lower than the preset threshold displayed on the units front panel, the relay changes state. To prevent any occurrences of electrolysis, an AC current is passed through the probes. A rotary switch on the front panel can be used to select the desired function and sensitivity range. A level can be monitored using the 2nd rotary switch. In this instance, the max. probe remains above the liquid and an adjustable time delay prevents the wave effect. A green LED indicates that the supply voltage is present. A yellow LED indicates the output relays state. When the green and yellow LEDs are flashing, this indicates an incompatible adjustment position.
Monitoring a level, filling function, activation time (level : 1 - on delay, function Up LS (Low Sensitivity : 250 W to 5 kW) , Up St (Standard Sensitivity : 5 kW to 100 kW) , Up HS (High Sensitivity : 50 kW to 1 MW). When the level of liquid drops below the probe for a period exceeding the value of time delay T set on the front panel, the relay energises and remains on until the level of liquid reaches the probe again. If the level of liquid returns above the level set before the time delay elapses, the relay does not come on. Note When the power returns after a power break, the output relay only energises after time delay T if the level of liquid is below the threshold.
1
T T
T T
B Level C Relay
Monitoring a level, emptying function, activation time (level : 1 - on delay, function Dwn LS (Low Sensitivity : 250 W to 5 kW) , Dwn St (Standard Sensitivity : 5 kW to 100 kW) , Dwn HS (High Sensitivity : 50 kW to 1 MW). When the level of liquid rises above the probe for a period exceeding the value of time delay T set on the front panel, the relay energises and remains on until the level of liquid drops back below the probe. If the level of liquid drops back below the level set before the time delay elapses the relay does not come on. Note When the power returns after a power break, the output relay only energises after delay time T if the level of liquid is above the threshold.
1
T T
T T
B Level C Relay
107
Monitoring a level, filling function, deactivation time (level : 1 - off delay, function Up LS (Low Sensitivity : 250 W to 5 kW) or Up St (Standard Sensitivity : 5 kW to 100 kW) or Up HS (High Sensitivity : 50 kW to 1 MW). When the liquid level drops below the probe the relay energises immediately and remains on until the level of liquid reaches the probe again and remains above it for a period exceeding time delay T set on the front panel. If the level of liquid drops back below the level set before the time delay elapses, the relay remains on. Note When the power returns after a power break, the output relay energises immediately if the liquid level is below the threshold.
1
T T T T
B C
Level Relay
Monitoring a level, emptying function, deactivation time (level : 1 - off delay, function Dwn LS (Low Sensitivity : 250 W to 5 kW) or Dwn St (Standard Sensitivity : 5 kW to 100 kW) or Dwn HS (High Sensitivity : 50 kW to 1 MW). When the level of liquid rises above the probe the relay energises immediately and remains on until the level of liquid drops back below the probe for a period exceeding the value of time delay T set on the front panel. If the level of liquid returns above the level set before the time delay elapses the relay remains on. Note When the power returns after a power break, the output relay energises immediately if the level of liquid is above the threshold.
1
T T T
T
B Level C Relay
Monitoring two levels, emptying function
U
Monitoring two levels, emptying function (level : 2, function Dwn LS (Low Sensitivity : 250 W to 5 kW) , Dwn St (Standard Sensitivity : 5 kW to 100 kW) , Dwn HS (High Sensitivity : 50 kW to 1 MW). The output relay remains open as long as the level of liquid has not reached the maximum probe. Once the maximum level is reached the contact closes and the tank can then be emptied (valve opened, pump started, etc). When the level drops below the minimum level the contact opens and interrupts the emptying process. Note : when monitoring two levels the time delay preventing the wave effect is not in operation. Note When the power returns after a power break, the output relay energises immediately if the level of liquid is above the threshold.
1
2
3
Monitoring two levels, filling function (level : 2, function Up LS (Low Sensitivity : 250 W to 5 kW) or Up St (Standard Sensitivity : 5 kW to 100 kW) or Up HS (High Sensitivity : 50 kW to 1 MW). The output relay remains on as long as the level of liquid has not reached the maximum probe. As soon as the maximum level is reached the contact opens and pumping stops. When the level drops below the minimum level the contact closes again and pumping restarts to bring the level of liquid back up. Note : When monitoring the two levels the time delay preventing the wave effect is not in operation. Note When the power returns after a power break, the output relay energises immediately if the level of liquid is below the threshold.
1
2
3
The probe cable (maximum length 100 metres) does not have to be screened, but avoid mounting it in parallel with the power supply cables. A screened cable can be used with the screening connected to the common terminal.
108
109
Level control
Specifications
Type LN Supply voltage 24 V AC 120 V AC 230 V AC 24 V AC 120 V AC 230 V AC 230 V AC Base 8-pin 8-pin 8-pin 11-pin 11-pin 11-pin 11-pin (special base) Code 84 870 301 84 870 303 84 870 304 84 870 306 84 870 308 84 870 309 84 870 807
General characteristics
Supply voltage Un Operating range Max. absorbed power Adjustable sensitivity Measurement accuracy (at maximum sensitivity) Electrode voltage (max) Electrode current (maximum) Maximum cable capacity Response time high level Response time low level Output relay (according to AC1 resistive load) Galvanic isolation via transformer (4 kV, 8 mm creepage distance) Isolation of contacts and electrodes from power supply Temperature limit operation (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Weight (g) 230 V, 110 V, 48 V, 24 V AC, 50/60 Hz 0.85 1.15 x Un 3 VA 5 k 100 k 0 +30 % 24 V AC (50/60 Hz) 1 mA (50/60 Hz) 10 nF 300 ms 500 ms 1 AgCdO switch 8 A AC max. Class II VDE 0551 2.5 kV AC -20 +60 -30 +70 140
Dimensions
LN LN Connector sockets 11-pin: 25 622 078 8-pin : 25 622 129
70 39
2x5
50
27
65
38
3,5
16
110
Connections
LN
3
R S T
4 3 2
7 8 9 3 2
5 6 7
11
10
1
Max. Min.
M P
Principles
Emptying control
Un
Min. Max.
5
T
1
2
3
4
6
7
Operating principle Control of maximum and/or minimum levels of conductive liquids (tap water, sea water, waste water, chemical solutions, coffee etc). The principle is based on measurement of the apparent resistance of the liquid between two submerged probes. When this value is lower than the preset threshold on the unit front face, the output relay changes state. To avoid electrolytic phenomena, an AC current funs across the probes. Applications found in environmental, chemical industries and food technology etc. Regulation of two levels : Minimum / Maximum The output relay changes state when the level of liquid reaches the maximum electrode, with the minimum electrode submerged. It returns to its initial state when the minimum probe is no longer in contact with the liquid. Note The probe wire (maximum 100 metres) does not have to be screened, but avoid mounting it in parallel with the power supply wires. A screened wire can be used, with the screening connected to the common.
B Max. level C Min. level D Output relay E Down F Unit power-up G Controlled level H Empty function
111
Level control
Specifications
Type L2N Supply voltage 24 V AC 120 V AC 230 V AC 230 V AC Base 11-pin 11-pin 11-pin 11-pin (special base) Code 84 870 401 84 870 403 84 870 404 84 870 808
General characteristics
Supply voltage Un Operating range Max. absorbed power Adjustable sensitivity Measurement accuracy (at maximum sensitivity) Electrode voltage (max) Electrode current (maximum) Maximum cable capacity Response time high level Response time low level Output relay (according to AC1 resistive load) Galvanic isolation via transformer (4 kV, 8 mm creepage distance) Isolation of contacts and electrodes from power supply Temperatures limits use (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Weight (g) 230 V, 110 V, 48 V, 24 V AC, 50/60 Hz 0.85 1.15 x Un 3 VA 5 k 100 k 0 +30 % 24 V AC (50/60 Hz) 1 mA (50/60 Hz) 10 nF 300 ms 500 ms 1 AgCdO switch 8 A AC max. Class II VDE 0551 2.5 kV AC -20 +60 -30 +70 140
Dimensions
L2N L2N Connector sockets 11-pin: 25 622 078 8-pin : 25 622 129
70
39
2x5
50
27
65
38
3,5
16
Connections
L2N
R S T
4 3 2
7 8 9 10
11
4
Max Min Max Min
112
Principles
Emptying control
Un
1
Max.
2
Min. Max.
Operating principle Control of maximum and/or minimum levels of conductive liquids (tap water, sea water, waste water, chemical solutions, coffee etc). The principle is based on measurement of the apparent resistance of the liquid between two submerged probes. When this value is lower than the preset threshold on the unit front face, the output relay changes state. To avoid electrolytic phenomena, an AC current funs across the probes. Applications found in environmental, chemical industries and food technology etc. Combined Fill / Empty function The output relay changes state when the level of liquid in the tank reaches the "max" electrode, with the "min" electrode submerged. It returns to its initial state when the "min" sensor is no longer in contact with the liquid. When the level of liquid in the well reaches the "min" electrode, the pump stops. If, on power-up or after a power break, the "max" electrode in the tank is above the surface, reset the device by pressing the PB pushbutton. Note The probe wire (maximum 100 metres) does not have to be screened, but avoid mounting it in parallel with the power supply wires. A screened wire can be used, with the screening connected to the common.
3
Min.
113
Level control
Specifications
Type F2N Voltages 24 VAC 48 VAC 120 VAC 230 VAC Code 84 870 601 84 870 602 84 870 603 84 870 604
General characteristics
Power supply characterisitcs Operating range Nominal power Maximal power Immunity from micro power cuts Delay on pick-up Response time on power-down Insulation coordination 0.85 to 1.15 Un except 120 V AC : 0.85 to 1.1 Un 3 VA max. to Un + 15 % 4 VA to Un ; 15 % 10 ms T1 = 400 ms T4 = 500 ms Category III, degree of pollution conforming to IEC 664.1 / VDE 0110 : 4 KV/2 5 k to 100 k 30 % with maximum sensitivity 15 V AC (50 .. 60 Hz) 1 mA 30 % with maximum sensitivity T2 = 400 ms T3 = 700 ms 1 AgCdO changeover 2000 VA - 80 W 8 A AC DC 100 mA AC DC 250 V AC DC 5 x 106 2000 VA - 105 operations Cos = 0.3 - 6000 operations L/R = 300 ms - 6000 operations Self-extinguishing 2 x 1.5 mm2 with ferrule 2 x 2.5 mm2 without ferrule -20 +60 -30 +70 93 % (+2 % ; -3 %) 250
Control technical characteristics Sensitivity range Display accuracy Electrode voltage Electrode current Accuracy Response time on immersion Response time on emersion Output characteristics Output Breaking capacity Maximum breaking current Minimum breaking current Max. breaking voltage Mechanical life (operations) Electrical life AC 12 Electrical life AC 15 Electrical life AC 13 General characteristics Material housing Terminal capacity Temperature limit operation (IEC 68.1.14) (C) Temperature limits stored (IEC 68.1.1/2) (C) Relative humidity (no condensation) Weight (g)
114
Dimensions
F2N
3,5
23
77 5
4,2
78,5
89,7
100
45
Connections
F2N
L1 L2 L3 L4 C A1 11 R
Min. 1 Max. 1
99,3
57
A2 12 14 Min. Max.
2 2
11 2
Max. Min.
2 1
C
Max. Min.
3 3
4 4
Principles
Un Max2 Min2 1 Max1 Min1 2 R
3
Operating principle Control of filling a tank at 2 levels (Min1, Max1) with simultaneous emptying control of the well or supply tank at 2 levels (Min2, Max2) in order to protect the pump from draining. The principle is based on measurement of the apparent resistance of the liquid between the submerged probes. To avoid electrolytic phenomena, an AC current runs across the probes. In certain applications, a slight adjustment of the sensitivity enables the detection of undesirable elements such as the presence of foam or surface bubbles or the appearance of leakage impedance between probles (extended line capacity, humidity, etc). Filling / Emptying combined function The output relay changes state (de-energises) when the level of liquid in the tank reaches the Max1 proble, with the Min1 probe submerged. It returns to its initial state (reattaches) when the Min1 probe is no longer in contact with the liquid. When the level of liquid in the well reaches the Min2 probe, the pump stops (relay unstuck. Protection : prevents the pump from running when empty). If the well Max2 probe is not submerged on power-up or after a power cut, the device must be reactivated by pressing the pushbutton (P.B.).
T1
T2
T3
T4
B C D
T1 : Delay on pick-up T2 : Response time on emersion T3 : Response time on immersion T4 : Response time on power-down
115
Level control
Specifications
Type FN LS FN Voltages 230 VAC 24 VAC 48 VAC 120 VAC 230 VAC Code 84 870 803 84 870 501 84 870 502 84 870 503 84 870 504
General characteristics
Power supply characterisitcs Supply voltage Un Operating range Nominal power Maximal power Immunity from micro power cuts Delay on pick-up Response time on power up Insulation coordination Control technical characteristics Sensitivity range FN Sensitivity range FHLS Display accuracy Electrode voltage Electrode current Response time on immersion Response time on emersion Output characteristics Output Breaking capacity Maximum breaking current Minimum breaking current Max. breaking voltage Mechanical life (operations) Electrical life AC 12 Electrical life AC 15 Electrical life AC 13 General characteristics Material housing Terminal capacity Temperature limit operation (IEC 68.1.14) (C) Temperature limits stored (IEC 68.1.1/2) (C) Relative humidity (no condensation) Weight (g) 230, 120, 48 and 24 V AC 50/60 Hz galvanic isolation via transformer 0.85 to 1.15 Un except 120 V AC : 0.85 to 1.1 Un 3 VA at Un 4 VA at Un + 15 % 10 ms T1 = approx. 2 s T4 = 500 ms Category III, degree of pollution 2 conforming to IEC 664.1 / VDE0110 : 4 kV/2 5 k 100 k 250 5 k 30 % whith at maximum sensitivity 15 V AC (50/60 Hz) 1 mA T2 = 400 ms T3 = 700 ms 2 AgCdO changeover FN LS : 2000 VA FN : 80 W FN LS : 8 A AC FN : 8 A DC FN LS : 100 mA AC FN : 100 mA DC FN LS : 250 V AC FN : 250 V DC 2 x 106 2000 VA - 105 operations Cos = 0.3 - 6000 operations L/R = 300 ms - 6000 operations Self-extinguishing 2 x 1.5 mm2 with ferrule 2 x 2.5 mm2 without ferrule -20 +60 -30 +70 93 % (+2 % ; -3 %) 280
116
Dimensions
FN / FN LS
3,5
23
77 5
4,2
78,5
89,7
100
45
Connections
Regulating with "up" filling control
L1 L2 L3 L4
99,3
57
A1 - A2 : Supply voltage 11 - 12 - 14 : Output relay (R1) 21 - 22 - 24 : Alarm output relay (R2) C - Min - Max - Al. : Probe inputs
C A1 11 R1
Min. Max.
Al.
R2
A2 12 14 22 21 24
Al.
4
Al. Max.
Principles
Filling control with low alarm
1
Un Al. Max Min
On power-up, probe AI. is submerged, relays R1 and R2 are energised and the pump is ON : filling starts, the LED for relay R1 is lit. When the level reaches the Max probe, relay R1 de-energises and the pump is OFF : filling stops, the LED for relay R1 goes off. Relay R1 re-energises when the Min probe emerges. In the event of a fault (level continues to fall) probe AI. emerges, relay R2 deenergises and the alarm is triggered : the LED for relay R2 is lit. This fault can be stored
T3
R1 R2
T1
T2 T3
T2
T4
On power-up, the level in the tank is low, relays R1 and R2 are energised and the pump is ON : filling starts, the LED for relay R1 is lit. When the level reaches the Max probe, relay R1 deenergises and the pump is OFF : filling stops, the relay LED goes off. If, in the event of a fault, the level continues to rise and reaches proble AI., relay R2 de-energises and the alarm is triggered : the LED for relay R2 is lit.
R1 R2
117
On power-up, probes Min, Max and AI. are submerged, relays R1 and R2 are energised and the pump is ON : emptying starts, the LED for relay R1 is lit. When the Min probe emerges, relay R1 goes off. If, in the event of a fault, the level continues to fall and probe AI. emerges, relay R2 deenergises and the alarm is triggered : the LED relay R2 is lit. This fault can be stored.
R1 R2
On power-up, probes Min, Max are submerged and probe AI. is above the level of the liquid. Relays R1 and R2 are energised and the pump is ON : emptying starts, the LED for relay R1 is lit. When the Min probe emerges, relay R1 de-energises and the pump if OFF : emptying stops, the LED for relay R1 goes off. If, in the event of a fault, the level continues to rise and reaches proble AI., relay R2 de-energises and the alarm is triggered : the LED for relay R2 is lit. This fault can be stored.
T2
R1 R2
T1
T3
T2 T3
T4
Programming
1
1
0 ON
6
7
OFF
4
2
3
Operating principle Control of the level of a conductive liquid at specific points (high and low levels) with an alarm for a level which is abnormally high or low. The principle is based on measurement of the apparent resistance of the liquid between submerged probes. When this value is lower than the present threshold on the unit front face, the output relay R1 and/or the alarm relay R2 change state. The avoid electrolytic phenomena, an AC current runs across the probes. Adjusting sensitivity Set the sensitivity so that the relay will change state when the probes are in contact with the liquid. Then check that the relay returns to its initial position as soon as the probes emerge. In certain applications, fine-tuning the sensitivity prevents inappropriate detection, such as the presence of foam or bubbles on the surface or the occurrence of leakage impedance between probes (extended line capacity, humidity, etc). Note : Latching of the alarm relay R2 in de-energised state if a fault occurs can the programmed via a switch on the underside of the underside of the unit (only when the unit is switched off). To reset alarm relay R2, cut the power, as long as the levels are reset. Programming The FN level controller can be programmed using 3 switches on the lower panel : Note : Memory, Alarm and Function must only be selected when the unit is switched off.
118
Level control
Specifications
Type S8 Accessories Operating temperature (o C) A light, compact, 3-probe electrode holder (stainless 80 steel). Electrode holder and 1000 mm probe. Particularly recommended for drinks vending machines and in cases where installation space is limited. Electrode holder with a single probe supplied in a 200 standard length of 1000 mm. (304 stainless steel) Mounting with external 3/8" BSP thread and hexagonal head. Use 24 mm. spanner for hexagon. Suitable for use on boilers, autoclaves Protected electrode for mounting by suspension. Protective shell : PUC (S7) Electrode : stainless steel Length of cable as requested (ref. C1) : 79 696 001 Suitable for high pressures and high temperatures. 350 Metal parts of stainless steel, isolated by ceramic. 3/8" BSP mounting thread. Pressure Max. : 2 kg/cm2 Code 79 696 044
S3
Max. : 25 Kg/cm2
79 696 014
S7
79 696 043
S5
Max. : 15 Kg/cm2
79 696 006
Dimensions
79 696 014 - S3
G 3/8A
79 696 043 - S7
80
S5
1 2
84 46 29
13
20,7
25
1000
60
60
6,5
9,5
C1
4
49
Electrode holder with a single probe supplied in a standard length of 1000mm. (304 stainless steel). Mounting with external 3/8" BSP thread and hexagonal head. Use 24 mm. spanner for hexagon. Suitable for use on boilers, autoclaves and under high temperature conditions up to 200C and high pressure conditions up to 25 kg/cm 2 79 696 044 - S8
Protected electrode for mounting by suspension. Protective shell : PUC (S7) Electrode : stainless steel. Length of cable as requested (C1) : 79 696 001
B 9.5 Across flats C 1/4 width D 5/32 width E 3/8 tapered NPT
Suitable for high pressures and high temperatures. For use up to 350 C and 15 kg/cm2. Metal parts of stainless steel, isolated by ceramic.
3/8" BSP mounting thread.
A light, compact, 3-probe electrode holder (stainless steel). Electrode holder and 1000 mm probe. Particularly recommanded for drinks vending machines and in cases where installation space is limited. Ambiante temprature : 80 C Max. pressure : 2 kg/cm 2
119
Phase control
Specifications
Type EWS EWS2 Output relay 1 changeover 2 changeovers Code 84 892 299 84 873 004
General characteristics
Operating range Operating range Frequency Maximum consumption Output Output relay Type of contacts Nominal rating Maximum breaking voltage Max. voltage Nominal breaking capacity Min. breaking current Electrical life (number of operations) Maximum rate (at full load) Mechanical life (operations) Pick-up delay T1 Turn-off delay T2 Connection capacity - without ferrule Connection capacity - with ferrule Max. tightening torque Environment Operating temperature range (oC) Storage temperature (0C) Material housing Protection (IEC 60529) - Casing Protection (IEC 60529) - Term. block Dielectric strength (IEC 60255-5) Insulation coordination (IEC 60664-1) Weight (g) 200 500 VAC 3 AC 230...440 V 50 / 60 Hz +/- 1 Hz 25 VA 1 or 2 changeovers No cadmium 8A 250 V AC 440 V AC 2000 VA 10 mA / 5 V AC12 : 105 operations at 8A / 250 VAC. 360 operations /hour 2 x 107 200 ms 300 ms in the event of phase failure 2 x 2.5 mm2 1 x 4 mm2 2 x 1.5 mm2 1 Nm (screw M3 / IEC 947-1 -20 +50 -30 +70 Self-extinguishing IP40 IP20 2.5 KV / 1 mn / 1 mA / 50 Hz Overvoltage category III, degree of pollution 3 110
Dimensions
EWS / EWS2
4,2
78,5
89,7
72 100
22,5
120
99,3
57
Connections
EWS EWS EWS Monitoring of three-phase motor. Manual re-engage after disappearance of the fault.
R S
4
L1 L2 L3
L1
L2
L3 R
11
1
12
14
A1 11
R S T
D1 R
2
A2
EWS2
L1 L2 L3
3 12 14
L1
L2
L3
R
11
21
AR
U V W MA
12 14 22
24
d1
M 3~
B Isolating switch C Contactor D Alarm E Auxiliary power supply for contactor coil
and signalling
B Isolating switch C Contactor D Alarm E Auxiliary power supply for contactor coil
and signalling
Principles
Timing diagrams EWS
1
Operating principle EWS/EWS2 relays monitor the correct sequencing of phases L1, L2 and L3 as well as the loss of one of these phases. When the phase sequence is correct, the output relay is energised, indicated by a yellow LED. The relay de-energises (LED off) if one of the following faults occurs : Incorrect sequence of phases at terminals L1, L2 and L3 Total loss of one phase or all three phases (loss of phase detection threshold < 50 VAC)
3
4 4
121
Phase control
Specifications
Type EW2 EWA2 Voltage 230 V AC 400 V AC 230 V AC 400 V AC Code 84 873 511 84 873 512 84 873 501 84 873 502
General characteristics
Input Nominal supply voltage range Un Operating range Frequency Maximum consumption Output Output relay Type of contacts Nominal rating Maximum breaking voltage Nominal breaking capacity Min. breaking current Electrical life (number of operations) Maximum rate (at full load) Mechanical life (operations) Fault occurrence time T2 Fault disappearance time T1 Connection capacity - without ferrule Connection capacity - with ferrule Max. tightening torque Environment Operating temperature range (oC) Storage temperature (0C) Relative humidity (no condensation) Material housing Protection (IEC 60529) - Casing Protection (IEC 60529) - Term. block Dielectric strength (IEC 60255-5) Insulation coordination (IEC 60664-1) Vibration (IEC 60068-2-6) Weight (g)
3 V AC 230 V 3 V AC 400 V +15/ -20 % de Un 50-60 Hz +/-1 Hz 17 VA at Un / 50 Hz (20 VA at 60 Hz) 23 VA at Un +15 % / 50 HZ (27 VA at HZ) 2 changeovers No Cadmium 8A 250 V AC / 440 V AC 2000 VA 100 mA / 12 V AC12 : 105 operations at 8 A / 250 V AC 360 operations / hour 2 x 107 < 200 ms < 200 ms 2 x 2.5 mm2 1 x 4 mm2 2 x 1.5 mm2 1 Nm (vis M3 / IEC 947-1) -20 +50 -40 +70 95 % HR Self-extinguishing IP40 IP20 2.5 KV / 1 mn / 1 mA / 50 Hz Overvoltage category III, degree of pollution 3 : 4 KV / 3 Amplitude : 0.35 mm peak Frequency : 10-55 Hz 120
122
Dimensions
EW2
32 3,5 63 22,5
A1 15 Y1
EWA2
32 3,5 63 22,5
A1 15 Y1
57
78
57
18 16 A2
78
18 16 A2
95 5
95 5
Connections
EW2
L1 L2 L3
EWA2
L1 L2 L3
L1 L2 L3 R
L1 L2 L3 R
EW2 22 21 24 12 11 14
EWA2 22 21 24 12 11 14
Principles
EW2 / EWA2
1 2
3 4
11-14/21-24 11-12/21-22 100% 0% 100% 0% 100% 0% T1 T2 T1 T2 T1 T2 T1 T2
Operating principle EW2 relays monitor the correct sequencing of phases L1, L2 and L3 as well as a regeneration rate of 90 % : -10 % of Un for EW2 relays. When the phase sequence is correct, the output relay is energised, indicated by a yellow LED. The relay de-energises (LED off) if one of the following faults occurs : - Incorrect sequence of phases at terminals L1, L2 and L3, - Voltage drop on one or more phases. Operating principle EWA2 relays monitor the correct sequencing of phases L1, L2 and L3 as well as asymmetry rate of -5 to -15% of Un for EWA2 relays. When the phase sequence is correct, the ouptut relay is energised, indicated by a yellow LED. The relay de-energises (LED off) if one of the following faults occurs: - Incorrect sequence of phases at terminals L1, L2 and L3 - Voltage drop on one or more phases.
123
Phase control
Specifications
Type FW Voltages 3 x 230 VAC 3 x 380 VAC 3 x 400 VAC 3 x 415 VAC 3 x 440 VAC 3 x 480 VAC 3 x 575 VAC Setting range 180 - 260 V AC 310 - 440 V AC 320 - 460 V AC 330 - 480 V AC 350 - 510 V AC 380 - 550 V AC 460 - 660 V AC Code 84 873 010 84 873 011 84 873 012 84 873 013 84 873 014 84 873 015 84 873 016
General characteristics
Technical specifications Supply Operating range Frequency (Hz) Consumption Immunity from micro power cuts Delay on pick-up Insulation coordination
Self-powered L1 - L2 terminals 0.7 1.2 x Un 50 / 60 Hz 6 VA max. 10 ms 500 ms Category III Degree of pollution 2 according to IEC 664-1, VDE 0110 : 4 KV/2 1 K x Un max 70 % of preset threshold AC 20 % of preset threshold 10 % 2 AgCdO changeovers 2000 VA AC - 80 W DC 8 A AC DC 100 mA AC DC 250 V AC DC AC 12 : 2000 VA - 105 operations AC 15 : cos = 0.3 - 6000 operations DC 13 : L/R = 300 ms - 6000 operations 5 x 105 360 operations/h 0.2 to 10 s (0 + 50 %) green LED yellow LED Self-extinguishing 2 x 2.5 mm2 2 x 1.5 mm2 0.6 mN max. -20 +60 -30 +70 93 % 0.35 mm 10 - 55 Hz > 100 M sous 500 V File E 87 133 3 kV at 1 mA for 1 minute/50Hz 350
Input circuit Measurement input resistance Regeneration rate Under-voltage detection (symmetrical drop) Threshold display accuracy Output circuit Output relay Breaking capacity Maximum breaking current Minimum breaking current Max. breaking voltage Electrical life (A)
Mechanical life (operations) Maximum rate (at full load) General characteristics Time delay in the event of a fault Display voltage presence Display Relay Housing Terminals without ferrule Terminals with ferrule Terminals Tightening Temperature limit operation (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Relative humidity (no condensation) Vibration Amplitude Vibration Frequency Insulation resistance Approval UL and cUL Dielectric strength Weight (g)
To order, see page 6
124
Dimensions
FW
3,6
23
77 5
4,2
78,5
89,7
100
45
Connections
FW FW Monitoring of three-phase motor. Manual re-engage after disappearance of the fault.
R S
4 1
99,3
57
FW
U V W L1 L2 L3 R1 3~ 12 14 22 24 11 21 R2
D1
A1 11 R S T
Terminal identification L1-L2-L3 3-phase network being monitored 12-13-14 Output relay 21-22-24 Output relay
R
3 12 14
A2
AR U V W MA d1
M 3~
B Isolating switch C Contactor D Alarm E Auxiliary power supply for contactor coil
and signalling
W (L3) R1/R2
T
Operating principle In a 3-phase network, the FW simultaneously monitors phase sequencing, loss of phase with a maximum regeneration rate of 70 % of the voltage displayed by a potentiometer on the front face, and symmetrical voltage drop on the 3 phases of less than 20 % of the preset value. When the 3 phases succeed on another, the output relay is activated and indicated via a yellow LED. The output relay de-energises (LED off) after a time delay T, adjustable between 0.2 and 10 seconds on the front face, if one of the following faults is present : - reversed direction of phase rotation, - absence of one or more phases, - volgage drop. Note : Time delay T is not operational during loss of L1 and L2. It operates during loss of L3, phase inversion or voltage drop. Its role is to prevent spurious triggering of output relays during transient states, notably during motor starting.
125
Phase control
Specifications
Type FWA FWA2 Output 1 relay 2 relays Supply voltage 3 x 230 VAC 3 x 400 VAC 3 x 230 VAC 3 x 400 VAC Code 84 873 300 84 873 301 84 873 310 84 873 311
Principles
FWA / FWA2
100 % 0% 100 % 2 0% 100 % 3 0% 4 100 % 1 5 0% T3 T1 6 T2 T3 T2 T3 T1 T3 T2
L3 L2 7
B Phase L1 C Phase L2 D Phase L3 E Asymmetry F Threshold asymmetry rate G R1/R2 Output relay (yellow LED) H Hysteresis
T1 : Delay in the event of a fault T2 : Delay on power-down T3 : Delay on power-up
Operating principle The device is self-powered by two phases. A green LED indicates the presence of the power supply voltage. When the phase sequence is correct and the asymmetry rate is lower than the threshold displayed on the front face, the ouput relay is energised, indicated by a yellow LED. The output relay de-energises after a delay T1, adjustable from the front face, if one of the following faults is present : - incorrect phase sequence, - absence of L3, - asymmetry rate higher than the threshold displayer. This imbalance represents the increase or decrease in the voltabe of two phases compared to the voltage of a different phase. The ouput relay de-energises instantaneously in the event of a break on L1 or L2. A hysteresis fixed at approximately 10 % ensures bounce-free relay switching around the threshold. As differential measurement is used, the FWA does not react to symmetrical increases of decrases in the network.
126
General characteristics
Technical specifications Auxiliary power supply Auxiliary voltage (self powered from terminals L1 and L2) Operating range Frequency (Hz) Consumption Immunity from micro power cuts Delay on power-up T3 Delay on power-down T2 Insulation coordination Input circuit 3-phase network Nominal voltage 3-phase network Operating range Frequency (can be altered via switch underneath device) Regeneration rate Adjustment of asymmetry rate Threshold display accuracy (in accordance with VDE0435) Temperature drift Repetition accuracy Fixed hysteresis Output circuit Output Type of contacts Breaking capacity Max. breaking current Max. breaking voltage Min. breaking current Electrical life AC 12 Electrical life AC 15 Electrical life AC 13 Maximum rate Mechanical life (operations) General characteristics Time delay in the event of a fault T1 Display Powr supply Display Relay Class of protection (529) - Term. block Class of protection (IEC 529) - Casing Material housing Mounting Weight (g) Tightening capacity of terminals Tightening torque (M3 screw / IEC 947.1) Temperature limits stored (IEC 68.2.1/2) C Relative humidity (acc. to IEC 68.2.30) Vibration (IEC 68.2.6) Amplitude Vibration (IEC68.2.6) Frequence Insulation resistance (IEC 255.5) Breakdown voltage according to IEC 255-5 Impulse voltage (IEC 255.5 /664.1)
230 V AC, 400 V AC 0.8 1.2 x Un 50 - 60 Hz 4 VA max. to Un/8 VA to Un &plus ; 20 % 10 ms 1 s max. 300 ms max. Installation category III, Degree of pollution 2, conforming to IEC 664-1, VDE 0110 : 4 KV/2 FWA: 3 x 230 V AC FWA2: 3 x 400 V AC FWA: 185 to 275 V AC FWA2: 320 to 480 V AC 50 and 60 Hz Maximum 95 % Un 5 to 20 % Un 20 % at full scale 0.1 % / oC 1 % at full scale 10 % of displayed threshold volt-free changeover relay AgCdO 2000 VA - 80 W DC 8 V AC DC 250 V AC DC 100 mA AC DC 2000 VA - 105 operations Cos = 0.3 - 6000 operations L/R = 300 ms - 6000 operations 360 operations / hour at full load 5 x 106 0.5 to 10 s (-0 + 60 %) green LED yellow LED IP 20 IP 30 Self-extinguishing Panel or DIN-rail mounted 360 2 x 1.5 mm2 with ferrule, 2 x 2.5 mm2 without ferrule 0.6 Nm max -20 C +60 C -30 C +70 C 93 % ( + 2 % - 3 %) no condensation 0.35 mm 10 to 55 Hz > 100 m at 500 V DC 2.5 KV / 1 mn / 1 mA / 50 Hz 5 KV / Wave 1.2 - 50 s
Dimensions
FWA/FWA2
3,6
23
77 5
4,2
78,5
89,7
100
45
99,3
57
127
Connections
FWA/FWA2 FWA/FWA2 FWA/FWA2 Monitoring of three-phase motor. Manual re-engage after disappearance of the fault.
R S
4
R S T R S T
11
3
D1
12
14
A1 11
R S T
R
3 12 14
A2
AR U V W MA d1
M 3~
4
FWA/FWA2
N
B Isolating switch C Contactor D Alarm E Auxiliary power supplu for contactor coil
and signalling
R S
T
1
D1
2
Y1 11
R S T
R
12 14
U V W
AR
MA
d1
M 3~
128
129
HDU / HDI
Displays the current value and the preset value on LCD Controls AC and DC signals (automatic detection) Selectable overload or underload mode Threshold and hysteresis can be adjusted separately Memory function in case of fault Delay on threshold crossing
e a bl v ai l n a many N o er in G
Specifications
HDU - L Measurement ranges Supply voltage 24 DC 24 VAC 120 VAC 230 VAC Input circuits 0.2 to 60 V 84 872 301 84 872 302 84 872 304 84 872 305 E1-M : 0.2 - 2 V E2-M : 1 - 10 V E3-M : 6 - 60 V E1-M : 2 k E2-M : 10k E3-M : 60k E1-M : 4 V E2-M : 20 V E3-M : 120 V E1-M : 50 V E2-M : 100 V E3-M : 300 V Mains 277 / 480 VAC HDU - H 15 to 600 V 84 872 306 84 872 307 84 872 309 84 872 310 E1-M : 15 - 150 V E2-M : 30 - 300 V E3-M : 60 - 600 V E1-M : 100 k E2-M : 300 k E3-M : 650 k E1-M : 200 V E2-M : 350 V E3-M : 650 V E1-M : 2 kV E2-M : 2 kV E3-M : 2 kV Mains 277 / 480 VAC HDI - L 2 to 500 mA 84 871 301 84 871 302 84 871 304 84 871 305 E1-M : 2 - 20 mA E2-M : 10 - 100 mA E3-M : 50 - 500 mA E1-M : 5 E2-M : 1 E3-M : 0,2 E1-M : 40 mA E2-M : 200 mA E3-M : 1 A E1-M : 1 A E2-M : 5 A E3-M : 8 A Mains 277 / 480 VAC HDI - H 0.1 to 10 A 84 871 306 84 871 307 84 871 309 84 871 310 E1-M : 0,1 - 1 A E2-M : 0,5 - 5 A E3-M : 1 - 10 A E1-M : 0,1 E2-M : 0,02 E3-M : 0,01 E1-M : 2 A E2-M : 10 A E3-M : 14 A E1-M : 17 A E2-M : 20 A E3-M : 50 A Mains 277 / 480 VAC
Input resistance
Dimensions
HDI / HDU
66
36
A1
11 E3 E2 E1
45
81
A2 14 12
3 3
50
130
General characteristics
Supply Supply voltage 230, 120, 24 V AC 50 / 60 Hz 24 V DC no galvanic isolation protected against polarity reversal 0.85 to 1.10 x Un 3 VA at 230, 120 and 24 V AC 1 W at 24 VDC 10 ms 500 ms Category III Degree of pollution 2 according to IEC 664-1 VDE 0110 : 4 KV/2 1 AgCdO changeover relay 5 A - 250 V 100 mA 5 x 106 360 operations / h at full load AC 12 : 1250 VA - 105 operations AC 15 : cos = 0.3 - 6000 operations DC 13 : L/R = 300 ms - 6000 operations 0.1 to 3 sec 10 % Relay status OVER or UNDER mode Memory function Type of signal (AC or DC) Measurement overflow IP 20 IP 40 IP 50 Self-extinguishing 160 2 x 1.5 mm2 with ferrule 2 x 2.5 mm2 without ferrule 0.6 mN max. - 20 + 60 oC -30 +70 C 93 % (+2 % -3 %) CEI 255.5, 2.5 KV / 1 min / 1 mA / 50 Hz Adjustable from 5 to 50 % of threshold 40 500 Hz 10 % 0.1 % 0.05 % / C 0.5 %
Operating range Maximum power consumption Immunity from micro power cuts Delay on pick-up Insulation coordination
Output circuit Output Minimum current Mechanical life (operations) Maximum rate Electrical life (A)
Class of protection (529) - Term. block Protection class (IEC 529) - Panel-mounted Class of protection (IEC 529) - Casing Material housing Weight (g) Terminal capacity Tightening Temperature limits used (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Relative humidity (no condensation) Dielectric strength Hysteresis Frequency of measured signal Threshold display accuracy Repetition accuracy (with constant parameters) Drift Temperature Drift Voltage
131
Connections
HDI / HDU HDU
~
+
~ +
11 R
(+)
S1
L1
E1 E2 E3
1
A1 11
A2
M(-)
12
14
~
-
12 14
DC
M A2 (-)
(-) OV
L2
~ _
B AC or DC voltage to be controlled
HDI
N R S T
AR MA d1 D1
4
(+)
A1 11 E1 E2 E3
R
12 14 Y2 Y1 M A2
DC
(-) (-) OV
U V W
M 3~
132
Principles
Operating principle These devices are designed to control an AC or DC electrical signal : voltage using HDUs, current using HDIs. The threshold and hysteresis can be adjusted separately via two potentiometers on the front face. Before powering up the device, the operating mode should be selected using two dipswitches located under the device (with/without memory, over/under value). The mode is validated when power is applied to terminals A1 - A2. The signal to be monitored is connected between terminals E1, E2, or E3 (depending on the range) and terminal M. Control of voltage (HDU) or current (HDI) without memory
T U
1
When the value of the controlled signal, AC or DC, reaches the threshold set on the front face, the output relay opens (failsafe) at the end of time delay T. It closes immediately when the signal goes below (or above in under value mode) the threshold minus hysteresis (plus hysteresis in under value mode).
5 Notes
The threshold crossing time delay T, which can be adjusted on the front face from 0.1 to 3 sec, ensures immunity to transients and other inferference, thus preventing spurious triggering of the output relay. In "under value" mode, the absolute value of the hysteresis cannot be more than the maximum of
T U
1
2
3
5
133
Current control
the front
Specifications
Type MCI Supply voltage 24 V AC DC / 110-240 VAC Code 84 871 102
General characteristics
Characteristics Supply voltage Un Frequency (Hz) Operating range Maximum consumption 24 V AC DC/110 - 240 V AC 50 / 60 Hz 15 % for 24 V AC DC -15 % to 10 % of 110 V to 240 VAC 1 VA to 24 VAC 9 VA to 240 VAC 0.6 W to 24 VDC 0.06 % / oC 0.45 % 95 % HR from 1 A to 20 sinusoidal from 30 Hz to 400 Hz 10 % of the max. scale value 15 % of the value displayed 40 A 100 A / 3 s 400 ms 50 % 120 ms 50 % 500 ms maximum One normally open contact 1250 VA 5 A AC DC 10 mA AC DC 250 V AC DC 105 operations to 1250 VA resistive 30 x 106 AgCdO 2 x 1.5 mm2 with ferrule or 2 x 2.5 mm2 without ferrule -20 C +60 C -30 C +70 C 80 2.5 KV / 1 mn / 1 mA / 50 Hz (CEI 255.5)
Drift Temperature Repetition accuracy Relative humidity Input Measured current range Frequency range of measured current Display accuracy Switching hysteresis Maximum permanent current Accidental overload current Response time to sensing T2 Response time to sensing T3 Delay on pick-up T1 Output circuit Output Breaking capacity Maximum breaking current Minimum breaking current Max. breaking voltage Electrical life (A) Mechanical life (operations) Type of contacts Tightening capacity of terminals Temperature limit operation (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Weight (g) Dielectric strength
134
Dimensions
MCI
17,5
45
18
82
16,8 82,2
43,7
4,5
Connections
MCI
U (+) A1 I R 11
(-)
A2
A3
14
86
5,5
81
Principles
MCI
1 UA1-A2 0 3 1 4
Operating principle The relay contact (11 and 14) closes if the current is greater than the threshold. The relay contact (11 and 14) opens if the current is less than 15 % (hysteresis) of the threshold. Note : Delay on pick-up (T1) 500 ms maximum. Response time to sensing (T2) 400 ms 50 %. Response time to turn-off (T3) 120 ms 50 %. The graduated set-point scale on the front relates to sinusoidal or delta current measurement. The MCI can measure non-sinusoidal currents, for example currents subject to phase control. In this case, the display may be affected by an error coefficient which is a function of the tripping angle of the phase controller (form factor).
1 2 0 T1 T2 T3
5 6
135
Current control
Specifications
EIL Supply voltage 24 V DC 24 V AC 48 V AC 120 V AC 230 V AC Measurement range EIH EIT
84 871 020 84 871 021 84 871 022 84 871 023 84 871 024 2 500 mA
84 871 030 84 871 031 84 871 032 84 871 033 84 871 034 0.1 10 A
84 871 040 84 871 041 84 871 042 84 871 043 84 871 044 10 100 A with current transformer E1-M 10 100 A 20
Inputs
Sensitivity
Input resistance
E1-M E2-M E3-M E1-M : 2 20 mA E2-M : 10 100 mA E3-M : 50 500 mA E1-M : 5 E2-M : 1 E3-M : 0.2
E1-M E2-M E3-M E1-M : 0.1 1 A E2-M : 0.5 5 A E3-M : 1 10 A E1-M : 0.1 E2-M : 0.02 E3-M : 0.01
Accessories
Current transformers for EIT 100 A / 50 mA Code 26 852 304
General characteristics
Supply voltage Un 230 V, 110 V, 48 V, 24 Va 50 / 60 Hz (galvanic isolation by transformer) 24 V DC (No galvanic isolation). In this case, the product power supply and measuring circuit power supply must be electrically isolated. 0.85 1.15 Un 3 VA AC 1 W DC 40 500 Hz 5 50 % of the displayed threshold 10 100 % of the measurement range 10 % 0.1 % 0.1 % (10 % Un) 0.02 % 1 s 20 s 10 % 0.1 s 3 s 10 % 500 ms 1 changeover AgNi, 8A AC max -20 +50 -40 +70 140
Operating range Maximum power consumption Frequency of measured signal Adjustable hysteresis Threshold value Display accuracy of the preset threshold Repetition accuracy with constant parameters Drift Voltage Drift Temperature Delays on power up (T2) Delay on energisation T1 Delay on pick-up Output relay Temperature limit operation (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Weight (g)
136
Dimensions
EIL / EIH / EIT
32 3,5 63 22,5
A1 15 Y1
57
78
18 16 A2
95 5
Connections
EIL / EIH
U (+) A1 E1 (+) E2 E3 (+) (+) 11
EIT
U A1 E1 (+) R 11
I
12 14
(-)
A2
M (-)
A2
M (-)
12
14
A1 - A2 : Supply voltage
Principles
AC/DC control with memory
Un
4
Operating principle
5
6
1 2
3
2 1
2
T2
T1
T2
T1
AC/DC control without memory When the value of the controlled current, either AC or DC, reaches the threshold displayed on the front face, the output relay changes state at the end of time delay T1. It returns instantly to the initial state when the current drops below the hysteresis threshold, or when the power supply is disconnected. AC/DC control with memory The output relay changes state at the end of time delay T1 and remains latched in this position. To reset the memory function the auxiliary supply must be disconnected. Over-current function (UPPER) The time delay on energisation T2 prevents current peaks due to motor starting. The delay on upward crossing of threshold T1 provides immunity to transients and other interference, thereby preventing spurious triggering of the output relay. Under-current function (UNDER) The time delay on energisation T2 prevents the occurrence of current troughs. The delay on downward crossing of threshold T1 provides immunity to random dips, thereby preventing spurious triggering of the output relay. Note : In underload function, the absolute value of the hysteresis cannot be greater than the measurement range maximum.
T2
T1
T2
T1
2 6
B Threshold C Hysteresis D UPPER function E UNDER function F Unit power-up G Controlled current H Memory
AC/DC control without memory
Un
5 6 1 2 3 2 1
T2 T1 T1 T2
2
T2 T1 T1 T2
B Threshold C Hysteresis D UPPER function E UNDER function F Unit power-up G Controlled current
6 2
137
Voltage control
Specifications
EUL Supply voltage 24 V DC 24 V AC 120 V AC 230 V AC Measurement range Input EUH
84 872 020 84 872 021 84 872 023 84 872 024 0.2 60 V E1-M E2-M E3-M E1-M : 0,2 to 2V E2-M : 1 to 10V E3-M : 6 to 60V E1-M : 2k E2-M : 10k E3-M : 60k
84 872 030 84 872 031 84 872 033 84 872 034 15 600 V E1-M E2-M E3-M E1-M : 15 to 150V E2-M : 30 to 300V E3-M : 60 to 600V E1-M : 100k E2-M : 300k E3-M : 600k
Sensitivity
Input resistance
General characteristics
Supply voltage Un 24 V, 120 V, 230 V, 50/60 Hz (galvanic isolation via transformer) 24 V (no galvanic isolation). In this case, the product power supply and measuring circuit power supply must be electrically isolated. 0.85 1.15 Un 3 VA / 1 W 40 500 Hz Adjustment from 10 to 100 % of the measurement range Adjustment from 5 to 50 % of the displayed threshold 10 % of the full scale 0.1 3 s 10 % 1 AgNi changeover, 8 A max -20 +60 -30 +70
Operating range Maximum power consumption Frequency of measured signal Threshold Ue Hysteresis Display accuracy Delay on energisation T1 Output relay Temperature Use (C) Storage temperature (0C)
Dimensions
EUL / EUH
32 3,5 63 22,5
A1 15 Y1
57
78
18 16 A2
95 5
138
Connections
EUL
U (+) A1 E1 (+) E2 E3 (+) (+) 11
(+)
EUL / EUH
~ +
S1
L1
E1 E2 E3
1
A1 11
U
R
12 14
M A2 (-)
(-) OV
(-)
A2
M (-)
12
14
DC
L2
~ _
A1 - A2 : Supply voltage
Principles
Control of AC/DC voltage without memory
Un
1 2
T1
6
6
When the value of the controlled voltage, AC or DC, reaches the treshold Ue displayed on the front face, the output relay changes state at the end of a time delay T1, which can be set on the front face at between 0.1 and 3s. Once the voltage drops below 5 to 50 % of the treshold (hysteresis) , the output relay changes state again instantly. Changing the hysteresis onthe front face does not therefore modify the value of the preset treshold.
3
2 1
T1
B Treshold Ue C Hysteresis D UPPER function E UNDER function F Unit power-up G Controlled voltage
When the value of the controlled voltage, AC or DC, reaches the treshold Ue displayed on the front face, the output relay changes state at the end of a time delay T1, which can be set on the front face at between 0.1 and 3s and remains latched in this position.
1 2
T1
6 6
3 2 1
T1
B Treshold Ue C Hysteresis D UPPER function E UNDER function F Unit power-up G Controlled voltage H Memory
139
Voltage control
Specifications
EUS Supply voltage 12 V DC 20-80 V AC/DC 65-260 V AC/DC Supply voltage EUSF
84 872 040 84 872 046 84 872 047 7.5 to 18 V DC 15 to 150 V AC/DC 50 to 275 V AC/DC with protection against connection errors Direct adjustment 9.6 to 15.6 V DC 20 to 80 V AC/DC 65 to 260 V AC/DC Adjustment from 5 to 20 % Green LED : SupplyFixed yellow LED : relay state over voltageHigh LED : Relay state
84 872 056 84 872 057 20 to 80 V AC/DC 65 to 260 V AC/DC with protection against connection errors Adjustable from 20 to 80 V AC/DC 65 to 260 VAC/DC Fixed 5 % Fixed yellow LED : Relay state over voltageFalshing yellow LED : Relay state undervoltage
Threshold Ue
Hysteresis Display
General characteristics
Maximum power consumption 0.5 W at 12 V DC 0.5 VA at 80 V and 260 VAC 1.5 W at 80 V and 260 V AC 50/60 Hz 10 % 0.1 3 s 10 % 1 AgNi changeover 8 A max -20 +60 -30 +70
Frequency of measured signal Display accuracy (of the full scale) Delay on upward crossing of threshold Output relay Temperature Use (C) Storage temperature (0C)
Dimensions
EUS / EUSF
32 3,5 63 22,5
A1 15 Y1
57
78
18 16 A2
95 5
140
Connections
EUS / EUSF
U (+) A1 11
1
EUS / EUSF
~
A1 11 R 12 14 A2
R
(-)
A2
12
14
~
B Supply voltage to be monitored
Principles
EUS: voltage control without memory
Un
Operating principle
5
1 2
T1
6
6
EUS - The operating principle of the EUS control relays is identical to that for the EU control relays. Two operating mode are available : - AC / DC voltage control without memory - AC / DC voltage control with memory Note : Time delay T1 on crossing the upper and lower thresholds provides protection to transients, thus preventing spurious triggering of the output relay.
3
2 1
T1
B Threshold Ue C Hysteresis D UPPER function E UNDER function F Unit power-up G Controlled voltage
EUS: voltage control with memory
Un
1 2
T1
6 6
3 2 1
T1
B Threshold Ue C Hysteresis D UPPER function E UNDER function F Unit power-up G Controlled voltage H Memory
EUSF
Un
Operating principle
3
1 2
T1 T1
4 5 4
EUSF - The EUSF window threshold relay controls an electrical voltage which acts as its own power supply (simplified wiring). When the value of the controlled voltage, AC or DC, goes outside the window, the output relay de-energises at the end of a time delay T1 which can be set on the front face at between 0.1 and 3s. It switches back on when the voltage returns within the window and stays between the upper and lower thresholds displayed by two potentiometers on the front face. Fixed hysteresis ensures bounce-free relay switching around the threshold. Note : Time delay T1 on crossing the upper and lower thresholds provides protection to transients, thus preventing spurious triggering of the output relay.
141
Voltage control
Specifications
Type F3US F3USN Supply voltage 3 x 230 V AC 3 x 400 V AC 3 x 230 V AC 3 x 400 V AC Lower treshold 195 to 225 340 to 392 112 to 130 195 to 225 Upper treshold 235 to 264 408 to 460 135 to 152 235 to 264 Code 84 873 200 84 873 201 84 873 210 84 873 211
General characteristics
Power supply characterisitcs Supply voltage Un on terminals L1 - L2 Power (W) Delay on pick-up Immunity from micro power cuts Insulation coordination Control circuit characteristics Adjustment of upper threshold Adjustment of lower threshold Fault delay Hysteresis Display accuracy Repetition accuracy Drift Temperature Output characteristics Output Breaking capacity Maximum breaking current Max. breaking voltage Minimum breaking current Mechanical life (operations) Electrical life AC 12 Electrical life AC 15 Electrical life AC 13 General characteristics Delay on threshold crossing Display Powr supply Display overvoltage relay Display undervoltage relay Class of protection (529) - Term. block Class of protection (IEC 529) - Casing Material housing Mounting Weight (g) Tightening capacity of terminals Tightening torque Temperature limits Use (IEC 68.2.14) C Temperature limits stored (IEC 68.2.1/2) C Relative humidity (acc. to IEC 68.2.30) Vibration (IEC 68.2.6) Amplitude Vibration (IEC68.2.6) Frequence Insulation resistance (IEC 255.5) Breakdown voltage according to IEC 255-5 Impulse voltage (IEC 255.5 /664.1)
To order, see page 6
230 and 400 V AC 20 % -50 / 60 Hz 4 VA maximum to Un 8 VA maximum to Un +20 % Approximately 3 s 10 ms Instalation category III, degree of pollution 2 conforming to IEC 664.1 / VDE 0110 : 4 KV/2 102 to 155 % of Un 85 to 98 % of Un 0.1 to 10 sec (0, +50 %) Approximately 3 % 10 % upper threshold : 0.06 %, lower threshold : 0.09 % 0.05 % / oC 2 AgCdO changeover 2000 VA - 80 W 8 A AC DC 250 V AC DC 100 mA AC DC 30 x 106 2000 VA - 105 operations Cos = 0.3 - 6000 operations L/R = 300 ms - 6000 operations 0.1 to 10 s (0 50 %) Green LED Yellow LED Yellow LED IP 20 IP 50 Self-extinguishing Panel or DIN-rail mounted 310 2 x 1.5 mm2 with ferrule 2 x 1.5 mm2 without ferrule 0.6 Nm maximum (M3 screw / IEC 947-1) -20 C +60 C -30 C +70 C 93 % (+ 2 % ; - 3 %) no condensation 0.35 mm 10 to 55 Hz > 10 M at 500 V DC > 2.5 kV / 1 mn / 1 mA / 50 Hz 5 kV / Wave 1.2 - 50 s
142
Dimensions
F3US / F3USN
3,6
23
77 5
4,2
78,5
89,7
100
45
Connections
F3US
R S T
F3USN
R S T N
A1 11 R
R S T
A1 11 R
R S T
12 14
A2
12 14
1
1
99,3
57
N A2
R S T R S T
11
21
R S T N R S T
11
21
3~ > U <
12 14 22
24
>
N
3~ < U
12 14 22
24
L1 - L2 - L3 : 3-phase network being monitored 11 - 12 - 14 : Output relay (R1) lower threshold 21 - 22 - 24 : Output relay (R2) upper threshold
Principles
F3US / F3USN
1 2 3 0 R2 R1 T1 Tr T2 T1
Operating priciple The two relays are energised when the measured voltages are between the minimum and maximum thresholds which can be separately adjuste via two potentiometers on the front face. If one or more voltages goes outside the window, the relay corresponding to the fault de-energises following a delay which can be adjusted on the front face. The relays each have individual delays (0.1 to 10 sec.). A hysteresis fixed at 3 % ensures bounce-free relay switching when the voltage levels return to a value between the upper and lower theresholds. The unit is not affected by the phase sequence nor by harmonic distortion. A green LED indicates the presence of the power supply voltage. Two yellow LEDs indicate when the upper and lower thresholds have been exceeded. The LEDs go out when the voltages are within the set window.
143
Motor control
Specifications
Type FFP Supply voltage 3 x 230 VAC 3 x 400 VAC 3 x 440 VAC 3 x 480 VAC 3 x 575 VAC Code 84 873 400 84 873 401 84 873 402 84 873 403 84 873 404
General characteristics
Power supply characterisitcs Supply voltage Un Operating range Nominal power Maximal power Immunity from micro power cuts Insulation coordination Control / input circuit characteristics Threshold display Voltage input circuit resistance Current measurement Current range Input resistance Maximum permanent current Peak overload Delays on power up (T2) Delay on energisation T1 Frequency (Hz) Hysteresis Display accuracy Repetition accuracy Drift Temperature Output characteristics Output Breaking capacity Maximum breaking current Minimum breaking current Max. breaking voltage Mechanical life (operations) Electrical life AC 12 Electrical life AC 15 Electrical life AC 13 General characteristics Material housing Terminal capacity Temperature limit operation (IEC 68.1.14) (C) Temperature limits stored (IEC 68.1.1/2) (C) Relative humidity (no condensation) Weight (g)
230, 400, 440, 480, 575 V AC - 50/60 Hz Self-powered via L1 and L2 0.85 to 1.15 Un 2 VA to Un 3 VA to Un +15 % 10 ms Category III, degree of pollution 2 conforming to IEC 664.1 / VDE 0110 : 4 KV/2 0.1 to 0.99 approx. 2 k (Un) by internal shunt via 2 terminals 0.5 to 10 A 20 m 14 A (20 C) 50 A (< 1 s) (20 C) 0.5 to 20 s - 20 % of full scale 0.3 to 3 s - 20 % of full scale 50 / 60 Hz 10 % fixed for Cos e ; 0.4 10 %<Hyst.<30 % for Cos<0.4 10 % of full scale 0.8 % with constant parameters 0.05 % / oC 2 AgCdO changeover 2000 VA - 80 W 8 A AC DC 100 mA AC DC 250 V AC DC 30 x 106 200VA - 105 operations Cos = 0.3 - 6000 operations L/R = 300 ms - 6000 operations Self-extinguishing 2 x 1.5 mm2 with ferrule 2 x 2.5 mm2 without ferrule -20 +60 -30 +70 93 % (+2 % ; -3 %) 360
144
Dimensions
FFP
3,5 23 77
4,2
78,5
89,7
100
45
Connections
FFP Operation on 3-phase network I < 10 A AC
3 x 400 V~
M
99,3
57
L1 L2 E L3
11 R1
21
L1 L2
E L3
11 R1
21 R2
L1
L2
E
1
L3
11
21
R2
1
R1
R2
12
14
22
24
12
14
22
24
12
14
22
24
B Internal shunt
L1 - L2 - L3 : Network to be monitored E : Current read output 11 - 12 - 14 : Low threshold output relay (R1) 21 - 22 - 24 : High threshold output relay (R2)
Principles
FFP Operating principle
1
2 Cos
4
R1 R2
T2
T1
T1
The FFP control relay is used for motor protection. The variation in the power factor (current / voltage phase-shift or cosine ) is related to the variation in the mechanical load of the motor. The FFP control relay monitors the power factor, and therefore the mechanical load, and ensures that it stays between two defined, adjustable limits. A green LED indicates presence of the power supply. Two yellow LEDs display the state of the output relays. On power-up, both output relays are closed for the duration of the inhibit time (T2 adjustable beween 0.5 and 20 seconds). If the value of the power factor is between the two threshold values set, both relays are closed. If the power factor exceeds the maximum threshold value set by the user, the high threshold relay de-energises after a delay T1 (adjustable between 0.3 and 3 seconds). During this delay, the green LED flashes (1 Hz). The relay closes again when the measured value drops below the threshold less the hysteresis. If the power factor drops below the minimum threshold value set by the user, the low threshold relay de-energises after a delay (T1 adjustable between 0.3 and 3 seconds). During this delay, the green LED flashes. The relay closes again when the measured value is (1 Hz) above the threshold plus the hysteresis. If the value of the high threshold is set as less than or equal to the low threshold value, the green LED flashes quickly (2 Hz).
145
Motor control
Specifications
Type FRL Supply voltage 24 VDC 24 VAC 110 VAC 230 VAC Code 84 874 300 84 874 301 84 874 303 84 874 304
General characteristics
Power supply characterisitcs Supply voltage Un 24, 120, 230 VAC 50 / 60 Hz Galvanic isolation via transformer 24 V DC without galvanic isolation 0.85 to 1.15 UN 3.5 VA max. at UN and 5 VA at Un +15 % 1 W max. at Un and 1.5 W at Un +15 % 10 ms Category III, degree of pollution 2 conforming to IEC 664.1 / VDE 0110 : 4 KV/2 24 V PNP (50 mA max.) 8.2 V on 1 k Volt-free 30 V max. 16 k except for NAMUR 1 k Min. 4.5 V, max. 30 V Min. 0 V, max. 1 V 200 Hz 5 ms 5 ms 8-position switch on front face 0.1 to 1s, 1 to 10 s, 0.1 to 1 min, 1 to 10 min 0.1 to 1s, 1 to 10 s, 0.1 to 1 min, 1 to 10 min 5 % of treshold displayed 10 % of full scale (@ 25C) 0.5 % with constant parameters 0.5 % / C 1 % / V 200 ms minimum 100 ms minimum 0.3 to 30 s 10 % 1 AgCdO changeover 2000 VA - 80 W 8 A AC DC 100 mA AC DC 100 V AC DC 5 x 106 AC12 : 2000 VA - 105 operations AC15 : Cos = 0.3 - 6000 operations DC13 : L/R = 300 ms - 6000 operations 360 operations / hour at full load Self-extinguishing 2 x 1.5 mm2 with ferrule 2 x 1.5 mm2 without ferrule -20 +60 -30 +70 93 % (+2 % ; -3 %) 255
Operating range Maximum power consumption - Version AC Maximum power consumption - Version DC Immunity from micro power cuts Insulation coordination Control / input circuit characteristics Input circuit 3-wire sensors Input circuit NAMUR sensor Input circuit Contact Input circuit Voltage input Input resistance High state Low state Breaking frequency Minimum pulse time Minimum time between pulses Selection of delay and memory function Selection of delay and memory function - No memory Selection of delay and memory function - With memory Hysteresis Display accuracy Repetition accuracy Drift Temperature Voltage-dependent drift Reset time Reset time S2 Inhibit time delay Output characteristics Output Breaking capacity Maximum breaking current Minimum breaking current Max. breaking voltage Mechanical life (operations) Electrical life
Maximum rate General characteristics Material housing Terminal capacity Temperature limit operation (IEC 68.1.14) (C) Temperature limits stored (IEC 68.1.1/2) (C) Relative humidity (no condensation) Weight (g)
To order, see page 6
146
Dimensions
FRL
3,5
Connection
FRL
77 5
4,2
23
~ +
S1
S2
+ +
_ 1
_ 2
78,5
89,7
99,3
57
+ A1 11 Y1 24V e OV
R 12 14
+ 8V2 Y2 A2
100
45
3
4
_ ~
Principles
Without latching
U
Operating principle The FRL control relay can be used to solve underspeed problems : conveyor belts, conveyors, etc wehere the crossing of a low speed threshold should trigger an alarm. Speed data is collected via a sensor such as a three-wire output proximity sensor, an NAMUR sensor or by volt-free contact or voltage. On power-up, to allow the process which is being controlled to reach its operating speed, control is inhibited for a time of between 0.3 and 30 sec, which can be adjusted on the front face. If starting requires an inhibition time above 30 seconds, external contact S2 must be closed during starting to inhibit the FRL (during this time the yellow LED flashes) , then opened when the nominal speed has been reached. On each cycle of the process being controlled, the sensor sends a pulse to the FRL. Each of these pulses resets the internal time delay of the FRL. If the time between two pulses is less than the value set on the FRL, the delay is reset on each pulse and the output relay remains closed. If the speed of the process decreases, the time between pulses increases. When the time between two pulses is greater than the value set on the FRL, the controlled process is in underspeed mode, the output relay of the FRL changes state (opens). The output relay closes again when the speed of the controlled process exceeds the preset value plus the hysteresis (5 % of the value displayed). If "memory" mode is activated, the relay remains open when an underspeed fault is detected. In this case, the output relay can only close again after a manual reset has been performed by closing external contact S2. A yellow LED indicates the state of the relay. A green LED indicates the presence of the power supply.
1 2
0
3 4
With latching
200 ms min. U S2
1 2
0
147
Motor control
Controls temperature of machines using built-in PTC Line break or probe short-circuit detection
Version ETM2 / ETM22 : Fault latching function Pushbutton for local reset Remote reset via external contact Pushbutton test facility 2 LEDs to indicate relay and power supply status
Specifications
Type ETM Output 1 N/O contact 1 N/O contact 1 N/O contact 1 changeover 1 changeover 1 changeover 2 changeovers 2 changeovers 2 changeovers Supply voltage 24 V AC/DC 120 V AC 230 V AC 24 V AC/DC 120 V AC 230 V AC 24 V AC 120 V AC 230 V AC Code 84 874 015 84 874 013 84 874 014 84 874 025 84 874 023 84 874 024 84 874 035 84 874 033 84 874 034
ETM2
ETM22
General characteristics
Operating range Nominal power Maximal power Immunity from micro power cuts Delay on pick-up Insulation coordination Input circuit characteristics Max. resistance of cold probes Trip threshold Reset threshold Short-circuit detection Measurement voltage as per IEC 34-11 Repetition accuracy with constant parameters Temperature drift Voltage-dependent drift Output characteristics Output Breaking capacity Max. breaking current Max. breaking voltage Min. breaking current Maximum rate Mechanical life (operations) Electrical life
230, 120 and 24 VAC 50 / 60 Hz Galvanic isolation by transformer 24 VDC no galvanic isolation 0.85 to 1.10 Un 3 VA 5 VA 10 ms 500 ms Category III, degree of pollution 2 conforming to IEC 664.1 / VDE 0110 : 4 KV/2 1500 3100 10 % 1650 10 % 0 - 10 2.5 V 0.05 % with constant parameters 0.05 % / oC -2 % AgNi 90/10 2000 VA - 80 W 8 A AC 440 V AC 100 mA AC DC 360 operations / hour at full load 5 x 106 AC12 : 2000 VA - 105 operations AC15 : Cos = 0.3 - 6000 operations DC13 : L/R = 300 ms - 6000 operations 500 ms 500 ms green LED yellow LED IP 20 IP 50 Self-extinguishing 145 2 x 1.5 mm2 with ferrule 2 x 2.5 mm2 without ferrule -20 +60 C -30 +70 C 93 % (+2 % ; -3 %)
General characteristics Reset time Response time Display on ETM2/ETM22 - power supply Display on ETM2/ETM22 - Relay Class of protection (529) - Term. block Class of protection (IEC 529) - Casing Material housing Weight (g) Terminal capacity Temperature limit operation (IEC 68.1.14) (C) Temperature limits stored (IEC 68.1.1/2) (C) Relative humidity (no condensation)
To order, see page 6
148
Dimensions
ETM / ETM2 / ETM22
2 23 77 5
4,2
11
14 12
78,5
89,7
Y1 Y2 11 14 12 A2
100
22,5
Connections
ETM ETM2 ETM22
99,3
57
Y1
Y2
11
21
12 T1 T2
14 22
24
A2 -
14
A2 -
Y1
1
Y2
12
14
B Fault memory
A1 - A2 : Supply voltage 11 - 12 -14 : Output relay T1 - T2 : External PTC probe Y1 - Y2 : Remote reset contact
A1 - A2 : Supply voltage 11 - 12 -14 : Low threshold output relay (R1) 21 - 22 -24 : High threshold output relay (R2) T1 - T2 : External PTC probe Y1 - Y2 : Remote reset contact
ETM
R S T
A1 11 T1 T2
R
12 14
r>
Y1 Y2 A2
c1
h1 N
149
Principles
Reset WITHOUT fault latching (Y1 and Y2 not connected for ETM2/ETM22) Operating principle Control relay is used in combination with PTC thermistor probes (not supplied) for thermal protection of machines (motors, alternators, transformers, etc). The probes are placed at critical points on the equipment to be protected (normally inserted into the stator windings of motors). The resistance of the PTC probe has a positive temperature coefficient. As soon as the nominal trip temperature of the probe is exceeded, the resistance of the probe increases rapidly. Protection relay detects this and opens the power supply circuit of the protected equipment (eg motor) and the yellow fault indicator LED lights up (version ETM2/ETM22). Test button The ETM2/ETM22 has a TEST button which can be used to simulate a thermal overload in order to test the service condition of the relay. Tripping The relay drops out as soon as the protected equipment is subjected to a thermal overload, shortcircuit or break in the probe measuring circuit. Early warning of tripping If the equipment being protected has another PTC proble with a lower nominal trip temperature, a second ETM/ETM2/ETM22 relay can be used to give early warning of tripping and thus prevent breaks in operation. Control relay ETM/ETM2/ETM22 is automatically reset as soon as the temperature drops below the trip threshod (the yellow fault indicator LED goes out). PTC probe specification According to standard DIN 44081 (or IEC 34-11)
R( ) 4000
U 3100 1650
3
10
1330
4
1
550
250
20 ( C) 2
Reset WITH fault latching (only for ETM2/ETM22) (Y1 and Y2 connected)
U B.P. "reset" S2 3100 1650 10
TNF-20
-20
The relay is reset either using the RESET pushbutton on the front face or by opening the external contact S2 (remote reset) , or by cutting the auxiliary power supply (terminals A1 - A2). If the auxiliary power is cut for a period of time greater than the reset time (500 ms) , the relay is reactivated if the proble detects a normal temperature when the power supply voltage is restored.
B Unit power-up C Latching contact D Resistance between terminals T1 and T2 E Output relay
150
151
Variable speed
Single-phase 300 W
Control fan speeds in air-conditioning applications For 150 to 300 W asynchronous motor at 230 V AC 0 / 10 V control input Quiet
with permanent dephasing via capacitor
Specifications
Type VRT 300 Designation VRT 300 Code 84 886 019
Dimensions
23 77 5
4,2
78,5
89,7
100
45
Connections
2 1 3 4 U
99,3
57
pH N
NC NC NC
Power ON
B 230 V AC mains input 50 Hz single-phase C Earth D Neutral E Phases F 0 - 10 V DC control input cable (2-wire screened) G Screening H Single-phase asynchronous motor (230 V ; 50 Hz) with permanent
dephasing via capacitor I Main phase
0-10VDC +
J Auxiliary phase
8 9 7
152
General characteristics
Technical specifications Supply Voltage Frequency Power consumption Internal protection 0 - 10 V input Input voltage Max. voltage Input impedance (k) Protection Transfer characteristics Motor control Characteristics of the load Supply Absorbed power cos Voltage range (RMS) at 230 V AC nominal 0 - 10 V control input Relay breaking capacity Display LED on LED off Environmental characteristics Climatic environment Operation Temperature (oC) Relative humidity Storage Temperature (C) Humidity Mechanical environment Resistance to vibrations Amplitude Frequency range (Hz) Number of axes Cycle duration (min) Number of cycles Weight (g) Dimensions Connection solid without ferrule Connection stranded without ferrule Mounting Material housing Material terminal block Packaging Electromagnetic environment Product EMC standard Environment Immunity to bursts of fast transients
230 V AC 15 % ; 50 Hz 2 Hz 150 300 W 0.95 0.99 at 230 V AC 0.9 to 80 V AC 80 V 225 V (15 V) 8 A / 250 V AC / AC 1 Power supply present Power supply missing
0.35 mm 10 55 3 5 20 210 45 x 78 x 105 mm 2 x 2.5 mm2 2 x 1.5 mm2 DIN rail or panel mounted Self-extinguishing Self-extinguishing Individual Packed in lots of 5 IEC 1800-3 (09/96) Domestic and similar (residential, commercial and light industry) Tested in accordance with IEC 1000-4-4 Power supply : 1 kV (direct) 0-10 V input : 0.5 kV (connection) Tested in accordance with IEC 1000-4-2 Discharges on contact : 6 kV Discharges into the air : 8 kV Tested in accordance with IEC 1000-4-5 Power supply : 1 kV (line-to-line connection) Power supply : 2 kV (connection btwn line & earth) Tested in accordance with IEC 1000-4-3 Frequency range 26 MHz to 1 GHz Level of severity : 3 V/m Tested in accordance with IEC 1000-2-2 (class 2) THD in steady state 8 % Tested in accordance with IEC 1000-2-4 (class 2) Level 10 % Duration < 60 s Tested in accordance with IEC 1000-2-2 (class 2) Level 2 Hz Tested in accordance with EN 55022 (94) / 11 group 1 Level of severity : Class B Frequency range : 0.15 to 30 MHz Tested in accordance with EN 55022 (94) / 11 group 1 Level of severity : Class B Frequency range : 30 MHz to GHz Tested in accordance with IEC 664-1 Impulse : 1.2 / 50 s Level : 2.5 kV
Radiated emissions
153
Principles
Basic controller
1
The current harmonics circulate in both motor phases and generate constant noise.
Crouzet controller
4
The current harmonics circulate in a single phase and generate very little noise.
5
Curves
Transfert function Operating principle Phase control by modification of the aperture angle of a triac. 0 - 10 V input : Motor control activated when input higher than 2 V 150 mV. Comment : When the motor starts, control is forced to full speed for 2 seconds.
80 V 2s 2s t U t 1 10 V
225 V
80 V
2V 2 225 V t
2V
10 V
B Input C Output
154
B Input C Output
www.crouzet.com
155
Selection guide
Solid state relays - resistive and inductive load
Mains supply Current* 3A 5A Output voltage 5 to 48 V DC 12 to 280 V AC 1 to 200 V DC Control voltage 4 to 32 V DC 4 to 32 V DC 3 to 32 V DC 4 to 32 V DC 24 to 280 V AC 10 A 18 to 36 V AC / DC 90 to 280 V AC / DC 4 to 32 V DC 48 to 660 V AC 18 to 36 V AC / DC 90 to 280 V AC / DC 4 to 32 V DC 12 A 24 to 280 V AC 180 to 280 V AC / DC 90 to 140 V AC 15 A 1 to 100 V DC 3 to 32 V DC 4 to 32 V DC 24 to 280 V AC 180 to 280 V AC / DC 90 to 140 V AC 4 to 32 V DC 48 to 660 V AC 25 A 24 to 280 V AC 180 to 280 V AC / DC 90 to 140 V AC 4 to 32 V DC 18 to 36 V AC / DC 90 to 280 V AC / DC 4 to 32 V DC 48 to 660 V AC 18 to 36 V AC / DC 90 to 280 V AC / DC THYRISTOR 30 A Single-phase 35 A 1 to 50 V DC 48 to 660 V AC 3 to 32 V DC 4 to 32 V DC 90 to 280 V DC 4 to 32 V DC 90 to 280 V AC 4 to 32 V DC 24 to 280 V AC 50 A 48 to 660 V AC 18 to 36 V AC / DC 90 to 280 V AC / DC 4 to 32 V DC 18 to 36 V AC / DC 90 to 280 V AC / DC 4 to 32 V DC 24 to 280 V AC 75 A 48 to 660 V AC 18 to 36 V AC / DC 90 to 280 V AC / DC 4 to 32 V DC 18 to 36 V AC / DC 90 to 280 V AC / DC 4 to 32 V DC 24 to 280 V AC 100 A 48 to 660 V AC 18 to 36 V AC / DC 90 to 280 V AC / DC 4 to 32 V DC 18 to 36 V AC / DC 90 to 280 V AC / DC 4 to 32 V DC 24 to 280 V AC 125 A 48 to 660 V AC 18 to 36 V AC / DC 90 to 280 V AC / DC 4 to 32 V DC 18 to 36 V AC / DC 90 to 280 V AC / DC GN Page 176 GN Page 176 GN Page 176 GN Page 176 GN GRD Integrated heatsink GRD Integrated heatsink Page 170 Page 164 GN Page 176 GRD Integrated heatsink Page 162 GRD Integrated heatsink GN GN Page 176 Designation GMS GMS Resistive load Page 179 Page 179 Page 170
Page 176
GMS
Page 162
Page 170
Page 162
GRD 22.5 mm
Page 176
45 A
48 to 660 V AC
Page 164
Page 164
Page 176
GRD 90 mm
Page 176
Page 176
GN without cover
*The current ratings should be checked against the thermal curves (see catalogue) in order to select the appropriate heatsink For a GN relay with cover 84 137 102 For a GN relay without cover 84 134 102
156
Mains supply
Current* 2 x 35 A
Designation GRD
Two-phase
25 A
24 to 280 V AC
DUAL
Page 174
Page 174
40 A THYRISTOR
24 to 280 V AC
DUAL
Page 174
3 x 25 A 3 x 10 A Three-phase 3 x 25 A
3 x 45 A Three-phase changeover
24 to 660 V AC
GA3
Page 190
Page 190
3 x 25 A
24 to 280 V AC
GA0
3 to 32 V DC 10 A TRIAC Single-phase 25 A 24 to 280 V AC 24 to 280 V AC 18 to 36 V AC / DC 90 to 280 V AC / DC 3 to 32 V DC 18 to 36 V AC / DC 90 to 280 V AC / DC *The current ratings should be checked against the thermal curves (see catalogue) in order to select the appropriate heatsink For a GN relay with cover 87 137 102 For a GN relay without cover 87 134 102 GNA5 Page 172 GNA5 Page 172
*The current ratings should be checked against the thermal curves (see catalogue) in order to select the appropriate heatsink to connect
*The current ratings should be checked against the thermal curves (see catalogue) in order to select the appropriate heatsink to connect
157
RHP
SMART MODULE - Control module for Hockey puck type solid state relays
Function Provides both visual and electrical information if a fault occurs in the circuit or on the solid state relay being controlled. For mounting on single-phase "hockey puck" type solid state relays. Current Output voltage Control voltage Dsignation
15 to 35 A
4 to 32 V DC
5 to 24 V DC
SMART MODULE
Page 184
158
159
RHP
20 A in a case only 17.5 mm wide Service life > 5 million operations at full load Silent operation Functions : contactor - impulse relay - day / night contactor Clips onto a 35 mm DIN rail UL/UL (listed) approval NF-USE label "CE" / Low Voltage Directive conformity
Specifications
Type Day/night contactor Impulse relay Contactor Input voltage 90 260 V AC 90 260 V AC 90 260 V AC 4 32 V DC 18 36 V AC Frequency 50 / 60 Hz 50 / 60 Hz 50 / 60 Hz 50 / 60 Hz 50 / 60 Hz Thresholds OFF control 0 46 V AC 0 46 V AC 0 46 V AC 0 1 V DC 0 1 V AC Thresholds ON control 76 260 V AC 76 260 V AC 76 260 V AC 4 32 V DC 18 36 V AC Code 84 138 201 84 138 101 84 138 001 84 138 000 84 138 002
General characteristics
Input characteristics Minimum duration of the control Output characteristics Max. current Overload current 20 A (IEC 60947-4-3) Minimum current Frequency Contact Number of operations Leakage current Acoustic noise in steady state Acoustic noise on switching Tightening capacity of terminals 50 ms 20 A (AC1 / AC51 / AC7a) AC-51 : 1.25 x Ie - 60 s : 50-30 100 mA (AC1 / AC51 / AC7a) 50 / 60 Hz N.O > 5 000 000 < 5 mA < 35 dB at 1 m < 50 dB at 0.5 m 2 x 1.5 mm up2 ; with ferrule 2 x 2.5 mm up2 ; without ferrule 1 x 4 mm up2 ; without ferrule 1 Nm max. M3 screw (IEC60947-1) -5 +55 -40 +85 90 95 % Self-extinguishing IP20 IP50 70
Tightening torque Operating temperature (oC) Storage temperature (0C) Relative humidity (no condensation) Material housing Protection (IEC 529) Housing Protection (IEC 529) Terminal Weight (g)
Dimensions
18 81 45
44 60
5,5
17,5
160
Connections
1 3 A1
N I 1 3
I N 1 3 A1 90... 260V 2 4 A2
A1 90...260 V AC/4...32 V DC
2 4 LOAD
2 4 A2
A2
Principles
Operating principles Contactor The contactor output is closed when the control voltage is present at the control input terminals. The contactor output is open when there is no voltage at the control input terminals. The LED is lit when the output is active. Impulse relay The impulse relay output changes state on each impulse at the control input terminals, and remains in that state between each impulse. The output changes state on the rising edge of the control state change. The pushbutton on the front can be used to select an operating mode : Automatic (LED lit) : Impulse relay function (Auto) Forced operation (LED flashing) : output closed (ON) Stop (LED not lit) : output open (OFF) Day/night contactor The contactor output is closed when the control voltage is present at the control input terminals. The contactor output is open when there is no voltage at the control input terminals. The pushbutton on the front can be used to select an operating mode : Automatic (LED lit) : Day/night contactor function (Auto) Forced operation (LED flashing) : output closed (ON) When the control changes state, the day/night contactor reverts to automatic mode. Stop (LED not lit) : output open (OFF) Conformity with standars IEC/EN 60947-4-3 (industrial environment) IEC/EN 60669-2-1 (domestic environment) IEC/EN 60601-1 (medical environment) IEC/EN 60947-7-1 (connection for industrial env.) IEC/EN 60998-2-1 (connection for domestic env.) Insulation coordination: Installation category: 3 Degree of pollution: 3 According to IEC/EN60669-2-1: Breakdown voltage according to IEC/EN60669-2-1: 2 KV/1Min / 1mA / 50 Hz Insulation resistance according to IEC/EN60669-2-1: > 5M /500VDC / 1Min Vibrations according to IEC/EN60068-2-6: frequencies: 10 to 55Hz amplitude: 0.35 mm
161
Specifications
Type Zero voltage switching (Triac) Current 12 A Output voltage 24 - 280 V AC Input voltage 90 - 140 V AC 4 - 32 V DC 180 - 280 V AC/ DC 90 - 140 V AC 4 - 32 V DC 180 - 280 V AC/ DC 180 - 280 V AC DC 4 - 32 V DC 90 - 140 V AC 4 - 32 V DC Code 84 130 150 84 130 101 84 130 100 84 130 152 84 130 103 84 130 102 84 130 118 84 130 116 84 130 158 84 130 117
20 A
24 - 280 V AC
25 A
48 - 660 V AC
25 A
48 - 660 V AC
Connections
GRD range - single-phase with triac GRD range - single-phase with SCR Zero voltage switching
1
3
U
1 2
4
3
Curves
GRD range 22.5 mm - 12 A (Triac)
I(A) 12 10 8 6 4 2 0 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 t ( C)
25 A (SCR)
I (A)
25 20 15 10 5 0 0 10 25 40 50 60 70 t ( C)
25 20 15 10 5 0 0 10 25 40 50 60 70 t ( C)
162
General characteristics
Output characteristics Voltage range (Vrms max) Peak voltage - t = min (V) Maximum off-state leakage at Vmax and T = 25 C (mAeff per phase) Minimum current mA(rms) per phase Max. 1-cycle surge A(peak) Max. 1-second surge A(peak) On-state voltage drop at I max V(peak) I t (t = 10 ms) (A2s) Static (off-state) dv/dt (V/s) Supply frequency range Cos (Zero voltage) Rth junction / ambient air (oC/W) Inputs specifications Input voltage Turn-off voltage (V) Maximum current at Vmax Nominal input resistance (k) Response time (close) (ms) Response time (open) (ms) General characteristics Operating temperature (oC) Storage temperature (0C) Input to output insulation voltage V(rms) Dielectric strength V(rms) Input/output capacitance (pF) Material housing Material baseplate Weight (g) Terminal capacity Triac : 24-280 Thyristor : 48-660 Triac : 600 Thyristor : 1200 Triac : 15 Thyristor : 20 Triac : 50 Thyristor : 100 Triac : 100-250 Thyristor : 750 Triac : 30-75 Thyristor : 145 Triac : 1.6 Thyristor : 1.6 Triac : 312-750 Thyristor : 1250 Triac : 200 Thyristor : 500 Triac : 47 80 Hz Thyristor : 47 80 Hz Triac : > 0.5 Thyristor : > 0.5 Triac : 4.9 - 3.6 Thyristor : 2.5 Triac : 90-280 AC/DC Thyristor : 4-32 DC Triac : 10 Veff Thyristor : 1 VDC Triac : 5.5 mAeff Thyristor : 12 mA Triac : 45 Thyristor : 3 Triac : 20 ms Thyristor : 0.5 cycle max. Triac : 30 ms Thyristor : 0.5 cycle max. -20 +80 -40 +100 4 000 2 500 8 Self-extinguishing (UL 94 V0) Aluminium 250 2 mm max.
Dimensions
11,25
5,15
87,70
4,5
98
80
43,85
163
Specifications
Type Zero voltage switching SCR output Current 35 A 45 A Instantaneous switching Thyristor output 35 A 45 A Output voltage 48 - 660 V AC 48 - 660 V AC 48 - 660 V AC Input voltage 90 - 280 V AC / DC 4 - 32 V DC 90 - 280 V AC / DC 4 - 32 V DC 4 - 32 V DC Code 84 130 110 84 130 111 84 130 115 84 130 113 84 130 112 84 130 114
General characteristics
Output characteristics Voltage range (Vrms max) Peak voltage - t = min (V) Maximum off-state leakage at Vmax and T = 25 C (mAeff per phase) Minimum current mA(rms) Max. 1-cycle surge A(peak) Max. 1-second surge A(peak) On-state voltage drop at Imax and T = 25 oC V(peak) I t (t = 10 ms) (A2s) Static (off-state) dv/dt (V/s) Supply frequency range Cos (Zero voltage) Rth junction / ambient air (oC/W) Inputs specifications Input voltage Turn-off voltage (V) Maximum current at Vmax Nominal input resistance (k) Response time (close) (ms) Response time (open) (ms) General characteristics Operating temperature Temperature stored Input to output insulation voltage V(rms) Dielectric strength V(rms) Input/output capacitance (pF) Material housing Material baseplate Weight (g) Input terminal capacity Output terminal capacity 48-660 1000 (1) 4 100 750 145 1.6 35A : 1260 45A : 5000 500 47 80 > 0.5 35A : 3.78 C 45A : 1.65 C/W 35A : 80-280 AC/DC 45A : 4-32 DC 35A : 10 Veff 45A : 1 V DC 35A : 10 mAeff 45A : 12 mA 35A : 45 45A : 3 35A : 20 ms 45A : 0.5 cycle max. 35A : 30 ms 45A : 0.5 cycle max. -20 +80 C -40 +100 C 4000 2500 8 Self-extinguishing (UL 94 V0) aluminium 490 2 mm max. 5.6 mm max.
164
Dimensions
35,70 3,20
5
4,5
87,70
98
80
Connections
GRD range - single-phase with SCR Zero voltage switching
3
U
43,85
4
U
1 2
Curves
GRD range 45 mm - 35 A
I (A)
GRD range 45 mm - 45 A
I (A)
45 40 35 30 25 20 15 0 10 25 40 50 60 70 t ( C)
45 40 35 30 25 20 15 0 10 25 40 50 60 70 t ( C)
165
Specifications
Type SCR zero voltage switching SCR Instantaneous switching Current 3 x 20 A 3 x 20 A Output voltage 48 - 660 V AC 48 - 660 V AC Input voltage 90 - 280 V AC / DC 4 - 32 V DC 4 - 32 V DC Code 84 130 311 84 130 310 84 130 312
General characteristics
Output characteristics Voltage range (Vrms max) Peak voltage (1 min) V(peak) Maximum current Maximum off-state leakage at Vmax and T = 25 C (mAeff per phase) Minimum current (mArms per phase) Max 1 cycle surge T = 25 oC A(rms) Max 1 second surge T = 25 oC A(rms) On-state voltage drop at Imax and T = 25 oC V(peak) I t (t = 10 ms) (A2s) Static (off-state) dv/dt (V/s) Supply frequency range Cos (Zero voltage) Rth junction / ambient air (oC/W) Inputs specifications Input voltage Turn-off voltage (V) Maximum current at Vmax Nominal input resistance (k) Response time (close) (ms) Response time (open) (ms) General characteristics Operating temperature (oC) Storage temperature (0C) Input to output insulation voltage V(rms) Dielectric strength V(rms) Material housing Material baseplate Input/output capacitance (pF) Weight (g) 48-660 1200 3x35 (A) 20 100 500 145 1.6 1260 500 47 80 Hz > 0.5 1 C/W 90-280 AC/DC 4-32 DC 10 Veff 1 V DC 10 mAeff 10 mA 45 3 20 ms 0.5 cycle max. 30 ms 0.5 cycle max. -20 +80 -40 +100 4000 2500 Self-extinguishing (UL 94 V0) aluminium 8 940
166
Dimensions
80,70 3,20 4,5
87,70
5 98 80
4,5
12,2 9,30 90
43,85
6,80 102,80
Connections
GRD range - three-phase with SCR
A1+
U
2 3
U
4 5
U
A2-
Curves
GRD range 90 mm - 3 x 20 A
I(A) 25 20 15 10 5 0 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 t ( C)
167
Specifications
Type SCR zero voltage switching SCR Instantaneous switching Current 2 x 25 A 2 x 25 A Output voltage 48 - 660 V AC 48 - 660 V AC Input voltage 90 - 280 V AC / DC 4 - 32 V DC 4 - 32 V DC Code 84 130 222 84 130 220 84 130 221
General characteristics
Output specifications Voltage range (Vrms max) Peak voltage (1 min) V(peak) Maximum current Maximum off-state leakage at Vmax and T = 25 C (mAeff per phase) Minimum current (mArms per phase) Max 1 cycle surge T = 25 oC A(rms) Max 1 second surge T = 25 oC A(rms) On-state voltage drop at Imax and T = 25 oC V(peak) I t (t = 10 ms) (A2s) Supply frequency range Cos (Zero voltage) Rth junction / ambient air (oC/W) Inputs specifications Input voltage Turn-off voltage (V) Maximum current at Vmax Nominal input resistance (k) Response time (close) (ms) Response time (open) (ms) General characteristics Operating temperature (oC) Storage temperature (0C) Input to output insulation voltage V(rms) Dielectric strength V(rms) Input/output capacitance (pF) Material housing Material baseplate Weight (g) 48-660 1200 2500 2x25A 100 500 135 1.6 1260 47 80 Hz > 0.5 0.95 90-280 AC/DC 4-32 DC 10 Veff 1 V DC 10 mAeff 10 mA 45 3 20 ms 0.5 cycle max. 30 ms 0.5 cycle max. -20 +80 -40 +100 4000 2500 8 Self-extinguishing (UL 94 V0) aluminium 940
168
Dimensions
80,70 3,20 4,5
87,70
5 98 80
4,5
12,2 9,30 90
43,85
6,80 102,80
Curves
GRD range 90 mm - 2 x 25 A
I(A) 25 20 15 10 5 0 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 t (C)
169
GN single-phase
GND DC output
FET transistor versions 10, 15 and 30 A Bipolar transistor version 10 A Control voltage : 3 to 32 V Optimum thermal response Available with or without protective cover UL/Cul, TUV approval and CE marking
Specifications
Type FET version Current 10 A 15 A 30 A 10 A 15 A 30 A Bipolar version 10 A 10 A Output voltage 1 - 200 V DC 1 - 100 V DC 1 - 50 V DC 1 - 200 V DC 1 - 100 V DC 1 - 50 V DC 3 - 60 V DC 3 - 60 V DC Input voltage 3 - 32 V DC 3 - 32 V DC 3 - 32 V DC 3 - 32 V DC 3 - 32 V DC 3 - 32 V DC 3 - 32 V DC 3 - 32 V DC Protective cover with protective cover with protective cover with protective cover without protective cover without protective cover without protective cover with protective cover without protective cover Code 84 137 850 84 137 860 84 137 870 84 134 850 84 134 860 84 134 870 84 137 750 84 134 750
General characteristics
Output characteristics Voltage range (Vrms max) FET 10A : 1 - 200 FET 15A : 1 - 100 FET 30A : 1 - 50 Bipolar 10A : 3 - 60 FET 10A : 14 FET 15A : 1 FET 30A : 1 Bipolar 10A : 10 FET 10A : 90 FET 15A : 120 FET 30A : 160 10A : 90 FET 10A : 2.25 FET 15A : 2.25 FET 30A : 2.45 Bipolar 10A : 3.75 1 FET : 20 Bipolar : 14.5 FET : 2 Bipolar : 100 FET : 100 Bipolar : 200 -20 +80 -55 +125 -40 +100 4000 2500 8 UL 94 V zamak With cover : 114 g Without cover : 97 g
Max. non-rep. 1 s surge (T=25 C) (A) Thermal resistance Junction to casing ( oC/W)
Inputs specifications Turn-off voltage (V) Max. controled current (mA) Response time (close) (ms) Response time on closing (ms) General characteristics Operating temperature (oC) Storage temperature (0C) Input to output insulation voltage V(rms) Dielectric strength V(rms) Input/output capacitance (pF) Material housing Material baseplate Weight
170
Dimensions
44,4 (1.75)
12,2 (0.48)
57,1 (2.25)
25,4 (1)
11,4 (0.45)
7 (0.275)
47,7 (1.88)
43,2 (1.7)
26,4 (1.04)
Curves
GN SSR FET 10 A GN SSR FET 15 A GN SSR FET 30 A
30.0
10.0
15.0
25.0
8.0
12.0
20.0
6.0
9.0
1
4.0
1
6.0
1 15.0
10.0
2.0
3.0
5.0
5
20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 75 80
0.0 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 75 80
0.0 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 75 80
0.0
2 3
1,5 C/W 2.0 C/W
2 3
1,5 C/W 2.0 C/W
2 3
1,5 C/W 2.0 C/W
10.0
8.0
6.0
1
4.0
2.0
0.0 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 75 80
2 3
2.0 C/W 3.0 C/W
171
GN single-phase
Specifications
Type Screw Current 10 A Output voltage 24-280 V AC Input voltage 3-32 V DC 18-36 V AC/DC 90-280 V AC/DC 3-32 V DC 18-36 V AC/DC 90-280 V AC/DC 3-32 V DC 18-36 V AC/DC 90-280 V AC/DC 3-32 V DC 18-36 V AC/DC 90-280 V AC/DC Code 84 134 900 84 134 902 84 134 901 84 134 910 84 134 912 84 134 911 84 134 907 84 134 908 84 134 909 84 134 917 84 134 918 84 134 919
25 A
24-280 V AC
Fast on
10 A
24-280 V AC
25 A
24-280 V AC
General characteristics
Output characteristics Range Non-rep. peak voltage (Vp) Maximum off-state leakage at Vmax and T = 25 C (mAeff per phase) Minimum current (mA) Max. non-rep.1-cycle surge (T=25 C) (A) Max. non-rep. 1 s surge (T=25 C) (A) I2 t (50-60 Hz) (A2 s) Voltage drop at Imax (T=25C) (V) Static dv/dt (V/s) Thermal resistance Junction to casing ( oC/W) Inputs specifications Range
24-280 V AC 500 4.75 100 30 (10 A) 75 (25 A) 100 (10 A) 250 (25 A) 50 - 41 (10 A) 288 - 240 (25 A) 1.65 (10 A) 1.85 (25 A) 200 3 (10 A) 2 (25 A) 3-32 V DC 18-36 V AC/DC 90-280 VAC/DC 3-32 V DC : 1 18-36 V AC/DC : 2 90-280 V AC/DC : 10 3-32 V DC : 14 18-36 V AC/DC : 8 90-280 V AC/DC : 8.5 3-32 V DC : 8.33 (60Hz) 10 (50Hz) 8-36 V AC/DC : 20 90-280 V AC/DC : 20 3-32 V DC : 8.33 (60Hz) 10 (50 Hz) 18-36 V AC/DC : 30 90-280 V AC/DC : 30 -20 +80 -40 +100 4000 2500 8 47 63 UL 94 V zamak 97
General characteristics Operating temperature (oC) Storage temperature (0C) Input to output insulation voltage V(rms) Dielectric strength V(rms) Input/output capacitance (pF) Frequency (Hz) Material housing Material baseplate Weight (g)
To order, see page 6
172
Dimensions
44,4 (1.75)
12,2 (0.48)
57,1 (2.25)
25,4 (1)
11,4 (0.45)
7 (0.275)
47,7 (1.88)
43,2 (1.7)
26,4 (1.04)
Curves
10 A 25 A
10.0
1.
2. 0
3.0
5.0
25.0
8.0
C/
W C/ W
C/
20.0
W
15.0
6.0
C/W
0 1. W C/
4.0
10.0
2.0
5.0
5
20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 75 80
0.0 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 75 80
0.0
173
DUAL
Rating 2x25A or 2x40A Output voltage 24 to 280 V Back-to-back SCR Instantaneous or zero volt switching Input to output insulation voltage : 4000 V Protection by RC filter UL-Cul approval Tv and CE marking
Specifications
Type Dual range Current 25 A 25 A 40 A 40 A 25 A 25 A 40 A 40 A Output voltage 24 - 280 V AC 24 - 280 V AC 24 - 280 V AC 24 - 280 V AC 24 - 280 V AC 24 - 280 V AC 24 - 280 V AC 24 - 280 V AC Input voltage 4 - 15 V DC 17 - 32 V DC 4 - 15 V DC 17 - 32 V DC 4 - 15 V DC 17 - 32 V DC 4 - 15 V DC 17 - 32 V DC Switching Zero voltage Zero voltage Zero voltage Zero voltage Instantaneous Instantaneous Instantaneous Instantaneous Code 84 140 000 84 140 010 84 140 200 84 140 210 84 140 100 84 140 110 84 140 300 84 140 310
General characteristics
Output characteristics Peak voltage (1 min) V(peak) On-state voltage drop at Imax and T = 25 oC V(peak) Max. leakage current mA (rms) Minimum current mA (rms) Max 1 cycle surge A (rms) @ 25 oC Max 1 second surge A (rms) @ 25 oC I2 t A2s) Static (off-state) dv/dt (V/s) Thermal resistance Junction to casing ( oC/W) Supply frequency range (Hz) Cos (Zero voltage) Inputs specifications Turn-off voltage (V) Maximum current at Vmax (mA) Characteristics Operating temperature (oC) Storage temperature (0C) Input to output insulation voltage V(rms) Dielectric strength V(rms) Input/output capacitance (pF) Material housing Material baseplate Weight (g) 550 1.6 7 100 500 (25A) 780 (40A) 150 (25A) 234 (40A) 1041 (25A) 2435 (40A) 500 0.6 (25A) 0.4 (40A) 47 63 > 0.5 1 V DC 32 -40 +80 -40 +100 4000 2500 8 Self-extinguishing (UL 94 V) Zamak 97
174
Dimensions
B
9,5 (0.375) 4,4 (0.175) 28,7 (1.131)
11,9 (0.47)
31,9 (1.256)
57,1 (2.25)
47,7 (1.88)
22,5 (0.886)
Connections
Equivalent circuits
A1
A2
B1
B2
5
Curves
25 A
A
50,0
40 A
A
80,0 70,0
40,0
60,0 50,0
30,0
40,0
20,0
30,0 20,0
10,0
10,0
0,0 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 75 80 C
0,0 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 75 80 C
0.7C/W 1.0C/W
1.5C/W 2.0C/W
0.5C/W 1.0C/W
1.5C/W 2.9C/W
Dual SSR thermal curves with both outputs switched on at the same time
Dual SSR thermal curves with both outputs switched on at the same time
175
GN single-phase
GN AC output
EMC compatible for industrial environments built-in transient protections Optimum thermal response Regulated control input Control status LED Available with or without protective cover
Specifications
Current 125 A 125 A 125 A 125 A 125 A 125 A 100 A 100 A 100 A 100 A 100 A 100 A 75 A 75 A 75 A 75 A 75 A 75 A 50 A 50 A 50 A 50 A 50 A 50 A 25 A 25 A 25 A 25 A 25 A 25 A 10 A 10 A 10 A 10 A 10 A 10 A Output voltage 48-660 V AC 48-660 V AC 48-660 V AC 24-280 V AC 24-280 V AC 24-280 V AC 48-660 V AC 48-660 V AC 48-660 V AC 24-280 V AC 24-280 V AC 24-280 V AC 48-660 V AC 48-660 V AC 48-660 V AC 24-280 V AC 24-280 V AC 24-280 V AC 48-660 V AC 48-660 V AC 48-660 V AC 24-280 V AC 24-280 V AC 24-280 V AC 48-660 V AC 48-660 V AC 48-660 V AC 24-280 V AC 24-280 V AC 24-280 V AC 48-660 V AC 48-660 V AC 48-660 V AC 24-280 V AC 24-280 V AC 24-280 V AC Input voltage 90-280 V AC/DC 18-36 V AC/DC 4-32 V DC 90-280 V AC/DC 18-36 V AC/DC 4-32 V DC 90-280 V AC/DC 18-36 V AC/DC 4-32 V DC 90-280 V AC/DC 18-36 V AC/DC 4-32 V DC 90-280 V AC/DC 18-36 V AC/DC 4-32 V DC 90-280 V AC/DC 18-36 V AC/DC 4-32 V DC 18-36 V AC/DC 90-280 V AC/DC 4-32 V DC 18-36 V AC/DC 90-280 V AC/DC 4-32 V DC 18-36 V AC/DC 90-280 V AC/DC 4-32 V DC 18-36 V AC/DC 90-280 V AC/DC 4-32 V DC 90-280 V AC/DC 18-36 V AC/DC 4-32 V DC 90-280 V AC/DC 18-36 V AC/DC 4-32 V DC Instantaneous with cover without cover 84 137 381 84 134 381 84 137 382 84 134 382 84 137 380 84 134 380 84 137 281 84 134 281 84 137 282 84 134 282 84 137 280 84 134 280 84 137 341 84 134 341 84 137 342 84 134 342 84 137 340 84 134 340 84 137 241 84 134 241 84 137 242 84 134 242 84 137 240 84 134 240 84 137 331 84 134 331 84 137 332 84 134 332 84 137 330 84 134 330 84 137 231 84 134 231 84 137 232 84 134 232 84 137 230 84 134 230 84 137 322 84 134 322 84 137 321 84 134 321 84 137 320 84 134 320 84 137 222 84 134 222 84 137 221 84 134 221 84 137 220 84 134 220 84 137 312 84 134 312 84 137 311 84 134 311 84 137 310 84 134 310 84 137 212 84 134 212 84 137 211 84 134 211 84 137 210 84 134 210 84 137 301 84 134 301 84 137 302 84 134 302 84 137 300 84 134 300 84 137 201 84 134 201 84 137 202 84 134 202 84 137 200 84 134 200 Zero voltage with cover without cover 84 137 181 84 134 181 84 137 182 84 134 182 84 137 180 84 134 180 84 137 081 84 134 081 84 137 082 84 134 082 84 137 080 84 134 080 84 137 141 84 134 141 84 137 142 84 134 142 84 137 140 84 134 140 84 137 041 84 134 241 84 137 042 84 134 042 84 137 040 84 134 040 84 137 131 84 134 131 84 137 132 84 134 132 84 137 130 84 134 130 84 137 031 84 134 031 84 137 032 84 134 032 84 137 030 84 134 030 84 137 122 84 134 122 84 137 121 84 134 121 84 137 120 84 134 120 84 137 022 84 134 022 84 137 021 84 134 021 84 137 020 84 134 020 84 137 112 84 134 112 84 137 111 84 134 111 84 137 110 84 134 110 84 137 012 84 134 012 84 137 011 84 134 011 84 137 010 84 134 010 84 137 101 84 134 101 84 137 102 84 134 102 84 137 100 84 134 100 84 137 001 84 134 001 84 137 002 84 134 002 84 137 000 84 134 000
Dimensions
44,4 (1.75) 27,9 (1.1) 11,9 (0.47) 32,2 (1.386) 20 (0.786) 6,35 (0.25)
44,4 (1.75)
12,2 (0.48)
60,2 (2.37)
47,7 (1.88)
57,1 (2.25)
43,2 (1.7)
8,5 (0.335)
25,4 (1)
25,4 (1)
11,4 (0.45)
7 (0.275)
47,7 (1.88)
43,2 (1.7)
26,4 (1.04)
176
General characteristics
General characteristics Operating temperature (oC) Storage temperature (0C) Input to output insulation voltage V(rms) Dielectric strength V(rms) Input/output capacitance (pF) Frequency (Hz) Material housing Material baseplate Weight (g) Control specifications Turn-off voltage (V) -20 +80 -40 +100 4000 2500 8 47 80 polycarbonate UL-94V Zamak IP20 : 114 IP00 : 97 4-32 VDC : 1V 18-36 VDC : 1V 90-280 VDC/AC : 10V 4-32 VDC : 14 18-36 VDC : 20 90-280 VDC/AC : 8.5 4-32 VDC : 8.33 (60Hz) - 10 (50Hz) 18-36 VDC : 20 90-280 VDC/AC : 20 0.1 4-32 VDC : 8.33 (60Hz) - 10 (50Hz) 18-36 VDC : 30 90-280 VDC/AC : 30 24-280 VAC : 600 48-660 VAC : 1200 10A : 300 25A : 500 50A : 780 75A : 1000 100A : 1200 125A : 1700 10A : 80 25A : 150 50A : 235 75A : 300 100A : 360 125A : 510 24-280 VAC : 2.5 - 4.25 48-660 VAC : 2.75 - 4.75 100 10A : 375-450 25A : 1041-1250 50A : 2535-3042 75A : 4166-5000 100A : 6000-7000 125A : 12041-14450 10A : 1.4 25A : 1.4 50A : 1.35 75A : 1.3 100A : 1.3 125A : 1.25 500 10A : 0.4 25A : 0.4 50A : 0.25 75A : 0.155 100A : 0.155 125A : 0.15
Output specifications Non-rep. peak voltage (Vp) Max. non-rep. 1 s surge (T=25 C) (A)
Maximum off-state leakage at Vmax and T =25C mA(rms) Minimum current (mA) I2 t (50-60 Hz) (A2 s)
177
Curves
GN 10 AMP SSR (1200 & 600 V)
10,0
25,0
50,0
8,0
20,0
40,0
6,0
15,0
30,0
1
4,0
1
10,0
20,0
2,0
5,0
10,0
0,0 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 75 80
0,0 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 75 80
0,0 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 75 80
2 3
3,0 C/W 5,0 C/W 7,0 C/W
2 3
1,0 C/W 1,5 C/W 2,0 CW 1,7 C/W 3,0 CW
2 3
0,5 C/W 0,7 C/W 1,5 C/W 1,0 C/W 2,0 C/W
75,0
125,0
100,0
5
1
70,0
50,0
60,0
75,0
50,0 40,0
1
50,0
25,0
0,0 20 25 30 35 40 45 50 55 60 65 70 75 80
0,0 0
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
0,0 0
10
20
30
40
50
60
70
80
2 3
0,4 C/W 0,5 C/W
1 C/W
2 3
0,7 C/W 1,5 C/W
0,25 C/W
0,4 C/W
0,7 C/W
2 3
0,5 C/W 1,0 C/W
0,25 C/W 0,4 C/W 0,7 C/W 0,5 C/W 1,0 C/W
178
GMS range
Complete, compact units DIN rail and panel mounting Input voltage 4-32 V DC regulated Input to output insulation voltage : 4 Kv LED display of input status Replaceable protection fuse UL-Cul approval and CE marking
e ab l vail n a m a ny N o er in G
Specifications
Type Transistor 17.5 mm Switching zero voltage Zero voltage Instantaneous Current 3A 5A 5A Output voltage 5-48 V DC 12 - 280 V AC 12 - 280 V DC Input voltage 4-32 V DC 4 - 32 V DC 4 - 32 V DC Code 84 130 104 84 130 105 84 130 108
General characteristics
Operating temperature (0C) Storage temperature (0C) Input to output insulation voltage (Vrms) Input/output capacitance (pF) Capacity of input and output terminals -30 to +80 -40 to +100 4000 8 With ferrule : 2 x 1.5 mm2 , Without ferrule : 2 x 2.5 mm2 and 1 x 4 mm2
Dimensions
18
5
81 45 40,65
49,5 65
17,5
Equivalent circuits
AC output module
1
DC output module
1
1
1
2
LED
3
3
2
LED
2
4
Curves
Sortie AC
5 4
Sortie DC
5 4
3 2 1 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70
3 2 1 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70
179
Relay-heatsink assemblies
Specifications
Type GA0-25 A GA3-25 A GA3-25 A GA3-25 A GA3-45 A 20 21 24 24 24 24 Relay 84 067 441 84 028 451 84 068 451 84 068 453 84 068 651 30 19 22 22 22 22 Sink 26 532 762 26 532 762 26 532 762 26 532 762 26 532 762 40 17 19 19 19 19 DIN rail adaptor 26 532 764 26 532 764 26 532 764 26 532 764 26 532 764 Temperatures (C) 50 15 17 17 17 17 60 14 15 15 15 15 70 11 12 12 12 12 Code 84 067 449 84 028 459 84 068 459 84 068 409 84 068 659 Protective cover 26 532 797 26 532 796 26 532 796 26 532 796 26 532 796 Code 84 067 449 84 028 459 84 068 459 84 068 409 84 068 659
Current (A)
180
181
PCB-mountable
Specifications
Type GA1 range GA8 range Current 4A 3A 4A 5A Input voltage 3 - 32 V DC 3 - 32 V DC 3 - 32 V DC 3 - 32 V DC 3 - 32 V DC 3 - 32 V DC Switching Zero voltage Instantaneous Zero voltage Zero voltage Instantaneous Zero voltage Code 84 064 131 84 025 040 84 065 040 84 065 131 84 025 030 84 065 030
General characteristics
Output characteristics Voltage range V (rms) max Peak voltage (1 min) V(peak) 24-280 / 24-480 24-280 : 600 24-480 : 850 24-280 : 4 or 5 depending on part no. 24-480 : 3 0.05 100 6 24-280 : 1.6 24-480 : 1.65 200 0.5 47 63 3-32 V DC 1 V DC 25 mA (at Vmax) regulated -30 +80 -40 +100 4000 Vrms 8 15
Maximum current A(rms) Minimum current mA(rms) Max. 1-cycle surge (Apeak) Max. leakage current (mAeff) On-state voltage drop at Imax and T = 25 oC V(peak) Static (off-state) dv/dt (V/s) Response time (close) (cycle) Frequency (Hz) Inputs specifications Input voltage Turn-off voltage (V) Max input current Nominal input resistance (k) Characteristics Operating temperature (oC) Storage temperature (0C) Input to output insulation voltage V(rms) Input/output capacitance (pF) Weight (g)
182
Dimensions
GA1
35,6 6,4
GA8
43,2
2,5
10,2
38,2
7,6
20,3
1,0
0,89 4 3 5,9 2 1
Connections
Equivalent circuits
4
1
+ 3
25,4
3+
30,5
3
3
1
2 1
2
1
10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80
2
20
40
2
60
80
183
SMART module
Specifications
Type Current " hockey puck " 15 35 mA Output voltage 4 32 V DC Input voltage 5 24 V DC Code 84 060 001
General characteristics
Electrical characteristics Maximum voltage (V DC) Minimum voltage (V DC) Max. voltage in stopped state (V DC) Line voltage V(rms) Peak voltage (1 min. max) V(peak) Leaking current (at maximum line voltage) mA (rms) DC power supply / Alarm output Voltage alarm output (V DC) Current alarm output (mA) Characteristics Operating temperature range (C) Storage temperature range (C) Input / output insulation voltage (limited to 1 mA for 1 sec. - Ta = 25 C) V(rms) 32 3 1 48 660 1200 8 4 32 60 -20 +80 -40 +100 4000
Dimensions
27,9
25,4
184
43,2
Connections
9 1
2 3 4 5 6
B Mains 48-660 V AC C Solid state relay D Alarm output (4-32 V DC) (1) E Auxiliary power supply (4-32 V DC (1) F Red LED : Alarm G Green LED : Input H SSR Input (3-32 V DC) (1) I Common J Load
The SSR input, the SMART MODULE alarm output and the SMART MODULE + power supply all share the same-terminal
7 8
Curves
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Operating principle The SMART MODULE can be mounted on any single-phase solid state relay with DC input / AC output in a "hockey puck" casing. The SMART MODULE has constant power supply to ensure that both the relay and the load being controlled are functioning correctly. The SMART MODULE provides information on the relay status by means of an LED display and an alarm output. Operation
B SMART SSR power supply C SSR input D Green LED E Mains presence F Load : closed circuit G SSR : external short-circuit on output terminals H SSR : output failed (internal short-circuit) I Alarm output J Alarm LED
Power is supplied to the SMART MODULE between its 4-32 V DC terminal (+) and the - terminal of the solid state relay control input. During correct operation when the relay is not being controlled, the alarm output is at 4-32 VDC and the LED are off. During correct operation when the relay is not being controlled, the green LED is on and the alarm remains at 4-32 VDC If the mains voltage is lost or there is a short-circuited on the relay output, the alarm output changes to 0 VDC and the red LED flashes. If the relay output is faulty, the alarm output changes to 0 VDC and the red LED comes on.
185
GZ range
Low-cost solid state relay - Triac output Extra-slim casing Output current 12 and 20 A Output voltages 24-280 V AC and 36-530 V AC Control input 4-15 V DC Version with low off-state leakage (no RC circuit) Optical isolation 4 KV UL-Cul approval and CE marking
Specifications
Type GZ range Current 12 A Input voltage 4 - 15 V DC Switching zero voltage Zero voltage Instantaneous Instantaneous Zero voltage Zero voltage Instantaneous Instantaneous Zero voltage Zero voltage Zero voltage Instantaneous Instantaneous Zero voltage Zero voltage Instantaneous Circuit RC no yes no yes no yes no yes yes no yes no yes no no yes Code 84 132 000 84 132 200 84 132 100 84 132 300 84 132 400 84 132 600 84 132 500 84 132 700 84 132 610 84 132 010 84 132 210 84 132 110 84 132 310 84 132 410 84 132 510 84 132 710
20 A
4 - 15 V DC
5
General characteristics
Output characteristics Voltage range V (rms) max Peak voltage (1 min) V(peak) Leakage current (mAeff) Off-state leakage at Vmax and 25 C - Low off-state leakage no RC circuit (mA) Static dv/dt - Standard (V/s) Static dv/dt Low off-state leakage-no RC circuit (V/s) Maximum current A(rms) Minimum current mA(rms) Max. 1-second surge A(peak) Max. 1-cycle surge A(peak) On-state voltage drop at I max V(peak) I t (t = 10 ms) (A2s) I2t (t = 8.33 ms) (A2s) Frequency (Hz) Thermal resistance Junction to casing ( oK/W) Inputs specifications Input voltage Turn-off voltage (V) Max input current (mA) Turn-on time (ms) (zero voltage relay) Turn-on-time (ms) (instantaneous relay) Response time on closing (cycle) Characteristics Operating temperature range (C) Storage temperature range (C) Input to output insulation voltage V(rms) Dielectric strength V(rms) Input/output capacitance (pF)
To order, see page 6
24-280 / 36-530 600 (24-280) 800 (36-530) 24-280 : 4.2 36-530 : 5.3 0.1 500 250 12 (24-280) 20 (36-530) 100 24-280 : 36 36-530 : 60 24-280 : 120 36-530 : 200 24-280 : 1.65 36-530 : 1.55 55 50 47 63 24-280 : 3 36-530 : 2.2 4 15 V DC 1 24-280 : 32 ma @ 15 V DC 36-530 : 63 ma @ 15 V DC 0.5 0.1 0.5 -20 +80 -40 +100 4 000 2 500 8
186
Dimensions
38,1 (1.5) 5,05 (0.199) 25,4 (1) 25,4 (1)
10,4 (0.41)
5,1 (0.2)
46,2 (1.82)
57,1 (2.25)
15,2 (0.6)
66,8 (2.63)
25,4 (1)
6,35 (0.25)
Connections
+ 3
Curves
12 A version
12,0 11,0 10,0 9,0
1
20 A version
20,0 18,0 16,0 14,0
5
0,5C/W 0,7C/W 1,0C/W 1,5C/W 2,0C/W
0 10 20 30 40 50
2
60
70
80
60 70 80
187
GA three-phase
Specifications
Type Alternative current Current 25 A Output voltage 24 - 480 V AC Input voltage 3 - 32 V DC Code 84 067 441
Accessories
DIN rail heatsinks Heat transfer compound Protective cover Code 26 532 764 18 373 112 26 532 797
General characteristics
Output characteristics Peak voltage (1 min) V(peak) Minimum current (mArms) Max 1 cycle surge T = 25 oC A(rms) Max. leakage current (mAeff) I t (t = 10 ms) (A2s) On-state voltage drop at Imax and T = 25 oC V(peak) Thermal resistance Junction to casing (C / W) Static (off-state) dv/dt (V/s) Frequency (Hz) Response time (close) (ms) Response time (open) (ms) Reversing time (ms) Inputs specifications Input voltage Turn-off voltage (V) Max input current Nominal resistyance (+/-10 % at 25 C) (k) Characteristics Operating temperature (oC) Storage temperature (0C) Input to output insulation voltage V(rms) Dielectric strength V(rms) Input/output capacitance (pF) Material housing Material baseplate Weight (g)
1 000 200 270 10 365 1.6 0.2 500 47 63 0.2 20 100 3 32 V DC 1 20 mA (input regulated current and limited) 1 -20 +80 - 40 to + 100oC 5 000 V AC 4000 V AC 8 Self-extinguishing aluminium 455
188
Dimensions
104 81 61 41 21 7,62
5,3
L1
L2
V
47,6 73,5
A1F 12,1
A2
A1R
92
6,35
2
18,5 22,6
Connections
Equivalent circuits
~ L1
L1 L2
L1 L2
U V V U M
A1F +
~U
L3
W
3
A2 -
~ L2
2
A1R + ~V
70
/W
50 40
2 C
3 C
/W
80 90
30 20 10
/W
/W
10
15
20
25 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80
B C D E F
Dissipated power (W) On-state current (A) Ambient temperature (C) Basseplate temperature (C) No heatsink
189
GA three-phase
GA3 three-phase
For controlling three-phase loads Rating 10, 25, 45 A Output voltages to 660 Vrms Control voltage 4-32 V = or 90-280 V AC Peak voltage : 1200 V Back-to-back SCR output Input to output insulation voltage : 4000 Vrms Protected against overvoltages by RC filter and overvoltage limiter Zero voltage or instantaneous switching
Specifications
Type Range GA3 Current 10 A 25 A Input voltage 4 - 32 V DC 4 - 32 V DC 4 - 32 V DC 90 - 280 V AC 4 - 32 V DC 90 - 280 V AC 4 - 32 V DC 90 - 280 V AC 4 - 32 V DC 90 - 280 V AC Switching Instantaneous Zero voltage Instantaneous Instantaneous Zero voltage Zero voltage Instantaneous Instantaneous Zero voltage Zero voltage Code 84 028 251 84 068 251 84 028 451 84 028 453 84 068 451 84 068 453 84 028 651 84 028 653 84 068 651 84 068 653
45 A
Accessories
General characteristics
Output characteristics Voltage range V (rms) max Peak voltage (1 min) V(peak) Minimum current mA(rms) Max. 1-cycle surge A(peak) 24-660 1200 200 10A : 160 25A : 270 45A : 450 10 10A : 128 25A : 365 45A : 1000 1.6 10A : 0.25 25A : 0.25 45A : 0.2 47 63 500 10 ms max. (3-32 VDC) 20 ms max. (90-280 VAC) 10 ms max. (3-32 VDC) 30 ms max. (90-280 VAC) 10 (90-280 AC) 20 (4-32 DC) 10 AC (90-280 AC) 1 DC (4-32 DC) 1 -20 +80 -40 to +100 4000 4000 <8 10 4 Self-extinguishing aluminium 450
On-state voltage drop at Imax and T = 25 oC V(peak) Thermal resistance Junction to casing (C / W)
Frequency (Hz) Static (off-state) dv/dt (V/s) Response time (close) (ms) Response time (open) (ms) Inputs specifications Max input current (mA) Turn-off voltage (V) Nominal resistance (k) Characteristics Operating temperature (oC) Storage temperature (0C) Input to output insulation voltage V(rms) Breakdown voltage (T=25C, 1 s) V(rms) Input/output capacitance (pF) Insulation resistance Material housing Material baseplate Weight (g)
To order, see page 6
190
Dimensions
1
104
47,6 0,1
-A2
A1+
5,1
92 0,2
23
A1+
U1
U2 V1
1 2
30
73,5
V2 W1
A2-
W2
B Input C Output
191
Curves
GA3 range - 10 A
35
C 1
GA3 range - 25 A
30 25
1
2 C /W
/W
100 80
1
0,5 C
1C
2C /
20 15 10 5
5
/W
60 40 20
/W
10
2
15
20 25 20 30
40 50 60
3
70 80
4
2
10 20
30
40 50
3
60
70 80
B Dissipated power (W) C On-state current (A) D Ambient temperature (C) E Baseplate temperature (C) F No heatsink
GA3 range - 45 A
B Dissipated power (W) C On-state current (A) D Ambient temperature (C) E Baseplate temperature (C)
0, 25 C
/W
/W
75 50
0,8
C 1C / W /W
25
10 20
2
30 40
20
30
40
50
3
60
70 80
B Dissipated power (W) C On-state current (A) D Ambient temperature (C) E Baseplate temperature (C)
192
Part numbers
For the G, GA5, GF and GT ranges For the 3-phase GA0 range and the GA3 range Sold in packs of 25 (representing 1 lot) per part number. Thermstrate is a registered trademark of Power Devices, Inc.
Part number
18 373 112
5
Part numbers
To ensure that the solid state relay is fully protected, we recommend the use of quick-blow fuses. Their role is to protect the solid state relay against short-circuits. The fuse rating is determined as follows : I2t fuse < I2t relay. Use the table below to determine the appropriate FERRAZ fuse for the solid state relay you have selected. These fuses can be obtained from your usual FERRAZ distributor (please consult us for a list of stockists). Very high breaking capacity fuses for protecting power semi-conductors. I2t fuse < I2t solid state relay
Range GN
I2t relay (A2s) 240 310 2800 2800 6000-7000 12041-14450 50 310 128 365 1000 365
Contact us
Part numbers
193
Part numbers
Thermal resistance G, GA5, GT, GF, 0.6 C/W GN 1 C/W Material: black anodised aluminium Range Length L = 100 mm L = 60 mm Weight 950 g 570 g 26 532 790 26 532 759
1 phase
120 11
17,5
60
85
3,8
Range 1 phase
Length L = 70 mm
40 10
66
4 x 10,35
Range 1 phase
20
Length L = 58 mm
55
5
67,5 10,5
50
Thermal resistance 2 x G, GA5, GT, GF 0.7 C/W 3 phases or 2 x 1 phase 1 x GA0, GA3, GN Material: black anodised aluminium
112
Range
Length L = 75 mm
Range 1 phase
17
Length L = 50 mm
24
76,2 87
41
Part number
26 532 801
10
10
M4
194
Part number
Characteristics Fits GA3 range Material Polycarbonate UL 94 V0 26 532 796
11,43
38,48 38,48 3,9 51,94 30,6 29,59 8,89 R 7,62 51,94 R 6,35
Material Polycarbonate UL 94 V0
26 532 797
11,43
5
4 13,34 36,83
30,73
Material Polycarbonate UL 94 V0
25,40
24,13 24,13
36,83
Part number
Characteristics Suitable for use with heatsinks 26 532 760, 26 532 761 and 26 532 762 Weight 55 g 26 532 764
47,6 22 44 8,7
65
195
196
www.crouzet.com
197
198
Selection guide
Module type Control voltage 5 V DC Output type Transistor 2 A Triac 0.5 A Transistor 0.5 A Transistor 2 A 24 V DC Triac 0.5 A Triac 1 A 1 changeover relay Output module 24 V AC/DC 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay 110 V AC/DC Transistor 0.5 A Triac 0.5 A Transistor 0.5 A 230 V AC Transistor 2 A Triac 0.5 A 230 V AC/DC 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay 1 NO relay 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay 1 changeover relay Max. switching voltage 5 to 48 V DC 24 to 250 V AC 5 to 48 V DC 24 to 250 V AC 10 to 280 V AC 250 V AC/DC 250 V AC/DC 250 V AC/DC 5 to 48 V DC 24 to 250 V AC 5 to 48 V DC 24 to 250 V AC 250 V AC/DC 30 V AC/36 V DC 30 V AC/36 V DC 30 V AC/36 V DC 30 V AC/36 V DC 30 V AC/36 V DC Min. current 1 mA 0.1 mA 0.1 mA 1 mA 0.1 mA 10 mA 10 mA/12 V DC 10 mA/12 V DC 10 mA/12 V DC 0.1 mA 0.1 mA 1 mA 0.1 mA 10 mA/12 V DC
50 mA 50 mA 50 mA 50 mA
199
Specifications
Type Changeover relay output 50 mA - 30 VAC / 36 VDC Control voltage 24 VDC 24 VAC / DC 110 VAC / DC 230 VAC / DC Normally open relay output 50 mA - 30 VAC / 36 VDC 24 VDC Control voltage range 19.2 30 VAC / DC 19.2 30 VAC / DC 95 121 VAC / DC 195 253 VAC / DC 19.2 30 VDC Current consumption 20 mA 20 mA 5 mA 5 mA 20 mA Code 84 145 061 84 145 062 84 145 064 84 145 066 84 145 071
General characteristics
Response time (close) (ms) Response time on closing (ms) Operating frequency (maxi) Mechanical life (operations) Electrical life (number of operations) Protection rating Operating temperature (oC) Storage temperature (0C) Weight (g) Contact 8 10 10 Hz 10 x 106 6 x 106 IP 20 -25 +60 -40 +80 35 AgSnO2 gold plated
Dimensions
Changeover relay output
4
44
70
83
44
70
35
90
78
6,2
6,2 34 48 65
35
48 65
Connections
84 145 061 / 062 / 064 / 066 84 145 071
200
Curves
84 145 061 / 062 / 064 / 066
A 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 0 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 C
Using information
Exceeding the value given for the output relay current will remove the gold plating from the contacts and we cannot then guarantee correct operation at low currents.
201
Specifications
Type Transistor output 0.5 A - 5 48 V DC Control voltage Control voltage range 10 44 V DC 70 130 V AC/DC 90 230 V AC 4 5.5 V DC 10 44 V DC 90 230 V AC 4 6.2 V DC 10 44 V DC 70 130 V AC/DC 140 250 V AC 10 44 V DC 19.2 30 V DC 19.2 30 V AC/DC 95 125 V AC/DC 195 253 V AC/DC Turn-off voltage (V) 5 V DC 30 V AC/DC 40 V AC 2 V DC 3 V DC 40 V AC 2 V DC 3 V DC 35 V AC/DC 80 V AC 3 V DC Max. current 2A 2A 2A 7A 7A 7A 2A 2A 2A 2A 40 A Current consumption 6 mA 7 mA 8.5 mA 6 mA 6 mA 7 mA 6 mA 6 mA 6 mA 7 mA 6 mA 20 mA 20 mA 5 mA 5 mA Code 84 145 001 84 145 004 84 145 005 84 145 010 84 145 011 84 145 015 84 145 020 84 145 021 84 145 024 84 145 025 84 145 031 84 145 041 84 145 042 84 145 043 84 145 046
24 V DC 110 V AC/DC 230 V AC Transistor output 5 V DC 2 A - 5 48 V DC 24 V DC 230 V AC Triac output 5 V DC 0.5 A - 24 250 V AC 24 V DC 110 V AC/DC 230 V AC Triac output 24 V DC 1 A - 24 250 V AC Relay output 24 V DC 6 A - 250 V AC 24 V AC/DC 110 V AC/DC 230 V AC/DC
Dimensions
Transistor or triac outputs
4
44
70
83
78
35
6,2
48 65
6,2 34 48 65
Connections
84 145 001 / 004 / 005 84 145 010 / 011 / 015 84 145 020 / 021 / 024 / 025 84 145 031
202
90
35
44
70
Curves
84 145 001 / 004 / 005
A 1 0.5 0 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 C
3 2 1 0 0 10 20 30 40 50 60
C
20 10
10
20
30
40
50
60
84 145 031
1 A
2 1 0
0 10 20 30 40 50 60 C 2
203
Industrial format
Its imaginative design enables either input or output modules to be connected to the mounting boards The boards can be used to create applications with between 4 and 32 channels.
www.crouzet.com
204
www.crouzet.com
205
206
Selection guide
Te m pe ra tu re O ut pu t 1
ty pe Al ar m N um of be di r sp la ys D es ig na ti o n ty pe ty pe 2
Temperature controllers
(-50 to +30C) Resistance temperature detector PT 100 (2-wire) Heating Thermocouple J Digital or Proportional derivative CT 48 A (0 to +40C) (0 to +120C) (0 to +200C) (0 to +400C) (0 to +250C) (0 to +450C) (0 to +600C) Thermocouple K (0 to +800C) (0 to +1200C)
100 to 240 VAC
Relay 5A
230 VAC
Su p vo ply l ta ge
C on tr ol
Ac t
In pu t
ut pu t
io
Page 210
CT 48 A
Universal configurable: Resistance temperature detector PT 100 (2-3-wire)/ Thermocouples J-K-R-S-L-N/Voltage Heating AND/ OR Cooling Resistance temperature detector PT 100 (3-wire)/ Thermocouples J-K-R-S-T-L-N/ Voltage/current
Relay 3A Relay 3A 1 1
(4 digits)
24 VAC/DC
100 to 240 VAC
24 VAC/DC
100 to 240 VAC
24 VAC/DC 100 to 240 VAC 24 VAC/DC Relay 1A 100 to 240 VAC 24 VAC/DC MIC 48 Page 212
Relay 3A 1
(3 digits)
CTD 43
100 to 240 VAC 24 VAC/DC Page 216 100 to 240 VAC CTD 43 24 VAC/DC
1 2
(3 digits)
CTD 46
Resistance Heating temperature detector AND PT 100 (3-wire)/ Cooling Thermocouples J-K-L-N
2
(3 digits)
CTH 46
With this function, the controller performs initial auto tuning of the PID control parameters and performs adaptive tuning of these parameters during operation
207
Sommaire gnral
The entire range incorporates an algorithm known as SMART. This algorithm calculates the PID control parameters automatically on starting (auto-tune) and during the process if any changes occur (adaptive tune) without any user intervention.
Measurement
Starting period
Starting period
The SMART function triggers its auto-tune action to calculate the PID parameters. This enables an optimum approach to reaching the setpoint.
Setpoint
Auto-tune
Adaptive tune
This makes it possible to prolong the lifetime of the heating element and avoid any thermal shocks. If you require this function, simply set the required output power (OLH) for preheating as well as its action time (t OL). On starting, the inhibition function for the temperature threshold alarm ensures that no fault indication will be acknowledged during preheating. In addition, these controllers also offer the possibility of programming a ramp to gradually increase power to further limit the risk of thermal shocks.
100%
Starting
tOL
Time
Display reading
12 10 8 6 4 2 constant programmed deviation (known as OFFSET) 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 Measurement with OFFSET without OFFSET
208
1.1
SP B
Note:
This function can also be applied to switching from SP to SP2. SP : Normal operating temperature of the process SP2 : Temperature when idle.
SP C SP A
2 ramps which can be programmed independently to switch from one setpoint to another 1st setpoint change 2nd setpoint change Time
Switching device
SP / SP2 are selected by an external switch without needing to touch the MIC 48 controller, and via the keypad on the CTD 24.
Communication via the RS 485 serial link compatible with C.BUS, MODBUS and J.BUS protocol
Main output
Time CY1
RPX PLC
MIC 48
REM C F ST
MIC 48 controller
SP2
209
CT48A
Input by J-K thermo-couple or by thermo-resistance Pt 2 regulation modes : ON/OFF or proportional Relay output
derivative selected by wiring 100 (2-wire)
Specifications
Type CT48A Designation Resistance temperature detector PT 100 Temperatures - 50 + 30 0 + 40 0 + 120 0 + 200 0 + 400 0 + 250 0 + 450 0 + 600 0 + 800 0 + 1200 Scale divisions 2C 1C 2C 5C 10C 10C 10C 10C 20C 20C Code 89 420 207 89 420 217 89 420 227 89 420 237 89 420 257 89 420 047 89 420 067 89 420 097 89 420 077 89 420 087
Thermocouple J
Thermocouple K
Accessories
Solder tag connector 8-pin Screw terminal or connector socket - 8-pin Protective cover IP 54 Code 25 622 301 25 622 303 79 237 709
General characteristics
Supply voltage Un Operating range Maximum power consumption Inputs Thermocouple according to IEC 584 Automatic cold-junction compensation Max. line resistance Resist. temp. detector Pt 100 according to IEC 751 Derating following line resistance Derating with regard to the setpoint Per 10 oC variation in ambient temperature Derating with regard to the setpoint Per 10 of line resistance variation Derating with regard to the setpoint Per10% variation in supply voltage Operation ON/OFF output action Fixed hysteresis Derived proportional output action Fixed proportional band (% of full scale) Derived proportiona output action Period proportional band Output Changeover relay Mechanical life (operations) Behaviour in the event of sensor failure Scale evolution Display accuracy J-K (full scale) Display accuracy Pt 100 (of the full scale) Temperature limit operation (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Insulation according to standard VDE 0110 Protection class according to DIN 40050 Casing Protection class according to DIN 40050 Front panel Mounting Connection Weight (g)
To order, see page 6
230 to 240 VAC 50/60 Hz 0.85 to 1.15 x Un 2 VA J-K For J - K : semi-conductor 150 2-wire 1 C / 0.4 J - K : 1 C Pt 100 : 0.1 C J - K : 1 C 0.1 %
0.4 % 3% 22 s
5 A / 250 V AC max. 3x10 5 Relay in rest position 80 mm 2% 1.5 % 0 +55 -20 +70 Group C for 250 IP20 IP41 Clip Solder terminals socket, 8 poles 350
210
Dimensions
Panel cut-out Screw terminal or connector socket - 8-pin base : ref. 25 622 303 for panel mounting Screw terminal or connector socket - 8-pin base : ref. 25 622 303 for mounting on DIN rail 35 mm EN 50022
Connector socket
Dimensions - mounting
Connections
Curves
ON/OFF output action - CT48A
1 2
2
5 3 4
3
4
B Temperature C Setpoint D Output ON E Output OFF F Time G Hysteresis (0.4 %) Other information
Other possible output type : solid state 0 Other possible supply voltages : 24 V AC and 110 V AC. Please consult us.
211
MIC48
Heating and / or cooling function 2 independent alarms Load break detection 2 setpoint which can be selected remotely Manual / automatic power adjustment RS 485 / MODBUS-JBUS serial communication option
Specifications
Type Without RS 485 link Voltages 100 to 240 VAC 24 VACDC With RS 485 link 100 to 240 VAC 24 VACDC Output Relay Logic Relay Logic Relay Logic Relay Logic Code 89 422 008 89 422 018 89 422 002 89 422 012 89 422 408 89 422 418 89 422 402 89 422 412
Accessories
Current transformers 10 A / 50 mA Current transformers 25 A / 50 mA Current transformers 50 A / 50 mA Current transformers for EIT 100 A / 50 mA Code 26 852 301 26 852 302 26 852 303 26 852 304
Dimensions
MIC 48
48
MIC 48
Current transformer
4 30 4
10 10
Panel cut-out
75
56
O1 U2 T 3
REM C F ST
5,5
27
60
SP2
2 x 2,9 5,5
9
13
122
48
19
45
20
- 0,6 0
38
20
212
45
- 0,6 0
Connections
Relay output
1
NO OUT 2 C OUT 2/3 NO OUT 3
Logic output
2 1 2
NO OUT 3
~
5
CT / SP - SP2
NO OUT 2
C OUT 2/3
~
5
CT / SP - SP2
11 6
C
12 7
NO
13 8
14 9 3
15 10 +
11 6 +
4
12 7 -
13 8
14 9 3
15 10 +
Applications
Display
12
B Lower display :
- setpoint - output power - heating element consumption (in amps) - abbreviation of the parameter selected during programming C Main output status LED, lit when the output is active.
MIC 48
2
D Cool output or alarm 1 output status LED, lit when the output is
11
E Load break alarm output and/or alarm output 2 status LED, lit when
REM C F ST
active
O1 U2 T 3
G Parameter modification and direct access to the setpoint H Parameter selection and validation in configuration and parameter
9
F
5 6 7
SP2
definition modes. This key is also used to display the output power and the heating element consumption I SP2 LED flashes slowly when control occurs at setpoint SP2. SP2 LED flashes rapidly when the setpoint value is programmed via the RS485 serial link J LED indicating the SMART function
K When the sensor input is connected to a thermocouple or a Pt100, L REM LED on when the controller is communicating via the RS485
serial link the LED corresponding to the selected unit of measurement is lit
M Upper display :
ming
213
MIC48
General characteristics
Supply Frequency (Hz) Tolerance Consumption Display measurement Display setpoint 100 to 240 VAC, 24 VACDC 50 / 60 -15 % +10 % Un 8 VA max. red LEDs-4 digits, 7 segment , height 10 mm green LEDs-4 digits, 7 segment, height 7.5 mm RS485 MODBUS, J.BUS 1 255 8 600 19 200 Bauds even, odd, no 1 > 100 M 1500 V Level 3 8000 V 0.2 % of the full measurement scale 1 digit at an ambient temperature of 25 oC at Un 0 +50 -20 +70 C 20 85 % Rh Input types and standard rangeRTD Pt100 Measurement range Decimal point
Characteristics Inputs
Thermocouples J, K, R, S, and N Thermocouples L Reference junction IEC 584-1 DIN 43710 Automatic cold junction compensation : 0 to 50 oC (Thermocouples) 0.1 C / C >1M
Serial link
Type Protocol Address Number of data bits Transmission speed Parity Stop bit
Reference junction drift Input impedance (k) Calibration (IEC 584-1) Resist. temp. detector 3-wire Pt 100 conforming to DIN 43760 Line resistance Input type and standard range TC
20 max. (Resistance temperature detector) L (0/400C) (0/1650F) (0/900C) J (0/400C) (0/1830F) (0/1000C) K (0/400C) (0/2190F) (0/1200C) N (0/1400C) (0/2550F) R (0/1760C) (0/3200F) S (0/1760C) (0/3200F) (-199.9/400.0C) (-199.9/400.0F) (-200/800C) (-330/1470F) adjustable : - - - -, - - - . -, - - . - -, - . -50 mA AC 10 A 100 A 10 to 20 A : 0.1 A 21 to 100 A : 1 A Relay output : NO or NC Logic output : level 1 or 0 50 ms - main setpoint : SP - auxiliary setpoint : SP2 50 mA AC selection via external N/C type contact
Temperature limit operation (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Relative humidity (no condensation)
Housing
Material housing Front panel Protection class according to IEC 529 (IEC 70-1) Connection Weight (g) self-extinguishing UL94 grade VO Polycarbonate membrane IP 54 screw terminals 250 in progress detects a fault in the equipment caused by external interference and activates automatic reset without modification of the process. the configuration and calibration are accessed via an internal switch, can only be accessed when the device is unplugged. PID with auto-tune and adaptive tune : SMART heat or cool heat / cool 250 ms 500 ms 1.0 to 100 % of scale amplitude 1.5 to 100 % of scale amplitude 0.1 to 10 % of scale amplitude 20 s to 20 min integral action is inactive 1 s to 10 min derivative action is inactive 1 s 200 s 1 s 200 s rC x heat proportional band 0.20 1.00
Output
Type of output Action type discontinuous can be programmed for heating and/or cooling Limitation of output power : SOFT- adjustable from 0 to 100 % START- heat action Limitation of output power : SOFT- adjustable from -100 to +100 % START-heat/cool action
Approvals
UL / CSA
Protection
Safe-guard
Switch
Output specification
OUT 1 Main output N/O contact OUT 1 Main output logic 3A 250 V AC resistive (N/C contact is possible via a jumper) Level 0 : <0.5 V DC Level 1 : 14 V DC20 % @ 20 mA max 24 V DC20 % @ 1 mA max 1 s 99 s N/O-2A contact, 250 V AC resistive N/O-2A contact, 250 V AC resistive
Control characteristics
Control algorithm Control type Sampling time linear input Sampling time TC and RTD input Proportional band Pb heat or cool Proportional band Pb heat - cool Proportional band Pb Note : if Pb = 0 % discrete action Hysteresis (during discrete action) Integral time ti Note : if ti > 20 min Derivative time td. Note : if td=0 Cycle time heating Cycle time cooling Heat-cool control Cool proportional band Heat-cool control rC : relative gain Heat-cool control dead.overlap band Main output cycle time OUT 2 Cool output or alarm 1 output OUT 3 Load break output and/or alarm 2 output
Reset to zero Inhibition Alarm threshold - absolute alarm Alarm threshold - band alarm Alarm threshold - deviation alarm
214
215
CTD 43/46
CTH 46 Heating / cooling function Measurement and setpoint display CTD 43 CTD 43 Heating or cooling function Measurement display Measurement deviation display-Setpoint via LED 1 configurable alarm CTD 46 CTD 46 Heating or cooling function Measurement and setpoint display 1 configurable alarm
Specifications
Type CTH 46 Supply voltage 100 240 V AC 24 V AC DC CTD 43 100 240 V AC 24 V AC DC CTD 46 100 240 V AC 24 V AC DC Output Relay Logic Relay Logic Relay Logic Relay Logic Relay Logic Relay Logic Code 89 422 508 89 422 518 89 422 502 89 422 512 89 421 108 89 421 118 89 421 102 89 421 112 89 422 108 89 422 118 89 422 102 89 422 112
Connections
CTH 46 relay output CTH 46 logic output CTD 43 relay output
7
B Supply C Main output 250 V AC / 3A resistive D Cool output 250 AC / 1 A resistive E 14-15 : Input 50 mA AC (Current
transformer connected for load break monitoring or selection of 2nd setpoint)
CTD 43 logic output
B Supply C Main output 0-24 V DC / 20 mA max D Cool output 250 V AC / 1 A rtesistive E 14-15 : Input 50 mA AC (Current
transformer connected for load break monitoring or selection of 2nd setpoint)
B Supply C Main output 250 V AC / 3 A D Alarm output 250 V AC / 1 A E Thermocouple or resistance temperature
detector connection
B Supply C Main output 0-24 V DC / 20 mA max D Alarm output 250 V AC / 1 A E Thermocouple or resistance temperature detector connection
To order, see page 6
216
General characteristics
Supply Frequency (Hz) Tolerance Consumption Display CTD 43 Display CTH 47 / CTD 46 Protection Switch Physical details and protection Insulation resistance conforming to IEC 348 Insulation voltage according to IEC 348 Immunity to interference conforming to IEC 801-4 Immunity to interference conforming to IEC 801-2 Accuracy Temperature limit operation (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Relative humidity (Rh no condensation) Housing Material housing Front panel Protection class according to IEC 529 (IEC 70-1) Connection Weight (g) Approvals Characteristics Inputs Thermocouples J, K, and N Thermocouples L Reference junction Reference junction drift Line resistance Calibration (IEC 584-1) Resist. temp. detector Pt 100 according to IEC 751 Line resistance Input type and standard range TC Input types and standard rangeRTD Pt100 Output Type of output Action type CTH 46 - CTD 43 - CTD 46 Limitation of output power : SOFT-START- heat action Limitation of output power : SOFT-START-heat/cool action Main output changeover relay Main output--logic 100 to 240 VAC 50 / 60 -15 % +10 % Un 5 VA Measurement or setpoint : red LEDs, 3-digit, 7-segment, height 10 mm Measurement : red LEDs, 3-digit, 7-segment, height 10 mm Setpoint : green LEDs, 3-digit, 7-segment, height 7.5 mm the configuration and calibration are accessed via an internal switch, which can only be accessed when the equipment is disconnected > 100 M 1500 V Level 3 8000 V 0.3 % of the full measurement scale at an ambient temperature of 25 oC at Un 0 +50 C -30 +70 C 20 85 % self-extinguishing UL94 VO grade polycarbonate membrane IP 54 screw terminals 160 UL/CSA
IEC 584-1 DIN 43710 Automatic cold junction compesation : 0 to 50 oC (Thermocouples) 0.1 C / C 100 max IEC 584 - 1 3-wire <4 L (0/800C) (0/999F) / J (0/800C) (0/999F) K (0/999C) (0/999F) / N (0/999C) (0/999F) (-199/500C) (-19.9/99.9F) (-199/999C) discontinuous heating-cooling adjustable from 0 to 100 % adjustable from -100 to + 100 % 3 A 250 V AC resistive Max. load : 700 Level 0 : < 0.5 V DC Level 1 : 14 V DC 20 % @ 20 mA max 24 V DC 20 % @ 1 mA max 1 s 200 s N/O-1 A contact, 250 V AC resistive N/O-1 A contact, 250 V AC resistive PID with auto-tune and adaptive tune : SMART heating or cooling heating-cooling 500 ms 1.0 % to 99.9 % of scale amplitude 1.5 % to 99.9 % of scale amplitude
Main output cycle time Cool output CTH 46 only Alarm output CTD 43-CTD 46 only Control characteristics Control algorithm Control type CTD 43 CTD 46 Control type CTH 46 Sampling time Proportional band Pb CTD 43 - CTD 46 Proportional band Pb CTH 46 Proportional band Pb. Note : if Pb = 0 % discrete action Hysteresis (during discrete action) Integral time ti Derivative time td. Note : if td=0 Cycle time heating Cycle time cooling (CTH46 only) Heat-cool control CTH 46 : Cool proportional band Heat-cool control : rC : relative gain Heat-cool control CTH 46 : dead.overlap band Alarms (on CTD 43 and CTD 46 only) Type of output Functions Reset to zero Inhibition Alarm threshold - absolute alarm Alarm threshold - band alarm Alarm threshold - deviation alarm Alarm
For more information www.crouzet.com
0.1 % to 10 % of scale amplitude 1 min 20 s to 20 min 0 s (10 s resolution) 1 s to 9 min 59 s 1 s 200 s 1 s 200 s rC x heat proportional band 0.20 1.00 -20 % to + 50 % of the heat proportional band direct or reverse absolute alarm, band alarm, deviation alarm manual can be configured absolute value independent from SP value relative to SP, adjustable from 0 to 500 C/F value relative to SP, adjustable from-199C/F (negative deviation) to +500C/F (positive deviation) 0.1 to 10 % of scale amplitude
217
Dimensions
CTH / CTD
48
Panel cut-out
75
56
ST
60
45
- 0,6 0
100
218
45
- 0,6 0
CTD 24
Concentrated technology and power, using the The Smart function ensures precision auto-tuning of
the CTD24 minimum of space.
Specifications
Type CTD 24 Output 1 relay 3 A-250 V resistive load Output 2 relay 3 A-250 V resistive load logic 14 V-20 mA logic 14 V-20 mA logic 14 V-20 mA Supply 100-240 AC 24 AC-DC 100-240 AC 24 AC-DC 100-240 AC 24 AC-DC Code 89 422 708 89 422 702 89 422 718 89 422 712 89 422 728 89 422 722
General characteristics
Display Universal input (configurable) Thermocouples 4 digits J (-100.0/999.9 C) (-150/1830 F) K (-100/1370 C) (-150/2500 F) R (-50/1760 C) (-60/3200 F) S (-50/1760 C) (-60/3200 F) T (-199.9/400 C) (-330/750 F) L (-100.0/900.0 C) (-150/1650 F) N (-100/1400 C) (-150/2550 F) 2 and 3-wire (-199.9/850.0C) (-330/1560 F) 0-60 mV, 12-60 mV 24 x 48 x 102 mm PID algorithm Auto-tune using SMART function Inverse and/or direct action Soft start function for preheating Configurable Control loop monitoring Selected with the ramp function between them Removable screw terminal block 90 IP 65 - Nema 4X
Universal input (configurable) Pt 100 Universal input (configurable) Linear Dimensions Control
Alarms 2 Reference points Connection Weight (g) Degree of protection of front panel
Dimensions
Outline and cut out dimensions
+0,3 0
80
22,2
24 102 8 48
35
50
45 0
+0,6
219
Temperature probes
Temperature probes
Thermocouple J :
- Nickel-plated brass eyelet - Stainless steel casing - Stainless steel sheath Thermocouple K PT 100 Class B : - Stainless steel sheath - Aluminium vee Connection / Sub-base / Flange
Specifications
Type Thermocouple / PT100 Designation Thermocouple probe J Temperature max : 400 C Characteristics Thermocouple probe J with nickelplated brass eyelet 6.5 mm, connection sleeve 5 x 30 mm in stainless steel 316 L. Glass filament cable with stainless steel braid : 2 m long Hot junction isolated from earth Thermocouple probe J with casing St. steel 304 L 3 mm : 500 mm long PVC cable : 2 m long Junction cannot be removed Junction isolated from earth Thermocouple probe J with sheath St. steel 16 L 6 mm : 200 mm long Glass filament cable with stailess steel braid : 2 m long Junction isolated from earth Thermocouple probe J with sheath ST steel 316 L 5 mm : 30 mm long Glass filament cable with stainless steel braid : 2 m long Junction isolated from earth Thermocouple probe K with casing St. steel 304 L 3 mm : 500 mm long PVC cable : 2 m long Junction isolated from earth PT100 probe Class B with sheath St. steel 316 L 6 mm : 200 mm long Silicon teflon cable : 2 m long 3-wire assembly PT100 probe Class B with sheath St. steel 316 L 6 mm : 30 mm long Glass filament cable with stainless steel braid : 2 m long 2-wire assembly PT100 probe Class B Aluminium vee : 50 mm long Silicom teflon cable : 2 m long 3-wire assembly Supplied with fixing clamp Code 79 696 030
max : 600 C
79 696 031
max : 400 C
79 696 032
79 696 033
Thermocouple probe K
max : 1100 C
79 696 034
max : 200 C
79 696 035
max : 400 C
79 696 036
max : 200 C
79 696 037
Accessories
Connection Characteristics Sliding connection 1/4 " BSP CYL. St. steel 316 L 3 mm Sliding connection 1/4 " BSP CYL. St. steel 316 L 6 mm Sliding connection 1/2 " BSP CYL. St. steel 316 L 6 mm Sliding connection 1/4 " BSP CYL 12 mm Nickel-plated steel Galvanised steel flange 6 mm Code 79 696 038 79 696 039 79 696 040 79 696 041 79 696 042
Sub-base Flange
220
Dimensions
Connection : 79 696 038
12
34
1/4 G
1/4 G
3
19
11
6
19
11
6
27
15
12
12
1/4 G
64,5 85
B 17 across flat
Thermocouple probe J : 79 696 030
2000
30
500
5 6,5
40
45
2000
1/2 G
180 20
30
6
15
12,5
500
45
2000
6
180 20
30
15
12,5
B Aluminium vee
15
221
222
www.crouzet.com
223
Selection guide
Counters
in g
in pu t
ge
(m
et
on s
M ax sp . c ee ou d nt
re s
vo l
io
D im en si
io
C ou nt e
M an ua l
na t
Fu nc t
Su pp l
D is
D es
24 V DC 24 V AC
5 digits
50 to 60 Hz -
Yes 115 V AC 230 V AC 24 V DC 24 V AC Electromechanical counter 24 x 48 mm No 115 V AC 230 V AC Volt-free or Solid state contact Voltage CP2 2293 CP2 2294 Lithium battery Yes CP2 2108 CP2 2231 CP2 2232 C108 sealed version No Page 246 Voltage 108 Yes Page 258 108 Page 256 Page 240 CP2 Solid state Page 250
Ti
m in g
pl a
ig
ra
ng e
ta
6 digits 24 x 48
50 to 60 Hz
7 KHz
7.5 KHz
WITHOUT PRESELECTION
28 x 53
LCD 8 digits
7.5 KHz
Volt-free contact
Lithium battery
36 x 37
Page 260
Electromechanical counter 36 x 37 mm
24 V DC 24 V AC
5 digits
50 to 60 Hz -
36 x 48
Page 264
24 V DC 24 V AC
6 digits
50 to 60 Hz
Electromechanical counter 36 x 48 mm
36 x 72
LCD 8 digits
5 KHz
Lithium battery
Yes
3233
Page 254
224
in g
in pu t
ge
(m
et
M ax sp . c ee ou d nt
D im en si
C ou nt e
M an ua l
pl a
na t
io
7 KHz
Lithium battery Lithium battery 18 to 26 V AC 36 to 48 V AC 110 to 127 V AC 220 to 240 V AC 24 to 30 V AC 110 to 127 V AC 220 to 240 V AC
Yes
Ti m in g
Fu nc t
Su pp l
D es
D is
ig
ra ng e
ta
on s
re s
vo l
io
Page 240
24 x 48
Page 242
CP2
No
CH 48 G
Hour
Page 266
60 Hz
CH 48 G
C108 sealed version No Hour totalizer 28 x 53 module LCD 8 digits 7.5 KHz Volt-free contact Lithium battery Yes 108 ER Totalizer and ratemeter Tachometer 36 x 72 36 x 72 LCD 8 digits LCD 6 digits 5 KHz 5 KHz Volt-free contact. Solid state or Voltage Volt-free contact. Solid state or Voltage Lithium battery Lithium battery Yes Yes 3293 3253 108 108 E 108 R Hour
Page 256
Page 258
3293
3253
225
um b U er P o Up D c fp N ou r C Dow nting ese U n ts D MU coun IR ti IN Di L Cu ng D rec m PH Ind tiona ulativ ep l e PH Enc ende up-do coun 2 oder nt up wn c ting PH E ph -d ou nc a o n B 4 En oder se sh wn c ting AT co ph ift oun de ase tin C r g D H B phas shift im at e s X2 ch hif en c t si ounti X4 ng on s D (m is m pl ) ay
sp ee
(K
z)
ou nt in g
ta
ge
vo l
io
M ax .c
ut pu t
Fu nc t
Su pp l
10 to 30 VDC 1 changeover 20 to 55 VAC 1 x x x 48 x 48 LCD 5 digits 5 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 1 contact and 20 to 55 VAC 1 solid state 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 1 changeover 20 to 55 VAC 1 x x x 48 x 48 LCD red 5 digits 5 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 1 contact and 20 to 55 VAC 1 solid state 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC LCD 6 digits 1 x x x x x x x x 72 x 72 LCD red 6 digits 5 20 to 55 VAC CP7 7141 1 contact and 80 to 260 VAC 1 solid state 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC CP7 7341 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 2 contact WITH PRESELECTION 2 x x x 48 x 48 LCD 5 digits 5 2 solid state Upcounter Downcounter 2 contact 2 x x x x 48 x 48 LCD 5 digits 5 2 solid state 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 2 contact 2 x x x 48 x 48 LCD red 5 digits 5 2 solid state 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 2 contact 2 x x x x LCD red 48 x 48 5 digits 5 2 solid state 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC LCD 6 digits 2 x x x x x x x x 72 x 72 LCD red 6 digits 5 20 to 55 VAC CP7 7142 2 changeover 80 to 260 VAC and 2 solid 10 to 30 VDC state 20 to 55 VAC CP7 7342 80 to 260 VAC Page 236 CP4 4344 Page 233 CP4 4342 CP4 4342 Page 233 CP4 4144 Page 232 CP4 4142 Page 232 Page 237 CP7 7141 Page 236 CP4 4341 Page 233 CP4 4141 Page 232
D es
ig
na t
io
CP4 4141
226
tio ula PH na tiv lu ec p- o PH Enc do un od wn tin 2 er PH E ph co g n un tin 4 code ase s B En r h g AT co ph ift de ase C r s D H B phas hift X im at e s 2 en ch co hift X un 4 si on ting s D (m is m pl ) ay
Di Cu re c m
vo l
Fu nc t
Su pp l
IN
10 to 30 VDC 2 contact 2 x x x x x x x x x 48 x 48 LCD 5 digits 7.5 2 solid state WITH PRESELECTION 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC Upcounter Downcounter Batch counter Chronometer Tachometer LCD 6 digits 2 x x x x x x x x x 72 x 72 LCD red 6 digits 7.5 2 x x x x x x x x x 48 x 48 LCD red 5 digits 7.5 2 solid state 2 contact 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC CP7 7192 2 changeover 80 to 260 VAC and 2 solid 10 to 30 VDC state 20 to 55 VAC CP7 7392 80 to 260 VAC Page 236 CP4 4392 Page 233 CP4 4192 CP4 4192 Page 232
D es
Ind
ig
ep
io
na t
e nd
io
nt
ta
up
ge
-d
n ow
co
un
M ax .c ou nt in g O sp ut pu ee d t
tin
(K H z)
Reminder of input counting modes: UP . . . . . DN . . . . CUMUL DIR . . . . IND . . . . PH . . . . . PH2 . . . PH4 . . . BATCH . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . Upcounting Downcounting Cumulative counting Directional up-down counting Independent up-down counting Encoder phase shift Encoder phase shift X2 Encoder phase shift X4 Batch counting
227
Motor
Slowdown
P1 OUT1 P2 OUT2
MODE
P1
P2
RST
CP7
Encoder
Slowdown
Stop
P RST
CP4
8
Amount dispensed
Fast-fill valve
P1 OUT1 P2 OUT2
Slow-fill valve
MODE
P1
P2
RST
CP7
Control of filling
228
Tachometers
Motor Motor
Inductive sensor
3293
229
General
Tachometers can be used to measure speeds (of linear or rotary movement), rates (per minute or per hour), or rates of flow (volumetric, etc.). Pulses are fed to the tachometer at the frequency to be measured. A scale factor is applied to produce readings of the desired type (linear speeds, flow rates, etc.). Crouzet/Syrelec tachometers operate on 2 different principles : 1 - The fixed time base principle, and 2 - The reciprocal principle
the sampling time (Tr) the time limit for measurement (TL)
TR TL T
Measurement begins
Measurement ends at the rising edge of the first pulse after Tr. If no pulse is received after T, the system waits until the time limit TL and then shows zero on the display. If the frequency of the signal is low, conditions are as shown below :
Once the time base has been calculated, it is set by means of DIP switches (or changeover switches) situated on the unit. As an example: Assume a sensor emits 8 pulses per revolution. What you want to see on the display is a speed in revs per minute. The maximum this speed can be is 2000 rpm. Nd = 8 Nt = 2000 V = Nt (since what you want displayed is a speed in rpm).
B = 2000 x60 = 7,5 secondes 2000x8
The interval between 2 rising edges is very much longer than Tr. The tachometer displays 0 until time T, at which it displays the new value.
Fixed time base tachometers are useful for high speeds but, if the accuracy obtained is to be good, it is essential for the number of pulses per revolution to be high. To overcome this drawback, Crouzet Automation can supply reciprocal tachometers. These need only a single pulse per revolution and are able to measure both high and low speeds.
to obtain a frequency.
230
Inputs specifications
2 counting inputs IN1, IN2 Input modes UP, DN, CUMUL, DIR, IND PHASE, PHASE x 2 PHASE x 4 0 - 2000 m Input by contact, voltage or solid state device for 3-wire and 2-wire 2.5 k Conforming to IEC 1000.4.2 : Level 3 detection using external resistor Conforming to IEC 1000.4.3 : Level 3 (NPN or PNP if present) Conforming to IEC 1000.4.4 : Level 3 Low level Conforming to IEC 1000.4.6 : Level 3 High level Conforming to EN 55022/11 group 1 : Impedance Class A Counting speed 10 - 55 Hz / 0.35 mm Counter Self-extinguishing
Vibration resistance in 3 axes acc. to IEC 68-2-6 Material Connection by screw terminals Tightening capacity Mounting Front panel, by clip Front panel protection Front panel watertight seal Temperatures limits use (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Weight (g) Type NPN open collector Maximum current Maximum voltage Voltage drop Response time
2 x 1.5 mm
IP 54
4.0 kHz 5.0 kHz 4.0 kHz 2.5 kHz 9.0 kHz 9.0 kHz 5.0 kHz 4.0 kHz From front panel : if not protected in programming phase Electrical : by contact, voltage or solid state device (NPN or PNP if present) 5 ms 0 1 V DC 4 30 V DC 10 K
Reset
Reset to zero or to preset
10 30 V DC 20 55 V AC 80 260 V AC 4W 10 VA
Minimum pulse time Low level High level Impedance Option to protect against reset from front panel Scale factor (each input pulse is multiplied by this figure) Decimal point selectable for ease of reading Sensor supply Version AC Sensor supply Version DC Programming and current value backed up via EEPROM memory
Operating characteristics
Functions Preselection up/down counter Multifunction : counters, "Batch" counters, tachometers and chronometers 1 or 2 Current value : 5 digits Preset : 5 digits Current value : 8 mm Preset : 4 mm -9999 - + 99 999
Number of presets Back-lit LCD or red illuminated display Height of digits Display details Simultaneous readout of count value and preset
231
Specifications
Type 4141-1 preset Time base Counting input modes UP, DN, PH Designation Up/down counter Output 1 contact and 1 solid state Voltages 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 V 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VDC 80 to 260 VDC 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VDC 80 to 60 VDC Code 87 618 012 87 618 014 87 618 018 87 618 042 87 618 044 87 618 048 87 618 062 87 618 064 87 618 068 87 618 022 87 618 024 87 618 028 87 618 072 87 618 074 87 618 078 87 618 032 87 618 034 87 618 038 87 618 262 87 618 264 87 618 268 87 618 222 87 618 224 87 618 228
1 changeover relay
4142-2 preset
UP, DN, PH
Up/down counters
2 solid states
2 contacts
4144-2 preset
Up/down counters
2 solid states
2 contacts
4192-2 preset
99h59min - 99min59s UP, DN, IND, CUMUL, DIR, - 99.99s -24h PH, PH2, PH4
Multifunctions : NO, 2 solid states Counters - "Batch" counters tachometers and NO, 2 contacts chronometers
Connections
87 618 042 87 618 044 87 618 048
1
B Supply
B Supply
B Supply
B Supply
232
Specifications
Type 4341-1 preset Time base Counting input modes UP, DN, PH Designation Up/down counter Output NO, 1 contact and 1 solid state 1 changeover relay Voltages 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC Code 87 618 112 87 618 114 87 618 118 87 618 142 87 618 144 87 618 148 87 618 162 87 618 164 87 618 168 87 618 122 87 618 124 87 618 128 87 618 172 87 618 174 87 618 178 87 618 132 87 618 134 87 618 138 87 618 362 87 618 364 87 618 368 87 618 322 87 618 324 87 618 328
4342-2 preset
UP, DN, PH
Up/down counters
NO, 2 contacts
4344-2 preset
Up/down counters
NO, 2 contacts
4392-2 preset
99h59min - 99min59s UP , DN , IND , CUMUL , DIR Multifunctions : NO, 2 solid states - 99.99s - 24h , PH , PH2 , PH4 Counters - "Batch" counters Totalizers Tachometers Chronometers
Dimensions
CP4 Panel cut-out
1
48
RST
8
45
+0.6 0
11 114
48
45
+0.6 0
2 3
233
234
Inputs specifications
2 counting inputs IN1, IN2 1 inhibit input Input modes UP, DN, CUMUL, DIR, IND PHASE, PHASE x 2 PHASE x 4 Contact, voltage or solid state (NPN/PNP by changeover switch) Low level High level Impedance
0 1 V DC 4 30 V DC 10 k 5 kHz (2.5 kHz in phase 4) 30 Hz in debounce mode 7.5 kHz 7.5 kHz
Counting speed
Counter
Vibration resistance in 3 axes acc. to IEC 68-2-6 Material Connection by screw terminals Terminal capacity Mounting Front panel, by clip Front panel protection Front panel watertight seal Temperatures limits use (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Weight (g) Type NPN open collector Maximum current Maximum voltage Voltage drop Response time
2 x 1.5 mm
IP 54
4.0 kHz 5.0 kHz 4.0 kHz 2.5 kHz 9.0 kHz 9.0 kHz 5.0 kHz 4.0 kHz 6.0 kHz 6.0 kHz 3.0 kHz 3.5 kHz 1.5 kHz From front panel : if not protected in programming phase Electrical : by contact, voltage or solid state device (NPN or PNP if present) 5 ms 0 1 V DC 4 30 V DC 10 k
Reset
Reset to zero or to preset
Operating characteristics
Functions Preselection up/down counter Multifunction : counters, "Batch" counters, tachometers and chronometers 1 or 2 Current value : 6 digits Preset : 6 digits Current value : 10 mm Preset : 6 mm -9999 - + 99 999
Number of presets Back-lit LCD or red illuminated display Height of digits Display details
Minimum pulse time Low level High level Impedance Option to protect against reset from front panel Scale factor (each input pulse is multiplied by this figure) Decimal point selectable for ease of reading Sensor supply Version AC Sensor supply Version DC Programming and current value backed up via EEPROM memory
235
Specifications
Type 7141- 1 preset Time base Counting input modes UP, DN, IND, CUMUL, DIR, PH, PH2, PH4 UP, DN, IND, CUMUL, DIR, PH, PH2, PH4 Designation Up/down counters Voltages 10 to 30 VDC 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC Up/down counters 2 changeover relays 10 to 30 VDC + 2 solid states 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC Multifunctions : 2 changeover relays 10 to 30 VDC Counters - "Batch" + 2 solid states 20 to 55 VAC counters 80 to 260 VAC Tachometers and chronometers Totalizers Output 1 changeover realy + 1 solid state relay Code 87 619 012 87 619 014 87 619 018 87 619 022 87 619 024 87 619 028 87 619 222 87 619 224 87 619 228
7142-2 preset
7192-2 preset
99h59min - 99min59s - 99.99s UP, DN, IND, CUMUL, DIR, - 24h - 999.99h - 999.99min PH, PH2, PH4
Connections
87 619 012 87 619 014 87 619 018 87 619 112 87 619 114 87 619 118 87 619 022 87 619 024 87 619 028 87 619 122 87 619 124 87 619 128
8
B Supply B Supply
236
Specifications
Type 7341-1 preset Time base Counting input modes UP, DN, IND, CUMUL, DIR, PH, PH2, PH4 UP, DN, IND, CUMUL, DIR, PH, PH2, PH4 Designation Up/down counter Output Voltages 1 changeover relay + 10 to 30 VDC 1 solid state 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 260 VAC Up/down counter 2 changeover relays 10 to 30 VDC + 2 solid states 20 to 55 VAC 80 to 55 VAC Multifunctions : 2 changeover relays 10 to 30 VDC Counters - "Batch" + 2 solid states 20 to 55 VAC counters 80 to 260 VAC Totalizers Tachometers Chronometers Code 87 619 112 87 619 114 87 619 118 87 619 122 87 619 124 87 619 128 87 619 322 87 619 324 87 619 328
7342-2 preset
7392-2 preset
99h59min - 99min59s - 99.99s UP, DN, IND, CUMUL, DIR, - 24h - 999.99h - 999.99 min PH, PH2, PH4
Dimensions
CP7
1
72
P1 OUT1 P2 OUT2
Panel cut-out
P1
P2
RST
10 112
72
68
+0.6 0
68
+0.6 0
237
Compteurs prselection et multifonctions CP4 - CP7 Preselection and multifunction counters CP4 - CP7
Input modes Modes d'entres
Input modes
PNP Count on rising edge NPN Count on falling edge
Output modes
Count in the direction of the cycle Count in the opposite direction from the cycle
Single shot
UP
1 Input IN1 2 Display 1 2
0 1 2 3 4 5 6
1 Preset
PR 0 P-----------1 0 P -1 P+1 -2--------------P+2-------------1 P+1 0 P 1------P-1---ON OFF 0 PR 0 1----- P-1
1 Input IN1
1 2
n n-1 n-2 n-3 n-4 n-5 n-6
or ou
DN
2 Display Maintained
2 Presets
PR 0 P2-----P1+1 P1 P1 P1-1 P1-2-------------- P1-1 P1 P1+1---0 PR 0 1----- P1-1 P1+1 P1+2------------ P1+1 P1 P1-1---ON OFF
IND
1 Input IN1 count in the direction of the cycle 2 Input IN2 count in the opposite direction from the cycle 3 Display (0 P) 2 channel up/down counter 4 Display (P 0) 2 channel up/down counter
1 2 3 4
0 n 1 n-1 2 n-2 3 2 1 0 n 1 n-1 n-3 n-2 n-1
1 Preset
PR 0 --------- 1 0 PR 0 1----- P-1 0 P -1 P+1 -2------- -1 P+2 P+1 0 P 1 P-1 2 P-2 3-----P-3---ON OFF t1 t1
2 Presets
PR 0 P2---------P1+1 P1 P1-1 P1-2---P1+1 P1+2--P1 P1+1 P1+2 --------P1 P1-1 P1-2 --------ON OFF 0 n 1 n-1 3 n-3 4 n-4 5 n-5 7. . . n - 7. . . t t
1 Input IN1 count in the direction of the cycle 2 Input IN2 count in the direction of the cycle CUMUL 3 Display (0 P) 2 channel up/down counter 4 Display (P 0) 2 channel up/down counter
1 2 3 4
0 PR 0 1----- P1-1
P1
Repetitive cycle
Pulsed with auto reset to value of P2 (or P for 1 preset) (t = 500 ms) t = 0.1s to 9.9s for multifunction
PR 0 P2 P2-1 ----1 P2 P2-1 0 PR 0 1----- P2-1 0 1 -----------n n+1 ----- P2 P2+1 -----------n n-1 ----0 -1 ON OFF t
DIR
1 Input IN1 pulses 2 Input IN2 count in the opposite direction from the cycle 3 Display (0 P) 1 channel up/down counter 4 Display (P 0) 1 channel up/down counter
1 2 3 4
0 n 1 n-1 Up 2 n-2 3 2 DOWN 1 0 n Up 1 n-1
PH
1 2 3 4
=0 1 2 n-2 3 4 3 2 =n n - 1 n - 3 n-4 n - 3 n - 2
PH 2
1 Input IN1, counts on rising and falling edges 2 Input IN2, direction of count reversed if IN2 in advance of IN1 3 Display (0 P) 4 Display (P 0)
1 2 3 4
0 1 2 3 4 5 4 3 2 1 n n-1 n-2 n-3 n-4 n-5 n-4 n-3 n-2 n-1
Example
On a packing line, bottles need to be counted into packs of 6 bottles and then dispatched in a box containing a batch of 4 packs. P2 : current counter preset value : 00006 P1 : batch counter preset value : 00004
PH 4
1 Input IN1, counts on rising and falling edges 2 Input IN2, counts on rising and falling edges, direction of count reversed if IN2 in advance of IN1 3 Display (0 P) 4 Display (P 0)
1 2 3 4
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7
Current counter
Batch counter
Totalizer function
On multifunction CP7 Totalizer reset via front panel only Current value reset via front panel and electrical.
238
Signal to be measured
Time TR Time TL
The outputs are updated each time measurement ends according to the selected output mode. Maintained output : output active if the measured speed is greater than the preset speed. Pulsed output : output activated during time T, when the preset threshold is crossed.
Start of measurement
End of measurement
Measurement precision : 100 + (200 / TR) PPM Example : for TR = 1s 300 PPM (0.03%)
Speed
P2 P1
Speed P1
P2
0
Out 1 (1) Out 2 Out 1 (2) Out 2
t
(1)
0
Out 1 Out 2 Out 1 (2) Out 2
Application example
You wish to display a linear speed of 2.00 m/s for a drive pulley rotating at 300 rpm. A sensor on this pulley delivers one pulse per revolution, ie: Ns Cf RPX n In addition, the decimal point is positioned in the hundreds (xxxx.xx). Selection of TR : you wish the measurement to be updated every 2 seconds if TR = 2s. Selection of TL > TR, for example TL = 3s.
V=
Required display: V = 2.00 (result in m/s RPX = 1) Given that: n = 1 300 Ns = =5 60 Hence Cf = Vn Ns RPX
300 rpm
0
2 m/s
Cf =
200 1 = 40 51 The tachometer function can also be used to calculate a flow rate.
1 Input IN1 2 Display (0 PR), 1-channel pulse measurement 3 Display (PR 0), 1-channel 3 pulse measurement 1 Input IN1 2 Display (0 PR), 1-channel pulse measurement 3 3 Display (PR 0), 1-channel pulse measurement
IN 2
1
T1 T2 T1 Tn - T1 ----------------T1 + T2 Tn - (T1 + T2)
2 3
0 Tn
-----
PROG IN 1
1
T1 T2 T1 Tn - T1 ----------------T1 + T2 Tn - (T1 + T2)
2 3 1 2 3 4
0 Tn
-----------------
PROG
1 Input IN1 (start counting) 2 Input IN2 (stop counting) 3 Display (0 PR), measurement on 3 2 separate channels 4 4 Display (PR 0), measurement on 2 separate channels
0 Tn
T1 -----------------
T1 Tn - T1
T2 -----------------
T1 + T2 Tn - (T1 + T2)
239
CP2 : 2108/2108H
8 or 6-figure display, height 7 mm Totalizer :
- 7 kHz and 40 Hz inputs - Max. counting capacity 99.999.999 impulses Hour counter/chronometer : - Start/stop/ inputs - 4 time ranges : 99.999.9 hours - 99.999.9 min 99.999.9 s - 99 h 59 min 59 s - Lithium battery powered - Reset either from front panel or remotely
Specifications
Type 2108 2108H Designation Impulse counter Hour counter / chronometer Code 87 610 340 87 610 440
Accessories
Adaptor for cut-out 50 (dimensions 73 mm) Adaptor for cut-out 45 x 45 mm (dimensions 52 x 52 mm) Adaptor for cut-out 25x50 mm (dimensions 29x54 mm) Code 26 546 829 26 546 830 26 546 831
Dimensions
Panel cut-out
22 - 0
+ 0,3
44,6
44,8 - 0
+ 0,5
30
24
2108
21,8
48
,3 37 3,2
20
48
4,4
29 24
8,4
52
24
24
60
60
Connections
2108
1 2 3 4 5
2108H
5 4 3,1 4
2
In. H
1
2108
1,4,5
1
2108 H
2
2108
Enable Prog. Reset
3
2
2
2108 H
3
2108
1
Reset Start/Stop 100 ms
240
General characteristics
Functions Solid state input Display Height of digits Counting capacity Time ranges Impulse counter (2108) Hour counter/chronometer (2108H)
8 digits LCD (2108) 6 digits LCD (2108H) 7 mm 0 to 99 999 999 (2108) For the 2108H : 0 to 99 999.9h 0 to 99 999.9min 0 to 99 999.9s 0 to 99h59min59s Quartz (precision 50 ppm) (2108H) For the 2108H : 1 Start/Stop input 40 ms min (terminals 3-5) 1 Reset input (RAZ) 100 ms min (terminals 1-3) 1 Prog input (terminals 3-4) 1 Authorised reset input (terminals 1-2) For the 2108: 40 Hz TOFF : 12 ms min TON : 12 ms min Current output : 52 A max Leakage current in OFF state 0.2 A max Residual voltage : 0.4 V max Volt-free contact or transistor NPN open collector For the 2108: 7 kHz max TOFF : 70 s min TON : 70 s min Level 0 : 0 to 1 VDC Level 1 : 4 to 30 VDC Current consumption : 6 mA max at 24 VDC Volt-free contact or transistor NPN open collector : 12 ms min (2108) 100 ms min (2108H) Front panel IEC 1000-4-3, level 3, 10 V/ M 26 MHz to 1 GHz IEC 1000-4-4, level 3, 1KV IEC 255.4, level 3, 1 KV IEC 1000-4-2, level 3, 8 KV Self-extinguishing 5 terminals 2 x 1.5 mm2 By bracket IP 64 0 +55 -25 +70
Reset to zero
Reset via Radiated field Fast transients Damped oscillatory wave Electrostatic discharge Function and use Material Connection by screw terminals at rear of casing Tightening capacity Mounting Degree of protection front face Temperature limit operation (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Conformity to standards VDE 0110 - ICE 664 - ICE 348 - ICE 255.4 - ICE 255.5 - ICE 801.2- ICE 801.4 Weight (g) Supply 1 lithium battery - Life (years)
60 8 (2108) 5 (2108H)
241
2213/2214
Start input and zero reset : solid state (2213) or voltage Integral module for voltage inputs (5-50VAC/VDC, 48 4 time ranges 99.999.9 h, 99.999.9 min, 99.999.9 s, 99 h Possibility of loading the current value Lithium battery supply - 5-year life Reset to zero : front panel or external with inhibit Bezels for 25 x 50, 45 x 45, 50
facility 59 min 59 s 240 VAC) (2214)
Specifications
Type 2213 2214 Designation Hour counter - LCD 24 x 48 solid state input Hour counter - LCD 24 x 48 voltage input Code 87 610 140 87 610 150
Accessories
Adaptor for cut-out 50 (dimensions 73 mm) Adaptor for cut-out 45 x 45 mm (dimensions 52 x 52 mm) Adaptor for cut-out 25 x 50 mm (dimensions 29 x 54 mm) Code 26 546 829 26 546 830 26 546 831
Dimensions
Ratchet action fixing yoke
44,6
21,8
24
64
48
Unit spacing
8
20
29
24
52
73
22 - 0
24
4,4
8,4
24
60
60
242
+0,3
General characteristics
Functions Display Height of digits Time ranges Hour counter 6 digits LCD 7 mm 0 to 99 999.9h 0 to 99 999.9min 0 to 99 999.9s 0 to 99h59min59s
Time base : Crystal controlled (Accuracy 50) Possibility of reloading current value Input 2213 One start/stop input by volt-free contact or NPN/PNP open-collector transistor (terminals 3-4) Minimum time closed Input 2214 One start/stop input Two voltage levels Terminals 4 - 5 Terminals 5 - 6 Minimum pulse time AC Minimum pulse time DC Reset to zero - Panel Switch no2 to OFF Switch no2 to ON Reset to zero - External 2213 Volt-free contact or open collector (terminals 1-2) Min time closed Reset to zero - External 2214 Voltage - Terminals 2-3 Voltage - Terminals 1-2 Minimum pulse time The reset is galvanically isolated from the counting input (2214-only) Supply 2213 and 2214 1 lithium battery Service life (years) Supply can be switched off by Dipswitch-no no 1 situated underneath the unit Function and use Material Connection by 6 screw terminals at rear of casing Tightening capacity Fixed using bracket Degree of protection front face Temperature limit operation (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Conformity to standards VDE 0110 - ICE 664 - ICE 348 - ICE 255.4 - ICE 255.5 - ICE 801.2- ICE 801.4 Weight (g)
40 ms
Self-extinguishing
2*1.5 mm2
2213 : 60 2214 : 65
243
Connections
2213 Start-stop input or reset input - 2213 Volt-free contact
1 2 3 4 5 6
1
NC NC
A Reset inputs B Start/stop inputs B Reset input C Reset common D Start/stop common E Start/stop input F Not connected G Not connected
Start-stop input or reset input - 2213 NPN transistor
1 2231
A Reset inputs B Start/stop inputs B Reset 48 to 240 V AC C Reset common D Reset 5 to 50 V AC / DC E 5 to 50 V AC / DC F Start/stop common G 48 to 240 V AC
Start-stop input or reset input - 2213 PNP transistor
1 2231
B 2 or 3 C 1 or 4
2213 2293
2213 2293
5-50V~/ 48-240V~
B 2 or 3 C 1 or 4
Reset 2214 : voltage
1
2
B 1 or 4 C 2 or 3
Start/Stop input 2214 : live contact
4 5-50V~/= 48-240V~ 5 6
48-240V~
48-240V~ 5-50V~/
5-50V~/
Start/Stop input 2214 : PNP transistor or 3wire PNP proximity switch (for switch with leakage current 0.1 mA)
5-50V
Reset 2214 : PNP transistor or 3-wire PNP proximity switch (for switch with leakage current 0.1 mA)
5-50V
Start/Stop input 2214 : NPN transistor or 3wire NPN proximity switch (for switch with leakage current 0.1 mA)
5-50V
+ PNP
4
5
PNP
4 5
OV
NPN
2
OV
OV
Reset 2214 : NPN transistor or 3-wire NPN proximity switch (for switch with leakage current 0.1 mA)
5-50V
30V
max
3 2
OV
1
5 OV
OV
1
2
NPN
1
OV 5
OV
1
2
244
245
Totalizers - LCD 24 x 48
Specifications
Type 2231 2232 Designation Solid state input, lithium battery Voltage input, lithium battery Code 87 610 040 87 610 050
Accessories
Adaptor for cut-out 50 (dimensions 73 mm) Adaptor for cut-out 45 x 45 mm (dimensions 52 x 52 mm) Adaptor for cut-out 25 x 50 mm (dimensions 29 x 54 mm) Code 26 546 829 26 546 830 26 546 831
Dimensions
Ratchet action fixing yoke
44,6mm
21,8mm
24mm
48mm
mm 64 3
Unit spacing
30
22 - 0
+0,3
48
4,4
29
20
24
8,4
8
Accessory 26 546 830
52 48 8
24
60
60
52
246
24
General characteristics
Functions Display Height of digits Counting capacity Input 2231 1 slow counting input for contact closure on NPN open-collector transistor input (terminals 3-4) 1 input for high speed counting signal from voltage level (terminals 3-5) Low level High level Input 2232 1 input for slow counting 2 voltage levels Terminals 4 - 5 Terminals 5 - 6 Reset to zero - Panel Switch no.2 to OFF Switch no2 to ON Reset to zero - External 2231 Volt-free contact or open collector (terminals 1-2) Reset to zero - External 2232 Voltage - Terminals 2-3 Voltage - Terminals 1-2 The reset is galvanically isolated from the counting input Slow counting Minimum pulse time. Low level . High level High-speed counting (2231) High-speed counting (2231) Low level - High level Input levels Input impedance (k) Supply 2 alkaline batteries - Life (years) 1 lithium battery - Life (years) Supply can be switched off by Dipswitch-no no 1 situated underneath the unit Function and use Material Connection by 6 screw terminals at rear of casing Tightening capacity Fixed using bracket Degree of protection front face Temperature limit operation (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Insulation resistance (IEC 255.5) Breakdown voltage according to IEC 255-5 Conformity to standards VDE 0110 - ICE 664 - ICE 348 - ICE 255.4 - ICE 255.5 - ICE 801.2- ICE 801.4 Weight (g) Impulse counter 8 digits LCD 7 mm 0 to 99 999 999
5-50 V AC / DC 48-240 V AC
Self-extinguishing
2*1.5 mm2
2231 : 60 2232 : 65
Connections
2231 2232 High-speed counting input 2231 NPN transistor or 3-wire NPN proximity switch
1 2 3 4 5 6
4-30V
8
3 4 5 6
+
5 3
NPN
OV
12ms
247
Slow counting input or reset input - 2231 Start-stop input or reset input - 2213 Counting and general reset input - 2293
1 2231
High-speed counting input 2231 PNP transistor or 3-wire PNP proximity switch (for switch with leakage current 1 mA)
4-30V + PNP 5 2231 3
4-30V
3 5
2213 2293
B 1 or 4 C 2 or 3
Slow counting input or reset input - 2231 Start-stop input or reset input - 2213 Counting and general reset input - 2293
1 2231
2213 2293
1
3 OV
OV
B 1 or 5 C 2 or 3
Slow counting input or reset input : 2231 Volt-free contact
1
1
2
5-50V~/
B 1 or 4 C 2 or 3
Counting input 2232 : Live contact Reset 2232 : Live contact Counting input 2232 : PNP transistor or 3-wire PNP proximity switch (for switch with leakage current 1 mA)
1 2 3
4 5-50V~/= 48-240V~ 5 6
5-50V
48-240V~ 5-50V~/
+ PNP
4
5
OV
Reset 2232 : PNP transistor or 3-wire PNP proximity switch (for switch with leakage current 1 mA)
5-50V
Counting input 2232 : NPN transistor or 3-wire NPN proximity switch (for switch with leakage current 1 mA)
5-50V
Reset 2232 : NPN transistor or 3-wire NPN proximity switch (for switch with leakage current 1 mA)
5-50V
+ PNP
4 5
OV
3 2
OV
NPN
NPN
8
30V max
2
OV
1
5 OV
OV
1
2
1
OV 5
**R = 470 / 2 W for a 2-wire switch with leakage current 1.5 mA Reset 2232 : 2-wire proximity switch**
30V max
1
OV 2
248
249
2293/2294
Partial or total count display Counting capacity : partial : 0 to 999.999 total : 0 to Counting inputs and reset inputs : solid state (2293) Decimal point Integral module for voltage inputs (5 to 50 V AC / DC,
48 to 240 V AC) Lithium battery. 5 years life Panel reset to zero facility for the partial count Panel or electrical reset to zero for the total count Bezels for 25 x 50, 45 x 45, 50 voltage (2294) 99.999.999
Specifications
Type 2293 2294 Designation Solid state input Voltage input Code 87 610 240 87 610 250
Accessories
Adaptor for cut-out 50 (dimensions 73 mm) Adaptor for cut-out 45 x 45 mm (dimensions 52 x 52 mm) Adaptor for cut-out 25 x 50 mm (dimensions 29 x 54 mm) Code 26 546 829 26 546 830 26 546 831
Dimensions
Panel cut-out (Max. thickness 10 mm) 1 unit
44,6
Unit spacing
30
44,8 - 0
21,8
+0,6
22 - 0
+0,3
24
64
48
29
24
52
20
24
48
4,4
8,4
24
60
60
250
General characteristics
Functions Display Height of digits Counting capacity Input 2293 One counting input by volt-free contact or NPN/PNP open-collector transistor (terminals 3 - 4) Minimum time closed Input 2294 1 counting input 2 voltages levels Terminals 4 - 5 Terminals 5 - 6 The inputs are galvanically isolated from one another Reset to zero - Panel Always enabled for partial counter Reset to zero - External 2293 (total counter) Volt-free contact or NPN open-collector transistor (terminals 1-2) Minimum time closed Reset to zero - External 2294 (total counter) Voltage - Terminals 2-3 Voltage - Terminals 1-2 Minimum time closed The reset is galvanically isolated from the counting input (2294-only) Counting speed 2293 Selectable from dipswitch n4 2294 Slow counting Minimum pulse time.Low level . High level High-speed counting Minimum pulse time.Low level . High level Supply 2293 - 2294 - 1 lithium battery Service life (years) Supply can be switched off by Dipswitch-no no 3 situated underneath he unit Function and use Material Connection by 6 screw terminals at rear of casing Tightening capacity Fixed using bracket Degree of protection front face Temperature limit operation (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Conformity to standards VDE 0110 - ICE 664 - ICE 348 - ICE 255.4 - ICE 255.5 - ICE 801.2ICE 801.4 Weight (g) Impulse counter 8 digits LCD 7 mm 0 to 99 999 999
40 ms
5-50 V AC / DC 48-240 V AC
40 ms 5-50 V AC / DC 48-240 V AC 40 ms
14 or 100 Hz 14 Hz 14 Hz max 35 ms Maximum 100 Hz Minimum pulse time low level 5 ms, high level 5 ms 5 ms 5
Self-extinguishing
2 x 1.5 mm2
2293 : 60 2294 : 65
251
Connections
2293 2294 Counting and general reset input - 2293 Volt-free contact
1 2 3 4 5 6
1
NC NC
A General reset input B Counting inputs B General reset input C General reset common D Count common E Counting F Not connected G Not connected
Start/stop input or reset input - 2293 NPN transistor
1 2231
A General reset inputs B Counting inputs B Reset 48 to 240 V AC C General reset common D Reset 5 to 50 V AC / DC E 5 to 50 AC DC F Count common G 48 to 240 V AC
Counting and general reset input - 2293 PNP transistor
1 2231
B 2 or 3 C 1 or 4
2213 2293
2213 2293
B 2 or 3 C 1 or 4
Reset 2294 Voltage
48-240V~
B 1 or 4 C 2 or 3
Counting input 2294 Live contact
1
2
4 5-50V~/= 48-240V~ 5 6
48-240V~ 5-50V~/
5-50V~/
Reset 2294 PNP transistor or 3-wire PNP proximity switch (for switch with leakage current 0.1 mA)
5-50V
Counting input 2294 PNP transistor or 3-wire PNP proximity switch (for switch with leakage current 0.1 mA)
5-50V
Counting input 2294 NPN transistor or 3-wire NPN proximity switch (for switch with leakage current 0.1 mA)
5-50V
+ PNP
PNP
4
5
4 5
OV
NPN
2
OV
OV
Reset 2294 NPN transistor or 3-wire NPN proximity switch (for switch with leakage current 0.1 mA)
5-50V
30V
max
30V
max
3 2
OV
1
5 OV
OV
1
2
NPN
1
OV 5
OV
1
2
252
253
Specifications
Type 3233 3253 3293 Designation Totalizer Ratemeter Totalizer counter and Ratemeter Code 87 614 040 87 614 340 87 614 440
General characteristics
Lithium battery Life (years) A power supply must be provided for a sensor (12 V DC) Material : self-extinguishing (UL94VO) Degree of protection front face Mounting (panel-mounting/slide-action clips) Connections at rear of case Waterproof gasket for panel sealing Temperature limit operation (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Weight (g) 3 V DC 8
IP 56
Screw terminals
0 +55 0 +70 60
Dimensions
panel cut-out
68
10
31,75
72
33
36
RESET
Mounting
254
Connections
Terminal markings Type 3233
2
4 7 5 3 2 1
B Common 0 V C Slow counting input D High-speed counting E Remote reset (3233 - 3293) F Enable/disable front reset button (3233)
Programming (3253 - 3293)
Type 3233
3.30V 3 1
Type 3233
4 1
Type 3233
3.30V
3 1 OV
3 1,5K 1
Front reset enable (3233) Programming enable (3293, 3253) Type 3293 - 3253
3.30V
7 1,5K
3 1 OV
255
C108
Liquid crystal display : 8 digits, 7 mm high Low consumption Small dimensions Time base : Crystal controlled Sealed version (C108W)
Specifications
Type C108 Designation Sealed version Code 87 606 330
General characteristics
Characteristics Functions Display Height of digits Counting capacity Inputs 1 input for high-speed counting signal from voltage level Counting speed Minimum pulse time Low level High level 1 input for slow counting signal from volt-free contact or NPN opencollector transistor Counting speed Minimum time closed Reset Volt-free contact or NPN open-collector transistor Min time closed Supply Minimum Maximum Consumption Function and use Material : Clear polycarbonate Connection solder on to 6 pins or wire wrap Mounted on p.c. by 2 screws and nuts Protection C108 Protection C108W Temperature limit operation (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Weight (g) Impulse / hour counter 8 digits LCD 7 mm 0 to 99 999 999
40 Hz 12 ms
Dimensions
Implantation
3,25 17,75 17,75 M1,6
42 36,7
1,5
C108
0,65
12,7
12,7
1
3,4
2,54
2,54
19 10,5
1 P +
12,4 3,2
7,5
9 10
256
Connections
Terminal markings
1 2 3 4 5
6
+ -
+ C 108 - P
1 R
3
2
1
+ -
+ P 2 C 108 R - 1
U = 5 V R = 180 U = 12 V R = 1 k U = 24 V R = 2 k 2
Precautions : these devices use CMOS technology and should be handled accordingly.
High-speed counting 7.5 kHz
+
R U z 3 v 3
+ C 108 P 2
1 R
3
1
-
+ -
+ 2 C 108 R - P 1
U R
5V 180k
12V 1k
24V 2,2k
U = 5 V R = 180 U = 12 V R = 1 k U = 24 V R = 2 k 2
Precautions : these devices use CMOS technology and should be handled accordingly.
257
108
Highly reliable Large 8 mm digits Very low consumption < 15 A (typically 6 A) Small dimensions With or without front panel reset
Specifications
Type 108 Reset to zero front panel and electrical electrical Version 108 R panel mounting 108 ER 108 panel mounting 108 E Code 87 606 110 87 606 120 87 606 010 87 606 020
General characteristics
Characteristics Functions Display Height of digits Counting capacity Resolution Inputs 1 input for high-speed counting signal from voltage level Counting speed Minimum pulse time Low level High level 1 input for slow counting signal from volt-free contact or NPN opencollector transistor Counting speed Min time closed Reset Volt-free contact or NPN transistor Minimum time closed Low level max Supply Minimum Maximum Function and use Temperature limit operation (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Impulse/hour counter 8 digits LCD 8 mm For totalizer : 0 to 99 999 999 For hour counter : 0 to 99 999 h 99 1/100h
40 Hz 12 ms
Dimensions
Mounting
6,22 17,78 17,78 3
2,88
48
R-2 0,64 1P+
13,5
12,7
15,25
12,7
2,54
15,25
1
2,54
7,8 7,62
21
2,5
258
Connections
Terminal markings
1 2 3 4 5
6
+ -
+ P 2 108 H R - 1
R U z 3 v 3
+
108 P
10k
3v3
10k
-
1 R
UE UE UZ -
1 R
R1
+ UE UE Uz
UE R1
5V - 24V 3,3k 1 /4
48V 3,3k 1
2,2k
B Supply C R to Z
High-speed counting 7.5 kHz
B Supply C R to Z
Slow counting (max 40 kHz)
10k
+ -
+ 108 - P
1 R
2
UE UE U 3 -
+ -
2 108 P 1R
259
36 x 37
Front panel 36 x 37 mm 6 or 5 digits, 4 mm in height With or without manual zero reset White digits on black background
Specifications
Type Without zero reset Voltages 230 VAC 115 VAC 24 VAC 24 VDC 230 VAC 115 VAC 24 VAC 24 VDC Frequency (Hz) 50 60 50 60 50 60 50 60 50 60 50 60 Code 99 766 601 99 766 602 99 766 604 99 766 607 99 766 610 99 766 611 99 766 613 99 766 616
General characteristics
Counting capacity 999 999 imp without zero reset 99 999 imp with zero reset 4 mm AC 18 imp / s DC 25 imp / s AC 28 ms DC 20 ms AC 28 ms DC 20 ms no limit + 10 % / -15 % from Un 24 V AC / 115 V AC : 1.1 VA 230 V AC : 2.1 VA 24 V DC : 0.8 W > 50 x 10 6 U 60 V : 500 V U > 60 V : 2000 V IP 40 IP 00 Metal parts protected (by surface treatment) or non-corroding None Yes -10 60 -40 +80 6.35 Faston connectors or link screws 2 x 2.5 screws - F 90o on front panel 50
Height of digits Max. count rate Min. count rate Min pause time between 2 pulses Max. pulse length (count coil) Voltage variation Absorbed power
Mechanical life count function (operations) Voltage tests to IEC 255 5 Protection Housing Protection Terminal Environmental protection Maintenance Operating position Temperature limit operation (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Connection Mounting Weight (g)
260
Dimensions
99 766 60 : 36 x 37 - 6 decades
8,5 37 49,3 6
23,5
36
30
20
2,5
2,5
99 766 61 : 36 x 37 - 5 decades
8,5 37 54,1 6
23,5
36
30
20
2,5
2,5 6
24
2,7
Using information
No count pulse must be received during the zero reset time. If a pulse is received, damage may be caused.
30
261
24 x 48
Front panel 24 x 48 mm 6 or 5 digits, 4 mm in height With or without manual zero reset White digits on black background
Specifications
Type Without zero reset Voltages 230 VAC 115 VAC 24 VAC 24 VDC 230 VAC 115 VAC 24 VAC 24 VDC Frequency (Hz) 50 60 50 60 50 60 50 60 50 60 50 60 Code 99 766 901 99 766 902 99 766 904 99 766 907 99 766 921 99 766 922 99 766 924 99 766 927
General characteristics
Counting capacity Height of digits Max. count rate Min. count rate Min pause time between 2 pulses Max. pulse length (count coil) Voltage variation Operator factor Absorbed power 999 999 imp, without zero reset 99 999 imp with zero reset 4 mm AC 18 imp/s DC 25 imp/s AC 28 ms DC 20 ms AC 28 ms DC 20 ms no limit + 10 % / - 15 % from Un 100 % 24 V AC / 115 V AC : 1.1 VA 230 V AC : 2.1 VA 24 V DC : 0.8 W > 50 x 106 U 60 V : 500 V U > 60 V : 2000 V IP 40 IP 00 Metal parts protected (by surface treatment) or non-corroding None Yes -10 +60 -40 +80 6.35 Faston connectors or link screws 2 x M3 screws - F90o on front panel 50
Mechanical life count function (operations) Voltage tests to IEC 255 100 Protection Housing Protection Terminal Environmental protection Maintenance Operating position Temperature limit operation (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Connection Mounting Weight (g)
262
Dimensions
99 766 90 : 24 x 48 - 6 decades
48 41,5 8,5 49,3 6
22,5
24
20
3,2
99 766 92 : 24 x 48 - 5 decades
48 41,5 8,5 54,1 6
22,5
24
20
3,2
3 6
23
M3
Using information
No count pulse must be received during the zero reset time. If a pulse is received, damage may be caused.
263
36 x 48
Front panel 36 x 48 6 or 5 digits, 4 mm in height With or without manual zero reset White digits on black background
Specifications
Type Without zero reset Voltages 230 VAC 115 VAC 24 VAC 24 VDC 230 VAC 115 VAC 24 VAC 24 VDC Frequency (Hz) 50 60 50 60 50 60 50 60 50 60 50 60 Code 99 766 701 99 766 702 99 766 704 99 766 707 99 766 710 99 766 711 99 766 713 99 766 716
General characteristics
Counting capacity Height of digits Max. count rate Min. count rate Min pause time between 2 pulses Max. pulse length (count coil) Voltage variation Absorbed power 999 999 imp, without zero reset 99 999 imp, with zero reset 4 mm AC 18 imp/s DC 25 imp/s AC 28 ms DC 20 ms AC 28 ms DC 20 ms no limit + 10 % / - 15 % from Un 24 V AC / 115 V AC : 1.1 VA 230 V AC : 2.1 VA 24 V DC : 0.8 W > 50 x 106 U 60 V : 500 V U > 60 V : 2000V IP 40 IP 00 Metal parts protected (by surface treatment) or non-corroding None Yes -10 +60 -40 +80 6.35 Faston connectors or link screws 2 x 2.5 F90o on front panel 50
Mechanical life count function (operations) Voltage tests to IEC 255 100 Protection Housing Protection Terminal Environmental protection Maintenance Operating position Temperature limit operation (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Connection Mounting Weight (g)
264
Dimensions
99 766 70 : 36 x 48 : 6 decades
8,5 49,3 6
48
23,5
36
30
20
2,5
2,5
99 766 71 : 36 x 48 - 5 decades
8,5 48 54,1 6
23,5
36
30
20
2,5
2,5 6
24
2,7
Using information
No count pulse must be received during the zero reset time. If a pulse is received, damage may be caused.
30
265
CH 48 G
48 x 48 front panel Capacity 100.000 h (99.999 h) Run indicator Panel-mounted Can be mounted inside cabinet with DIN rail socket connector
Specifications
Type CH 48 G Frequency (Hz) 50 Voltages 220 to 240 VAC 110 to 127 VAC 36 to 48 VAC 18 to 26 VAC 110 to 127 VAC 220 to 240 VAC 24 to 30 VAC Code 99 761 714 99 761 712 99 761 711 99 761 710 99 761 715 99 761 716 99 761 718
60
Accessories
DIN socket rail connector Bezel (grey) 55 x 55 mm Code 26 546 803 26 546 805
General characteristics
Counting capacity Reset to zero Read accuracy Digit size Colour of hour numbers Colour of decimal digits Voltage variation Time base Max. absorbed power Motor start up Voltage tests to IEC 255 100 Accuracy Environmental protection 99 999.99 without 1 / 100 h H x L : 3.8 x 1.6 mm White on black Red on black + 10 - 15 % from Un Synchronous motor 1 VA <1s U 60 V : 500 V U > 60 V : 2000 V AC mains supply Metal parts protected (by surface treatment) or non-corroding Casing in Noryl - UL Listed IP 40 Yes -20 +55 -40 +80 10-2000 Hz / 0.5 G (IEC 68.2.6) UL - CSA - VDE Tags 6.35 mm Screw terminals 2.5 mm 2 60
Degree of protection front face Operating position Temperature limit operation (C) Temperature limits stored (C) Vibration resistance Approvals Connections (panel mounted version) Connections (DIN rail mounted version) Tightening capacity Weight (g)
266
Dimensions
Panel-mounted DIN rail mounted via clip-on connector socket Circular cut-out
50
48
CH48G
33 40
55
45
Square cut-out
Using information
with a 380 V AC supply, connect a 50 K, W resistor in series with the 220 V
48
0000000
267
268
www.crouzet.com
269
Selection guide
Features Number of standard circuits 7 12 With external knob 17 22 31 40 5 10 With internal knob 15 20 29 38 5 10 Fast cycle-end or 2 speeds 15 20 29 38 6 8 10 12 6 to 22 circuits 14 16 18 20 22 2 4 2 4 1 1 to 2 circuits 2 - Adjustable cams - Precut cams - Striker cams - Mixed - Adjustable cams - Precut cams - Striker cams - Mixed - Adjustable cams - Precut cams - Striker cams - Mixed - Adjustable cams - Precut cams - Striker cams - Mixed 10 A 250 AC 2 s to 24h - Adjustable cams - Precut cams - Striker cams - Mixed 10 A 250 AC 2 s to 24h - Adjustable cams - Precut cams - Striker cams - Mixed 10 A 250 AC 2 s to 24h - Adjustable cams - Precut cams - Striker cams - Mixed 10 A 250 AC 2 s to 24h - Adjustable cams - Precut cams - Striker cams - Mixed Rating Standard cycle duration Programm storage medium
Cam timers
Page 274
Page 274
Page 274
Page 276
2 to 4 circuits Panel-mounted
10 A 250 AC
2 s to 24h
Page 278
2 to 4 circuits Base-mounted
10 A 250 AC
2 s to 24h
Page 278
10 A 250 AC
2 s to 24h
Page 280
Page 282
270
to a timer
Introduction
Our timers are pieces of automatic control equipment which, during a cycle, are intended to operate a series of contacts in a preset order following a program. The cycle may be single (non-repetitive), repetitive, or step by step. Though often decried, timers will greatly simplify automatic control systems and allow much other hardware to be dispensed with.
Basic concept
They consist of: a driving device: gearmotor a program storage medium: adjustable, precut or striker cams and output devices: microswitches, miniature valves
Striker cam
Precut cam
Program representation
The positions and sequence of the commands in the program will be fully defined by a diagram.
Diagram plotting
By convention, the lower line represents the rest position and the upper the working position. The heavy lines mean that the contact is closed. The total cycle duration is represented in degrees for the cams.
Importante note
Only the theoretical electrical (or pneumatic) values will be used for plotting the diagrams. The equivalent mechanical values are peculiar to the individual unit and are calculated when setting up the program or cutting the cam contour. Example: Diagramm for a cam timer
9
In the individual specifications, the minimum time is given as a proportion of a value which represents the duration of the program.
360
0 P1
Circuits
T R
30 30
180
230 300
Example :
or the type 88 645 cam timer, the minimum time is equal to 1/60th of the total duration of a cycle. The minimum interval is restricted solely by the mechanical strength of the web of material between two successive spaces or by the thickness of the strikers. It is given as a proportion of the same reference value as the minimum time. For the program storage medium, i.e. the cam, N repetitions of a pairing of minimum time with minimum interval gives the maximum number of switching operations by the output device which are possible. This number is quoted in each specification.
P2 4254 P3
Start of cycle End of cycle
170 180
240250270280
At the same time, a diagram plotted in this way also indicates the contour of the equivalent program storage medium : working = peak (or material present), rest = trough (or material cut away). A heavy line indicates that the contact is closed. For ease of cutting, the troughs should preferably be shorter than the peaks
www.crouzet.com
271
it is absolutely essential that the chronological order of the changes of state is maintained (Fig.A). When this is the case, the diagram interval between two switching operations must be at least equal to the accuracy. the chronological order of the changes of states need not be maintained (Fig. B)
Undefined
Quality
= individual accuracy of any given unit
X Y f|x-y| A
X Y B
Quality control
Our products are quality controlled systematically during assembly and on completion. The overseeing of control checks in the workshop, the use of data collected and possible product assessments which can occur form the essential role of Quality Control. All our products undergo a final check, either at 100% or on a selective basis following French standard X 06-022, which provides for a classification of possible defects in 3 groups : critical, major, minor. Different tolerance thresholds (matching necessarily varied statistical analyses) are thus determined as a function of the possible repercussions of any anomalies during the life of the product in normal use, such as defined in the preceding sections. The size of the batches, the sampling quantities and the standards selected combine to define the thresholds.
A copy (a photocopy or dyeline print)) of the diagram shown below on page 273 will enable you to give us details of the particular profile to be cut in our works.The changeover points will need to be entered in degrees with due allowance for the characteristics of the timer selected. The cams are fitted in ascending numerical order reading away from the drive motor.
Utilisation Applications
There are vast numbers of possible applications for these timers. In the commonest application, the timer performs repeated cycles which cause contacts to be closed for fixed lengths of time. It may also perform a single cycle but the program is still a function of time in this case.
Note:
According to customer requirements and for certain product ranges which must meet specific needs expressed in a specification, it is always possible to create or to modify a quality standard on a normal or special existing product and to vary the level of inspection. It can happen that the tolerance level is set at zero for certain parameters directly linked to the completion of a function for which total success must be assured : a defect is therefore fatal. Such specific requirements do, however, lead to a significant increase in product costs.
Examples: movement of automatic milling machine tables, periodic lubrication, animated shop-window displays, staged start-up of sets of pumps, automatic presses, industrial washing machines,etc.
The above applications are termed "open-ended" because the sequential progress of the operations is dependent solely on time and there is no check that the operation called for has actually taken place. The main application for timers is in sequential automatic control systems where a check on the completion of an operation causes the next operation to begin (limit switch, thermostat, timeclock). When this is the case the timer is used in the step by step mode. The program is not run as a function of time but in response to external commands, and the motor merely serves to move the program forward in steps. Step by step applications of this kind are in fact the ones for which timers can most usefully be employed. Though often decried, they allow automatic control systems to be greatly simplified and much of the hardware, such as relays and memories, needed for other techniques to be dispensed with. In the same unit, the timer may control not only switching operations which follow one another in a precise order but also series of step by step sequences and sequences proportional to time, sequences run in two directions, and so on. The circuits used are simple and there is a special technique for them which is easily modelled. If the power fails, the timers may either: remain in position, in which case the orders given are held in store, which is an intrinsic feature of the device, or return to their starting point as soon as the power comes back on. The cycle then begins again from the beginning.
272
0 12 T R T R
360 90 180
Adjustable cam
Cam 1:
(closest to motor) : move one of the segments to the point where the lever drops into the trough and lock it there; this point will form the beginning of the cycle. Switch the motor on for 2 seconds (equivalent to 12) (starting and stopping are instantaneous). Move the second segment of the cam to the point where the microswitch is to change state and lock it there. Grey cam-half: beginning of setting (beginning of rest position) Red cam-half: end of setting (end of rest position) The markings are read from the tool, as shown in the illustration above (except in the case of 88 655) Note: The accuracies quoted will be achieved provided the cams are always adjusted in the same direction of rotation. A number in line with each cam allows the circuit concerned to be identified easily.
Cam 2:
Switch the motor on again for 13 seconds (interval between the end of the cam 1 space and the beginning of the cam 2 space). Set the beginning and end of the space in the same way as for cam 1.
Note:
In the case of simple diagrams which need no great accuracy, such as 2 cams each containing a minimum space, positioned 180 apart, turn the motor shaft by hand to find the points for tripping the microswitches by eye.
Striker cam
Striker cam part no.79 222 640 (cam with 60 slots, increment 6) Pack of strikers, part no. 79 222 641 Kit comprising : 10 strikers for raising and lowering levers 20 spacer strikers with an angular width of 6 pliers for easier fitting and removal of the strikers. Other characteristics are the same as for the precut cam.
273
2 s - 24 h With external knob 7 88 645 0 12 88 645 2 17 88 645 4 22 88 645 6 31 88 645 8 40 88 645 8 82 334 5 + 10 - 15 % of Un 3.5 W 0.6 0.7 s 1 1/5 2 x 106 5 cm. daN External friction
2 s - 24 h With fast cycle-end or 2 speeds 5 88 645 1 10 88 645 3 15 88 645 5 20 88 645 7 29 88 645 9 38 88 645 9
Types
Features Number of standard circuits
Characteristics
Drive device
Type of standard gearmotor Max voltage variation Absorbed power cos Transition time Single direction Stopping performance - No. of rotor revs. Number of off-load starts Mechanical strength of gearbox Method of gearmotor coupling (to cams)
Adjustable cam
Accuracy
Precision limit error Repeat accuracy Selection precision
Output specification
Protected microswitch type Rating Mechanical life Resistive torque per circuit
* For stepping operation please enquire * * At these speeds, allowance must be made for bounce and transition time.
Direction of rotation
One-way or two-way (standard clockwise direction) Two-way motor type 82 524 0 : obtainable speed , for other speeds see motors catalogue 220 volt capacitor 0.1 F 10 %. Ref: 26 231 903
General specifications
Permitted voltage variation at 55 C maximum temperature is in accordance with IEC 255-1-00 (NFC 45250) Duty factor Temperature Use limits Stored
Supply voltage
Standard 1 direction - dual-voltage 127 / 220 V 50 Hz 2 directions - single voltage 220 V - 50 Hz 79 222 640 79 222 641 84 861 502 84 861 501 84 861 503
5 6
100 % -5 + 60 C -40 + 80 C Test voltages under IEC 255-5, VDE 0435/2021, Voltages 60 V = 1000 V IEC 536 class 1 (protection against electric Voltages > 60 V = 2000 V
shocks)
Accessories
Striker cams Packet of extra strikers Inverter for DC supply (for a 50 Hz AC motor of the same voltage) Output power max. of 10 VA 12 V c 24 48 V c 110 127 V c
Conformity to standards NFC 45 250, IEC 255-1-00, VDE 0435/2021 Connection Motors : to terminal strip Microswitches : Approvals * produced on request Mounting Weight
W3 blade (6.35) W3 blade (6.35) See below By 2 screws M4 on Rn 50022 35 mm symmetrical d DIN rail See table page 275
Other information
Timers classed as Standard Products are only available from our distributors. For other voltages and frequencies and DC, please consult us. Basic concepts see page 271. For some typical circuits, see page 284.
274
Features
88 645 - Motor connections to terminal strip - Easy adjustment with knob or tool
Dimensions
88 645 0 with external knob
Circuits 7 12 17 22 31 40
3 2 1
Types
Rating in Amps
Circuits 5 10 15 20 29 38
1 2 3 4 5 10 40 60
82 344
82 334 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22
Number of circuits 2
Operation
The program can only be run in one direction. The gearmotors used are of the Y 82 334 5 type (with roller free-wheel) High-speed gearmotor: max. speed is a function of the resistive torque. Only versions with adjustable and striker cams are supplied with internal knob. Versions with fully precut cams have no knob. A - Low-speed motor clockwise B - High-speed motor anti-clockwise
9
Types 88 645 1 88 645 3 88 645 5 88 645 7 88 645 9 88 645 9 Circuits 5 10 15 20 29 38 Dimension A 82 116 148 180 239 310 Dimension B 149 183 215 247 308 379 Weight (g) 760 960 1110 1210 1510 1860
To order, specify:
Standard products, stocked
1
Standard products, non stocked
Type
Cycle duration
Direction of rotation
Supply voltage
Accessory
Example : Cam timer with external knob 88 645 0 - 7 circuits - Adjustable cams - 60 s - 1 rpm - 127/240 V - 50 Hz - Packet of extra strikers 79 222 641
275
Characteristics
Drive device
Type of standard gearmotor depending on number of circuits and speed (see graph) Max voltage variation Absorbed power cos Transition time Single direction Stopping performance - No. of rotor revs. Number of off-load starts Mechanical strength of gearbox Method of gearmotor coupling (to cams) 82 344 0 82 334 5
2 s - 24 h
Types
Number of standard circuits 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22 88 650 3 88 650 4 88 650 5 88 650 6 88 650 7 88 650 8 88 650 9 88 650 9 88 650 9
Accuracy
Precision limit error Repeat accuracy Selection precision
Output specification
Protected microswitch type Rating Mechanical life Resistive torque per circuit
General specifications
Permitted voltage variation at 55 C maximum temperature is in accordance with IEC 255-1-00 (NFC 45250) Duty factor Temperature Use limits Stored
Test voltages under IEC 255-5, VDE 0435/2021, IEC 536 class 1 (protection against electric shocks)
100 % -5 + 60 C -40 + 80 C Voltages 60 V = 1000 V Voltages > 60 V = 2000 V Tropicalised to IEC 68-2.10 standard Any IP 10
* For stepping operation please enquire * * At these speeds, allowance must be made for bounce and transition time.
Direction of rotation
1 or 2 directions
4
220 V 50 Hz 79 222 640 79 222 641 84 861 502 84 861 501 84 861 503
Supply voltage
Standard
5 6
Accessories
Striker cams Packet of extra strikers Inverter for DC supply (for a 50 Hz AC motor of the same voltage) Output power max. of 10 VA 12 V c 24 48 V c 110 127 V c
Conformity to standards NFC 45 250, IEC 255-1-00, VDE 0435/2021 Connection Motors Microswitches Mounting Weight
Leads : 250 mm W3 blade (6.35) By 4 screw M4 on Rn 50022 35 mm symmetrical d DIN rail See table page 277
Other information
Timers classed as Standard Products are only available from our distributors. For other voltages and frequencies and DC, please consult us. Basic concepts see page 271. For some typical circuits, see page 284.
276
Features
- Easy adjustment with knob or tool (see page 271) - Mounting by screws or on Rn 50022 35 mm symmetrical d DIN rail (EN 50022) Internal layout
Dimensions
1 MS 4 1 2
3 2 1
35
A B
50 70 102
Types 88 650 3 88 650 4 88 650 5 88 650 6 88 650 7 88 650 8 88 650 9 88 650 9 88 650 9
Circuits 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22
Dimension B* 142 155 168 181 194 207 220 233 246
Weight 345 390 435 480 252 570 615 660 705
L R
I en A
rpm 1
rpm
1 2 3 4 5 10 40 60
82 344
Cam timers with fully precut cams and selector knob from 6 to 22 circuits
82 334 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22
Number of circuits 2
4,8
4x4,2
35,5
75,5
Type
88 650
9
Supplied with internal or external selector knob; the graduations in this case merely show the progress of the cycle.
To order, specify:
Program storage medium Cycle duration Direction of rotation Supply voltage
1
Standard products, non stocked
Type
Accessory
Example : Cam timer 88 650 3 - Base-mounted - Adjustable cams - 60 s - 1 rpm - 1 direction - 220 V - 50 Hz - Packet of extra strikers 79 222 641
277
Characteristics
Drive device
Type of standard gearmotor Max voltage variation Absorbed power cos Transition time Single direction Stopping performance - No. of rotor revs. Number of off-load starts Mechanical strength of gearbox Method of gearmotor coupling (to cams) 82 344 0 + 10 - 15 % of Un 3W 0.8 0.7 s 1 1/5 10 x 106 5 cm. daN External friction 82 334 5>12 rpm + 10 - 15 % of Un 3.5 W 0.7 0.4 s 1 1/5 2 x 106 5 cm. daN External friction
2 s - 24 h
Types/Features
Number of 2 standard 4 circuits Mounting (see dimension) 88 646 0 88 646 2 Base-mounted (1) 88 646 0 88 646 2 Panel-mounted (2)
Adjustable cam
Accuracy
Precision limit error Repeat accuracy Selection precision
Output specification
Protected microswitch type Rating Mechanical life Resistive torque per circuit
General specifications
Permitted voltage variation at 55 C maximum temperature is in accordance with IEC 255-1-00 (NFC 45250) Duty factor Temperature Use limits Stored
Test voltages under IEC 255-5, VDE 0435/2021, IEC 536 class 1 (protection against electric shocks)
100 % -5 + 60 C -40 + 80 C Voltages 60 V = 1000 V Voltages > 60 V = 2000 V Tropicalised to IEC 68-2.10 standard Any IP 10
* For stepping operation please enquire * * At these speeds, allowance must be made for bounce and transition time.
Direction of rotation
1 or 2 directions (Motor type depends on the number of circuits and the speed, and is selected by the factory)
4 5 6
Supply voltage
Standard 1 direction - dual-voltage 127 / 220 V 50 Hz 2 directions - single voltage 220 V - 50 Hz 79 222 640 79 222 641 84 861 502 84 861 501 84 861 503
Accessories
Striker cam Packet of extra strikers Inverter for DC supply (for a 50 Hz AC motor of the same voltage) Output power max. of 10 VA 12 V c 24 48 V c 110 127 V c
Conformity to standards NFC 45 250, IEC 255-1-00, VDE 0435/2021 Connection Motors : to terminal strip Microswitches : Approvals * produced on request Mounting By 2 screws M4 on Rn 50022 35 mm symmetrical d DIN rail Weight
W3 blade (6.35) W3 blade (6.35) Bureau vritas Bureau vritas - * CSA - * UL * CSA - * UL Fond d'armoire Faade
Other information
Timers classed as Standard Products are only available from our distributors. For other voltages and frequencies and DC, please consult us. Basic concepts see page 271. For some typical circuits, see page 284.
278
Features
Motor connections to terminal strip Easy adjustment with knob or tool (see page 271) Akulon insulation Mounting on DIN rail d 35 mm symmetrical (EN 50022)
Dimensions
Base-mounted
Internal layout
3 MS 4 1 2 2 1
3 2 1
14 2X4,5 20
65
30
50
55
Rating in Amps
Circuits 2 4
(1) 80 93
(2) 80 93
1 2 3 4 5 10 40 60
82 344
82 334 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22
Number of circuits 2
To order, specify:
1
Standard products, non stocked
Type
Cycle duration
Direction of rotation
Supply voltage
Accessory
Example : Cam timer with external knob 88 645 0 - 7 circuits - Adjustable cams - 60 s - 1 rpm - 127/240 V - 50 Hz - Packet of extra strikers 79 222 641
279
Characteristics
Drive device
Type of standard gearmotor depending on number of circuits and speed (see graph) Max voltage variation Absorbed power cos Transition time Single direction Stopping performance - No. of rotor revs. Number of off-load starts Mechanical strength of gearbox Method of gearmotor coupling (to cams) * Friction to special order 82 344 0 82 334 5
2 s - 24 h
Types
Number of standard circuits 1 2 To special order 88 655 1 88 655 2
1 2
To special order
Adjustable cam
Accuracy
Precision limit error Repeat accuracy Selection precision
Output specification
Protected microswitch type Rating Mechanical life Resistive torque per circuit
* For stepping operation please enquire * * At these speeds, allowance must be made for bounce and transition time.
General specifications
Permitted voltage variation at 55 C maximum temperature is in accordance with IEC 255-1-00 (NFC 45250) Duty factor Temperature Use limits Stored
Test voltages under IEC 255-5, VDE 0435/2021, IEC 536 class 1 (protection against electric shocks)
Direction of rotation
1 or 2 directions
4
220 V 50 Hz 79 222 640 79 222 641 84 861 502 84 861 501 84 861 503
Supply voltage
Standard
5 6
100 % -5 + 60 C -40 + 80 C Voltages 60 V = 1000 V Voltages > 60 V = 2000 V Tropicalised to IEC 68-2.10 standard Any IP 10
Accessories
Striker cam Packet of extra strikers Inverter for DC supply (for a 50 Hz AC motor of the same voltage) Output power max. of 10 VA 12 V c 24 48 V c 110 127 V c
Environmental protection
Conformity to standards NFC 45 250, IEC 255-1-00, VDE 0435/2021 Connection Motors Microswitches Approvals Mounting Weight
Leads : 250 mm W3 blade (6.35) UL (special version) - Veritas test agency (France) By 4 screws M4 on Rn 50022 35 mm symmetrical d DIN rail See table page 281
Other information
Timers classed as Standard Products are only available from our distributors. For other voltages and frequencies and DC, please consult us. Basic concepts see page 271. For some typical circuits, see page 284.
280
Features
- Insulating support
Dimensions
Internal layout
2 1 MS 4 1 2
3 2 1
50 70 107
75,5
35 A
Circuits 1 2
Rating in Amps
1 2 3 4 5 10 40 60
82 344
82 334 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22
Number of circuits 2
To order, specify:
1
Standard products, non stocked
Type
Cycle duration
Direction of rotation
Supply voltage
Accessory
Example : Cam timer 88 655 1 - Adjustable cams - 60 s - 1 rpm - 220 V - 50 Hz - Packet of extra strikers 79 222 641
281
Characteristics
Drive device
Type of standard gearmotor Absorbed power Motor output Max. heating-up Number of off-load starts Maximum permitted torque from gearmotor under continuous conditions Method of Rigid gearmotor coupling Friction to (to cams) special order 82 344 0 3W 0.16 W 50 C 10 106 0.5 N.m
2 s - 24 h
Types
Number of standard circuits 1 2 3 88 256 4 88 256 5 88 256 9
1 2
Precut cams
21 - 1/17 *
* * At these speeds, allowance must be made for bounce and transition time.
Accuracy
Precision limit error : precut cam (* Factory) 3.5 83 160 0 16 A - 250 V a 20 A - 250 V c 107 0.06 N.m 0.01 N.m
Direction of rotation
1 or 2 directions (standard clockwise)
4
220 V - 50 Hz 12 V c 24 48 V c 110 127 V c 84 861 502 84 861 501 84 861 503
Output specification
Protected microswitch type Rating Nominal Thermal Mechanical life (operations) Resistive torque To trip per circuit Tripped
Supply voltage
Standard
5 6
Accessories
Inverter for DC supply (for a 50 Hz AC motor of the same voltage) Output power max. of 10 VA
General specifications
Permitted voltage variation at 55 C maximum temperature is in accordance with IEC 255-1-00 (NFC 45250) Duty factor Temperature Use limits Stored
Test voltages under IEC 255-5, VDE 0435/2021, IEC 536 class 1 (protection against electric shocks)
100 % +5 +60 C -40 +80 C 60 V = 1000 V 60 V = 2000 V Protected metal components Insulated motor coil Any IP 10
Leads 250 mm W3 blade (6.35) 2xM3 - 2xM4 See table page 283
Other information
Timers classed as Standard Products are only available from our distributors. For other voltages and frequencies and DC, please consult us. Basic concepts see page 271. For some typical circuits, see page 284.
282
Internal layout
2 1 MS 4 1 2
Dimensions
3 2 1 1 - 2 U< 1 -3 U> or single voltage
L 7,5 14,25
55 7,5 25,5 80
14,25
18 16 15
2 x M4
Types 88 256 4 88 256 5 88 256 9 L (mm) 52 63.5 74 Weight (g) 200 220 240
2 x M3
Rating in Amps
rpm 1
rpm
1 2 3 4 5 10 40 60
82 344
82 334 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16 18 20 22
Number of circuits 2
13 13
To order, specify:
1
Standard products, non stocked
Type
Cycle duration
Direction of rotation
Supply voltage
Accessory
Example : Cam timer 88 256 4 - Precut cam - 60 s - 1 rpm - 1 direction - 220 V - 50 Hz - Inverter 84 861 502
283
360
MA
0 P1
360
MA
P1
P1 MP
P2
P2
P1 MP
P2
P3
P2 P3
1 rpm
3 1st halt 4
Halt at origin
MA = On/off switch MP = Timer motor P1, P2 etc. = Timer contacts 1st changeover of MA = Start of cycle changeover of P1 = End of cycle 2nd changeover of MA = Return to origin N.B. : Time for 2nd changeover of MA min space x rpm > _________________ 360
1 Min. space
360
IMP
P1
P1
P2 MP
P2 P3
By pulse The layout is identical to that shown for 2 with or without relays. The contour of cam 1 will set the desired number of steps.
1 Min. space 2 Halt 1 2 Halt 2 Halt
360
1 step
P1 P2
Long cycle In the above case, the minimum length of pulse required may be prohibitive. The circuit shown below cuts this minimum length to the pull-in time of the relay.
MP
P3
5 top 4
Min. pulse
360
R2
P1
IMP
P1
R1
P2
P3
P2
IMP = Push button for manual start Fc = Limit switch B = Timed contact MP = Timer motor P1, P2, P3 = Timer contacts min. space x rpm __________________ < pulse < 1 step 360
rpm
MP
P3
IMP = Starting push button R = Relay coil R1, R2 = Relay contacts MP = Timer motor P1, P2 = Timer contacts Note: We do not supply the relay Pulse from IMP R1, R2 change over R maintains own supply during space at P1
The load circuits change over either at the halt positions (e.g. P2), or during the movement through a step thus setting the output pulses as a function of the size of the space and the duration of the cycle (e.g.P3). Other contacts can be connected in parallel with IMP and each pulse will then cause a fresh step. Typical applications : sequenced control of machine-tools, complex automatic cycles, preselection impulse counters with fixed or multiple settings N.B. : consult us for sequenced step by step operation or for using microswitches as changeover switches
284
Bi
2
1 step
1 Halt
1 Halt
360
P1 MP
P2
P1 P2
rpm 3
Bi = two-position actuating contact MP = timer motor P1, P2 etc. = timer contacts 1st changeover of Bi = advance by one step, P1 changes over 2nd changeover of Bi = advance by one step, P1 changes over Changeover time of Bi = > 1 step
2 Slow cycle
Fast 3 cycle
360
P1 P2
step 1
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 360
P1 P2 MR ML P3 P4
P3 P4
MT1
P2 P3
MT
MP
P4
ML = low-speed motor MR = high-speed motor M.A. to M = motor ML turns M.A. to A = motor MR fed from P1, fast reset to origin
360
P1 P2 P3 P4
inv c
P1
P2
Reverse 2 direction
360
P2
rpm 3
R = relay coil R1, R2, R3 = relay contacts ARS = Safety stop-switch IMP = Start ML = Low-speed motor MR = High-speed motor P1, P2, etc.= Timer contacts Pulse from IMP - R provides own supply via R1, P1 ML switched on by R2, supply to P3, P4 via R3 Changeover of P1 = End of cycle Voltage off; R1, R2 and R3 change over Voltage comes back on - supply to MR via P1 and P2; when P1 changes over, supply fed to ML
inv P1
Reverse 2 direction
360
0 P1 P2
MP
rpm 3
Inv. - Direction changer MP = Reversible motor 82 470 C = Timer capacitor P1, P2 = Timer contacts
285
Continuous cycling timer - fast cycle-end after voltage off and cycle resumed at slow constant speed
Closure of a contact
MA P1 R1 R3
1 top mini
360
P1
0 P1 1s P2
1s
360
R2
P2
P3
P1
P2
P2
MR
ML
P3
0,5 s
When MA closes, R1, R2 & R3 change over - there is supply to ML so P1 changes over. Voltage off - R1, R2 & R3 change over Voltage back on - MR is supplied via P1 and P2 - when P1 changes over, there is supply to ML
Circuit : a second contact, connected in series with the first, closes out of synchronisation with the first. There is only a supply to the load circuit while both contacts are closed.
Single-cycle timer, halt in intermediate position, fast cycle-end after voltage off and cycle resumed at slow speed Opening of a contact
0 360
P1
P2
0 P1
1s 1s
360
MA P1 R1 R3
P1 P2
P2
R2 MR R P2 ML P3 P4 P5
P3 P4 P5
0,5 s
Load
Same operation as in example 3 - ML turns until P2 changes over. There are other possible layouts, please consult us.
These circuits, which can be used with all timers, allow the minimum time interval to be reduced by approximately half. N.B. : These two circuits can only be obtained with adjustable cams.
Important note : These circuits require one or more control circuits (P1, P2). In your order, be sure to state the total number of control circuits used.
0 P1
0,5 s
360
9
Example : The minimum time normally obtainable with a standard cut-out is 1/60th of the total duration of the cycle, i.e. 1 second.
286
..............
Timer : Motor :
............................... .......................
..........................
Cycle duration :
0
10 20 30 40 50
60
120
180
240
300
360
70 80 90 100 110
T 1 R T 2 R T 3 R T 4 R T 5 R T 6 R T 7 R T 8 R T 9 R T 10 R T 11 R T 12 R T 13 R T 14 R T 15 R T 16 R T 17 R T 18 R T 19 R T 20 R T 21 R T 22 R
287
288
10
www.crouzet.com
289
10
290
Selection guide
Output contacts
n ti o ns Sa fe co ty nt ac ts D at a co nt ac ts ve sa l o fe f ty Su p vo ply l ta ge C on ne c na t io io n
Safety relays
Fu nc t
in g
C as
Screw terminals
KNA3 XS
Spring KNAC3 XS terminals Emergency stop Mobile guard monitoring 4 40 to 60 VAC/DC 115 VAC 230 VAC 24 VAC/DC 3 1 45 mm Screw terminals KZP3 RS Page 294 KNA3 RS
D es
Le
ig
KNA3 XS
24 VAC/DC 3 2-hand control 4 230 VAC 2 0 24 VAC/DC 22.5 mm 1 115 VAC 45 mm Screw terminals KZH3 RS Page 306
KZH2 XS
KZH3 RS
Timed contacts Emergency stop Mobile guard monitoring Zero speed monitoring of a motor
1 instantaneous 2 timed
1 timed
24 VAC/DC
45 mm
Screw terminals
KZR3 RS
Page 300
24 VAC/DC
45 mm
Page 304
24 VAC/DC Extension of number of contacts for safety relays Depending on main relay 3 0 40 to 260 VAC/DC 40 to 260 VAC
Spring KZEC3 XS terminals Screw KZE3 XS terminals 22.5 mm Spring KZEC3 XS terminals Screw KZE3 XS terminals Screw KZHNV XS terminals
24 VAC/DC
22.5 mm
Page 298
KZHNV XS
10
291
Sommaire gnral
Conformity
European "Machinery" Directive 89/392/EEC French Decree 92/765-766-768 European "Usage" Directive 89/655/EEC French Decree 93-40 / 93-41 European "EMC" Directive 89 336/EEC IEC 61496-1 IEC 664-1 EN 50081-2 EN 50082-2 EN 60204-1 EN 292-1 and 2 EN 574 / 97 EN 954-1 EN 418 EN 1088 UL 508 C22-2 No. 14-M91 GS-ET-20
UL (C) UL BG
EN 60 204-1
EN 1088
EN 954-1
Machine safety Parts of control systems relating to safety Tables of risks and categories
EN 574
10
292
Sommaire gnral
Categories Summary of requirements
The part of the machine control system - If a fault occurs, it may cause relating to safety and/or protective devices, as well the loss of the safety function. as its components, must be designed, selected, assembled and combined using the most - Certain faults are not detected. advanced methods in order to be able to cope with expected influences. The requirements of B apply. Proven components and safety principles must be used. As described for category B, but with greater reliability in relation to the safety of the safety function.
The requirements of B and the use of proven - The appearance of a fault may cause the loss of safety principles apply. the safety function between checking intervals. The safety function must be checked at suitable intervals by the machine control system. - the fault is detected by the check. Note : suitable times will depend on the application and the type of machine.
The control system must be designed so that : a) a single fault in control does not cause the loss of the safety function. b) if reasonably possible, the single fault must be detected by suitable measures using the most advanced technology.
- When there is a single fault, the safety function continues to operate. - Certain faults are detected, but not all. - The accumulation of non-detected faults may lead By structure to the loss of the safety function.
The requirements of B and the use of proven safety principles apply. The control system must be designed so that : a) a single fault in control does not cause the loss of the safety function, and b) if possible, the single fault should be detected, by the next call to the safety function, or c) if b) is not possible, an accumulation of faults should not cause the loss of the safety function.
- When faults appear, the safety function continues to operate. - Faults will be detected in time to avoid the loss of the safety function.
Estimation of the risk in the event of a fault and selection of a suitable category
(according to EN 954-1)
Categories B
S1
P1
Starting point for estimating the risk for the part of the control system relating to safety.
S2
F1 P2
10
Seriousness of injury S1 Slight injury S2 Serious, irreversible injury to one or more person(s) or death Frequency and duration of exposure F1 Rare to quite frequent F2 Frequent to continuous Possibility of avoiding the dangerous phenomenon P1 Possible under certain conditions P2 Rarely possible
P1 F2 P2
Go to the next highest category if the solution is standardised Go to the next lowest category if the solution is standardised
B. 1-4 : Categories for the parts of the control system relating to safety
293
Safety relay
Emergency stop
KNA3-XS / KNA3-RS / KZP3-RS "Emergency stop" and "mobile guard monitoring" functions Control device with one or two channels 3 "N/O" safety contacts with linked contacts 6A / 250 AC 1 "N/C" signalling contact Level 4 according to NF.EN 954-1 KNA3-RS (45 mm) Integrity check on control devices Separate return loop KZP3-RS (45 mm) Four input circuits
Specifications
Type KNA3-XS KNAC3-XS KNA3-RS Supply voltage 24 V AC/DC 40 - 260 V AC 24 V AC/DC 40 - 260 V AC 24 V AC/DC 115 V AC 230 V AC 24 V AC/DC Connections Screw terminals Screw terminals Spring terminals Spring terminals Screw terminals Screw terminals Screw terminals Screw terminals Weight (g) 310 310 310 310 310 410 410 410 Code 85 100 036 85 100 037 85 101 036 85 101 037 85 100 436 85 100 434 85 100 435 85 100 536
KZP3-RS
General characteristics
Operating range Precision Reset time Maximum response time on emergency stop Output specification Number of safety circuits Number of data circuits Function and use Max. absorbed power Dielectric strength Resistance to tracking EMC immunity according to EN 50082-2 Radiated electromagnetic field -15 % / + 10 % of Un for AC -15 % / + 15 % of Un for DC < 25 ms < 50 ms 3 "N/O" AgSnO2 contacts 1 "NC" AgSnO2 contacts KNA3-XS / KNA3-RS : AC 1.6 VA / DC 2 W KZP3-RS : AC 3 VA / DC 3 W 2.95 kV according to CEI 664-1 Material group III 80 MHz to 1 GHz/900 MHz (ENV 50140/204) KNA3-XS : 10 V/m Level 3 acc. to IEC 1000.4.3 KNA3-RS/KZP3-RS : 30 V/m Level X acc. to IEC 1000.4.3 8 kV in the air acc. to IEC 1000.4.2 KNA3-RS / KZP3-RS : 15 kV in the air acc. to IEC 1000.4.2 KNA3-XS : - Common mode 1 kV acc. to IEC 1000.4.5 KNA3-RS / KZP3-RS : - Level 3 acc. to IEC 1000.4.5 - Common mode 2kV for 24 V and 24 V - Common mode 4 kV for 230 V (2 kV residual current mode for KNA3-RS) KNA3-XS : - 10 V rms Level 3 according to IEC 1000.4.6 - 150 KhZ TO 80 MHz (ENV 50141) according to IEC 1000.4.11 KNA3-RS / KZP3-RS : - 30 Vrms Level X acc. to IEC 1000.4.6 150 kHz to 80 MHz (ENV 50141) according to IEC 1000.4.11
10
294
Dimensions
KNA3-XS
113
Mounting - Removing
KNA3-RS / KZP3-RS
113 90
90
68,6
90
68,6
118
22,5
118
90
45
Connections
KNA3-XS
13 23 33
KNA3-RS
Y11 Y12 Y1 13 23 33
KZP3-RS
13 23 33 S3 Y32 Y42
A1
Y1
Y2
A1
X1
Y2
S1
S2
41
A1
S1
S2
S4
Y31 Y41
PWR OUT
13 23 33 41
PWR OUT
13 23 33 41
PWR OUT
13 23 33 41
14 24 34 42 14 24 34 42
14 24 34 42
KNA3-XS
KNA3-RS
KZP3-RS
A2
41
42
A2
PE Y21 Y22
42
A2
Y11
Y1
Y2
41
42
14
24
34
Y1
X2
Y11
14
24
34
14
24
34
A1-A2 Power supply Control device (s) Y1-Y2 Start / validation 13-14/23-24/33-34 "N/O" safety contacts 41-42 "N/C" signaling contacts
A1-A2 Power supply Y11-Y12 / Y21-Y22 Redundant inputs with differentiated voltage for control devices Y1-Y2 Start/validation S1-S2 Short-circuit protection on start / validation input X1-X2 Return loop 13-14/23-24/33-34 "N/O" safety contacts 41-42 "N/C" signalling contacts
A1-A2 Power supply Y11-Y12 / Y21-Y22 Redundant inputs with differentiated voltage for control devices Y31-Y32 / T41-T42 Redundant inputs with differentiated voltage for control devices Y1-Y2 Start/validation S1-S2 / S3-S4 Short-circuit protection on start/validation input 13-14/23-24/33-34 "N/O" safety contacts 41-42 "N/C" signalling contacts
Principles
Control devices : The KZP3-RS is used to obtain and maintain a category 4 level of safety for an installation with two control devices. Depending on the degree of safety required, KNA3-XS / KNA3-RS / KZP3-RS can receive the following components as inputs : - pushbutton for start or validation (Y1-Y2) -emergency stop pushbuttons with one or two contacts (A1-A2) two contacts KNA3-RS : Y11-Y12 and Y21-Y22, two contacts KZP3-RS : Y11-Y12 / Y21-Y22 and Y31-Y32 / Y41-Y42 - position sensors (limit switches) with one or two contacts (A1-A2) two contacts KNA3-RS : Y11-Y12 and Y21-Y22, two contacts KZP3-RS : Y11-Y12 / Y21-Y22 and Y31-Y32 / Y41-Y42 A positive break operation device must be used if a single channel is used. To increase the degree of safety, one "N/C" auxiliary contact per power contactor is wired in series with the start (or validation) pushbutton, to ensure selfchecking in this part of the installation. Control devices : The KNA3 / KZP3 has three "N/O" safety contacts (13-14/23-24/33-34) and one "N/C" signalling contact (41-42). One or more control devices may be wired up to the breaking capacity of the safety contacts : 1500 VA. However, to limit internal heating, it is advisable not to exceed 10 A thermal for all three contacts. The signalling contact can be wired on a PLC input or integrated into a fault signalling system. Extending the number of contacts : The number of contacts can be extended and the breaking capacity thus increased. To do this, use the KZE3-XS.
10
295
Applications
KNA3-XS Category 2
1
KNA3-XS Category 3
24 V
1 2
2
24 V
13 23 33 A1 Y1 Y2
4
13 23 33 A1 Y1 Y2 13 23 33 C1 14 24 34 A2 41 42 14 24 34
13 23 33
C2
14 24 34 A2 41 42 14 24 34
C1 C2 0V
C1 C2 0V
B Control channel with 2 channels with C Validation D One coil per contact E Emergency stop
KNA3-RS
return loop
KNA3-RS
Category 4
+ 24 Vcc
1
Category 2
+ 24 Vcc
1 4
Y11 Y12 Y1 13 23 33 A1 X1 Y2 S1 S2 41
4
2 3
Y11 Y12 Y1 13 23 33 A1 X1 Y2 S1 S2 41
13 23 33 c1 c2 c3
41 c1
13 23 33
41
c2 c3
0V
C1 C2 C3
0V
C1 C2 C3
B S1 and S2 bridged for start/validation input protection C Emergency stop D 41-42 to PLC or fault circuit E Start
B "Light on" reflex cells C 41-42 to PLC or fault circuit D Start E Compulsory : S1 and S2 bridged for start/validation input
protection
10
296
Level 4 - KZP3-RS
+ 24 V
Level 4 - KZP3-RS
2
}
24 V 13 23 33 S3 Y32 Y42 A1 S1 S2 S4 Y31 Y41
AU1
13 23 33 c1 c2 c3
41
2
14 24 34 42
8
13 23 33
41
14 24 34 42 c1
6
0V
C1 C2 C3
c2 c3 0V
C1 C2 C3
B PLC outputs C NO D Cover E NF F S1-S2 and S3-S4 bridged for short-circuit protection on the G PLC input H Include an "N/C" contact from each power contactor in the start/ I Start
validation line (return loop) validation line
10
297
Safety relay
Specifications
Type KZHNV-XS Supply voltage 24 V AC DC Connections Screw terminal Weight (g) 230 Code 85 100 526
General characteristics
Supply Operating range Precision Synchronisation difference Response time on release of control device Output specification Number of safety circuits Number of data circuits Function and use Max. absorbed power Dielectric strength Resistance to tracking EMC immunity according to EN 50082-2 Radiated electromagnetic field Electrostatic discharge Shock waves Radio frequencies in common mode -15 % / + 10 % of Un for AC -15 % / + 15 % of Un for DC < 500 ms < 50 ms 2 "N/O" AgSnO 2 contacts 1 "N/C" AgSnO 2 contacts 1.5 VA - 24 V AC / 1.5 W - 24 V DC 2.95 kV according to IEC 664-1 Material group III 30 V/m Level X acc. to IEC 1000.4.3 80 Mhz to 1 Ghz (ENV 50140/204) 15 kV in the air (CEI 1000.4.2) Level 3 (IEC 1000.4.5) Common mode 2 kV for 24 V DC and 24 V AC 10 Vrms on inputs / Level 3 (IEC 1000.4.6) 30 Vrms on supp. / Level X (IEC 1000.4.6) 150 kHz to 80 Mhz (ENV 50141) acc. to IEC 1000.4.11
Dimensions
KZHNV-XS
113
Mounting - Removing
90
68,6
10
118
90
22,5
298
Connections
KZHNV-XS
13 A1 23 41
Y11 Y12
PWR OUT
13 23 41
1+ Z+ +Z
KZHNV-XS
A2 14 Y21 Y22 24 42
A1-A2 Power supply Y11-Y12 / Y21-Y22 Redundant inputs with differantiated voltage for control devices 13-14/23-24 "N/O" safety contacts 41-42 "N/C" signalling contacts
Applications
KZHNV-XS
4 5 6 2
13 A1 23 41
Y11 Y12
Y11
PWR
24 V
OUT
13 23 41
Y12 Y21
0V
1+ Z+ +Z
Y22
A2 14
KZHNV-XS
Y21 Y22 24 42
B Turn-off information from the enable relay C High speed contactor turn-off contact (optional) D Relevelling zone E Enable F Electronic client card G Check state of safety relay H Level sensors I Door safety line shunt
10
299
Safety relay
Timed contacts
"Emergency stop" and "mobile guard monitoring" Safety timer function from 0.5 s to 30 s Integrity check on control devices 1 "N/O" instantaneous safety contact with linked 1 "N/O" timed safety contact with linked contacts - 6A/ 1 "N/C" timed safety contact with linked contacts-6A/ 1 "N/C" timed signalling contact Level 4 according to NF.EN 954-1
250 V AC 250 V AC contacts-6A/250 V AC functions
Specifications
Type KZR3-RS Supply voltage 24 V AC DC Connections Spring terminals Weight (g) 410 Code 85 100 736
General characteristics
Supply Operating range Precision Reset time Maximum response time on emergency stop Output specification Number of safety circuits Number of data circuits Function and use Absorbed power Dielectric strength Resistance to tracking EMC immunity according to EN 50082-2 Radiated electromagnetic field Electrostatic discharge Shock waves - 15 % / + 10 % of Un for AC - 15 % / + 15 % of Un for DC < 25 ms < 50 ms instantaneous : 1 "NO" AgSnO2 timed : 1 "N/O" + 1"NC" AgSnO2 contact 1 "NC" AgSno2 contact AC 1.6 VA / DC 2 W 2,95 kV according to IEC 664-1 Material group III 30 V/m Level X acc. to IEC 1000.4.3 80 MHz to 1 GHz / 900 MHz (ENV 50140/204) 15 kV in the air acc. to IEC 1000.4.2. Level 3 acc. to IEC 1000.4.5 Common mode 4 kV for 230 V AC Common mode 2 kV for 24 V DC and 24 V AC 30 V rms Level X acc. to IEC 1000.4.3 150 kHz to 80 MHz (ENV 50141) acc. to IEC 1000.4.11
Dimensions
KZR3-RS
113 90
Mounting - Removing
10
68,6 90
118
45
300
Connections
KZR3-RS
Y11 Y12 13 27 35
A1
Y1
Y2
45
2
A1-A2
PWR OUT
K1 K2
13 27
45 35 K3 K4
14 28 46
36
KZR3-RS
A2 46
Y21 Y22
14
28
36
A1-A2 Power supply Y11-Y12 / Y21-Y22 Redundant inputs with differentiated voltage for control devices Y1-Y2 Start/validation 13-14 "N/O" instantaneous safety contact 23-24 "N/O" timed safety contact 31-32 "N/C" timed safety contact 41-42 "N/C" timed data contact
B Timed C Power-up
Principles
Control devices : Depending on the degree of safety required, KZR3-RS can receive the following components as inputs : - emergency stop pushbuttons with two contacts (Y11-Y12 and Y21-Y22) - position sensors (limit switches) with one or two contacts (Y11-Y12 and Y21-Y22) - auxiliary contact for electromagnetic lock (Y11-Y12 and Y21-Y22) - pushbutton for start or validation (Y1-Y2) A positive break operation device must be used if a single contact is used. Control devices : The KZR3-RS has one "N/O" instantaneous safety category 4 contact (13-14) , one "N/O" timed safety category 3 contact (23-24) and one "N/C" (41-42) signalling contact. One or more control devices may be wired up to the breaking capacity of the safety contacts : 1500 VA. Extending the number of contacts : The number of contacts of the KZR3-XS can be extended and the breaking capacity thus increased. To do this, use the KZE3-XS.
Applications
KZR3-RS used for deferred access KZR3-RS used for breaking M1 and M2 in sequence
24 V
C1
Y11 Y12 13 27 35 Y1 Y2 45 A1
2 1
c1 c2
13 27 K1 K2
45 35 K3 K4 36 46 28 36
C2
c2 c3 c4 Y1 Y21 13 23 K1 K2
M
41 31
14 28 46 KZR3-RS A2 Y21Y22 14
10
Y1
Y2 Y21 Y11 0V
4
C1 C2
Y22
Y12 C1 C2 C3 C4
Y12 Y22
Safety relay
Extension relay
Extending the number of contacts in a safety relay Used to increase the breaking capacity of the main unit "CE" conforming product / BG approved Safety via redundancy and self-checking 3 "N/O" safety contacts with linked contacts 6 A / 250 V AC 1 "N/C" return loop
Specifications
Type KZE3-XS KZEC3-XS Supply voltage 24 V AC DC 40 / 260 V AC 24 V 40 - 260 V Connections Screw terminals Screw terminals Spring terminals Spring terminals Weight (g) 310 310 310 310 Code 85 100 936 85 100 937 85 101 936 85 101 937
General characteristics
Supply Operating range Precision Synchronisation difference Maximum response time on emergency stop at Un Output specification Number of data circuits Return loop Function and use Max. absorbed power Dielectric strength Resistance to tracking EMC immunity according to EN 50082-2 Radiated electromagnetic field Electrostatic discharge Shock waves Radio frequencies in common mode - 15 % / + 10 % of Un for AC - 15 % / + 15 % of Un for DC < 25 ms 50 ms 3"NO" AgSnO2 contact 1 "NC" AgSnO2 contact AC 1.6 VA / DC 2 W 2.95 kV according to CEI 664-1 Material group III 10 V/m Level 3 acc. to IEC 1000.4.2 80 MHz to 1GHz / 900 MHz (ENV 50140/204) 8 kV in the air acc. to IEC 1000.4.2 Common mode 1 kV acc. to IEC 1000.4.5 10 Vrms Level 3 acc. to IEC 1000.4.6 150 kHz to 80 MHz (ENV 50141) acc. to IEC 1000.4.11
Dimensions
KZE3-XS
113
Mounting - Removing
90
68,6
10
118
90
22,5
Principles
Control devices : Depending on the degree of safety required, the KZE3-XS can be controlled by one or two channels. In most cases, control by one channel will be sufficient. Please consult your inspection office for further information. Control devices : The KZE3-XS has three "N/O" safety contacts (13-14/23-24/33-34) and a return loop (X1-X2) which must be included in the "start / validation" line (Y1-Y2) of the main unit. One or more control devices may be wired up to the breaking capacity of the safety contacts : 1500 VA. However, to limit internal heating in the KZE3-XS, it is advisable not to exceed 10 A thermal for all three contacts. Extending the number of contacts : It is possible to wire several extension KZE3-XS units in cascade. All the return loops (X1-X2) will be in series with the "start/validation" line (Y1-Y2) of the main unit.
To order, see page 6
302
Connections
13 23 33
A1
X1
X2
PWR OUT
13 23 33 41
14 24 41 42
KZE3-XS
A2
X1
X2
14
24
34
A1-A2 Power supply-Control device (s) 41-42 Return contact 13-14/23-24/33-34 "N/O" safety contacts X1-X2 Internal return loop
Applications
Example of wiring KZE3-XS controlled by a single channel as an extension of a KNA3-XS
24 V
1
1 3
24 V
13 23 33 A1 Y1 Y2 KNA3-XS 13 23 33
13 23 33 A1 X1 X2 KZE3-XS 13 23 33
13 23 33 A1 Y1 Y2
13 23 33 A1 X1 X2 KZE3-XS 13 23 33
13 23 33 A1 X1 X2 KZE3-XS 13 23 33
2
KNA3-XS 13 23 33
c1
14 24 34 A2 41 42 14 24 34
14 24 34 A2 41 42 14 24 34
14 24 34 A2 41 42 14 24 34
c1
14 24 34 A2 41 42 14 24 34
14 24 34 A2 41 42 14 24 34
c2
c2
C1 C2
C3 C4 C5 C6
C7 C8 C9
0V
C1 C2 0V
C3 C4 C5 C6
Y11 Y12 13 23 33 A1 X1 Y2 51 52 41
13 23 33 A1 X1 X2 KZE3-XS 13 23 33
c1 c2 c3
10
13 23 33
41
14 24 34 42 KNA3-RS A2 Y21Y22 42 X2 Y1 14 24 34
14 24 34 A2 41 42 14 24 34
c4 c5
0V
C1 C2
C3 C4 C5
Safety relay
Specifications
Type KSW2-RS Supply voltage 24 V AC DC Connections Screw terminals Weight (g) 410 Code 85 100 326
General characteristics
Supply Operating range Precision Reset time (self-test) Setting for channels 1 and 2 Synchronisation difference Hysteresis Output specification Number of safety circuits Function and use Max. absorbed power Dielectric strength Resistance to tracking EMC immunity according to EN 50082-2 Radiated electromagnetic field Electrostatic discharge Shock waves Radio frequencies in common mode - 15 % / + 10 % of Un for AC - 15 % / + 15 % of Un for DC 3s 20 mV 500 mV +/-15 % <3s 40 % +/- 50 % 1 "N/O" + 1 "NC" contact AgSnO2 AC 1.6 VA / DC 2 W 2.95 kV according to IEC 664-1 Material group III 30 V/m Level X acc. to IEC 1000.4.3 80 MHz to 1GHz / 900 MHz (ENV 50140 / 204) 15 kV in the air acc. IEC 1000.4.2 Level 3 according to IEC 1000.4.5 Common mode 2 kV for 24 V DC and 24 V AC 30 V rms Level X acc.to IEC 1000.4.6 150 kHz to 80 MHz (ENV 50141) acc. to IEC 1000.4.11
Dimensions
KSW2-RS
113 90
Mounting - Removing
68,6
118
90
10
45
304
Connections
NC 13 21 X1 NC NC
A1
NC
X2
NC
L3
L3
PWR OUT
A1-A2 Power supply X1-X2 Return loop L1-L2 Input channel 1 (motor winding) L2-L3 Input channel 2 (motor winding) 13-14 "N/O" safety contacts 21-22 "N/C" safety contacts
13 21
14 22
KSW2-RS
L2 NC NC
A2
NC
PE
NC
14
22
L1
NC
NC
Principles
Self-test : When terminals A1-A2 are powered up, a test sequence is initiated : the output relays (terminals 13-14 and 21-22) are energised for 1.5 s then separate for 1.5 s. If no fault is detected, the relays reattach. This test checks : - failure of the output contacts (terminals 13-14 and 21-22) - breaking of one of the phases (L1, L2 or L3) - the validity of the return loop (X1-X2) - the failure of an internal component Safety function : When an electric motor rotates while no longer supplied with power, it behaves like a generator, supplying voltage (called remanent) to the terminals of its windings. This voltage varies according to several parameters : speed of rotation, the motor characteristics, remanent magnetisation, inertia of the mechanical assembly. The KSW2-RS measures this voltage and interprets it so that the doors and mobile guards can only be opened once the motor has actually stopped. Setting : Both channels are set on the front of the KSW2-RS using two potentiometers. This mitigates the effects of any imbalance between the windings or remanent voltages. Setting is within a range of 20 mV to 500 mV in order to adapt a threshold to a slow or zero speed, which is not dangerous for the operator. Control devices : The KSW2-RS has one "N/O" (13-14) and one "N/C" (21-22) safety contact. One or more control devices may be wired up to the breaking capacity of the safety contacts : 1500 VA Extending the number of contacts : The number of contacts of the KSW2-XS can be extended and the breaking capacity thus increased. To do this, use the KZE3-XS
Applications
Example
+ 24 V
3 2
c1 Y11 Y12 Y1 13 23 33 A1 X1 Y2 S1 S2 41 13 21 X1 X2 L3 L3
C1
Y2
A1
13 23 33
41 c2 C2
10
14 24 34 42 Y1 Y21 Y11
5
KSW2-RS A2 L1 14 22 L2 L3 L1 L2 L3
Y12 Y22 0V
C1 C2
Safety relay
2-hand control
Type III C "2-hand control" functions according to EN Control device with two channels Level 4 according to NF.EN 954-1
"KZH2-XS" : 2 "N/O" safety contacts with linked contacts-6A/250 VAC "KZH3-RS" : 3 "N/O" safety contacts with linked contacts-6A/250 VAC "NC" signalling contact 574/97
Specifications
Type KZH2-XS KZH3-RS Supply voltage 24 VAC DC 24 V AC DC 115 V AC 230 V AC Connections Screw terminal Screw terminal Screw terminal Screw terminal Weight (g) 230 310 410 410 Code 85 100 626 85 100 636 85 100 634 85 100 635
General characteristics
Operating range Synchronisation difference Reset time Response time on release of control device Maximum response time on emergency stop at Un Number of safety circuits Number of data circuits Max. absorbed power Dielectric strength Resistance to tracking Radiated electromagnetic field Electrostatic discharge Shock waves -15 % / +10 % of Un for AC -10 % / + 15 % of Un for DC KZH2-XS : < 500 ms KZH3-RS / < 500 ms KZH3-RS : < 20 ms KZH3-RS : < 20 ms KZH2-XS : 2 "N/O" AgSnO2 contacts KZH3-RS : 3 "N/O" AgSnO2 contacts KZH3-RS : 1 "NC" AgSnO2 contacts KZH2-XS : AC 1.5 VA / DC 1.5 W KZH3-RS : 24 AC 1.5 VA / 24 DC 1.5 W / 115-230 AC 3.2 VA 2.95 kV according to IEC 664-1 Material group III 30 V / m Level X acc. to IEC 1000.4.3 80 MHz to 1GHz / 900 MHz (ENV50140 / 204) 15 kV in the air acc. to IEC 1000.4.2 Level 3 acc. to IEC 1000.4.5 Common mode 2 kV for 24 V DC and 24 V AC KZH3-RS / Common mode 4 kV for 230 V AC 2kV residual current mode 10 V rms on inputs / level 3 acc. to IEC 1000.4.6 30 V rms on supp. / Level X acc. to IEC 1000.4.6 150 kHz to 80 MHz (ENV 50141) acc. to IEC 1000.4.11
Dimensions
KZH2-XS
113
KZH3-RS
113 90
Mounting - Removing
90
10
68,6
90
68,6
118
22,5
118
90
45
306
Connections
KZH2-XS
13 23 Y11
KZH3-RS
Y12 Y11 Y13 13 23 33
A1
Y12 Y13
A1
N1
N1
41
PWR OUT
13 23
PWR OUT
13 23 33 41
14 24 34 42
14 24
KZH2-XS
KZH3-RS
A2
Y22 Y23
A2
PE
PE
42
14
24
Y21
14
24
34
A1-A2 Power supply Y11-Y12-Y13 / Y21-Y22-Y23 Redundant inputs with differentiated voltage for control devices 13-14/23-24 "N/O" safety contacts
A1-A2 Power supply Y11-Y12-Y13 / Y21-Y22-Y23 Redundant inputs with differentiated voltage for control devices 13-14/23-24/33-34 "N/O" safety contacts 41-42 "N/C" signalling contacts
Principles
Control devices : The KZH2-XS and KZH3-RS can receive the following components as inputs : - two pushbuttons with two positions "N/O" + "N/C" (Y11-Y12-Y13 and Y21-Y22-Y23) - one or two emergency stop pushbuttons with one or two channels (A1-A2). Control devices : The KZH2-XS has two "N/O" safety contacts (13-14/23-24). One or more control devices may be wired up to the breaking capacity of the safety contacts : 1500 VA. However, to limit internal heating in the KZH2-XS, it is advisable not to exceed 8 A thermal for both contacts. The KZH3-RS has three "N/O" safety contacts (13-14/23-24/33-34) and one "N/C" signalling contact (41/42). One or more control devices may be wired up to the breaking capacity of the safety contacts : 1500 VA. However, to limit internal heating in the KZH3-RS , it is advisable not to exceed 10 A thermal for both contacts. Extending the number of contacts : The number of contacts can be extended and the breaking capacity thus increased. To do this, use the KZE3-XS.
Applications
KZH2-XS
24 V
KZH3-RS
+ 24 V
S1
1
Y12 Y11 Y13 13 23 33 A1 N1 N1 41
13 23 33
41
KZH2-XS 13 23
2
14 24 34 42 KZH3-RS A2 PE 42 Y22 Y21 Y23 14 24 34
S2
10
C1 C2 C3 0V
C1 C2 0V
B C
307
S1
c3
C1 C2 0V
C3 C4 C5
B Emergency stop
10
308
Emergency stop Timed contacts Extension relay Zero speed monitoring 2-hand control
Supply
Supply voltage On/off indication 24 V AC 50 / 60 Hz 24 V DC maximum ripple 10 % 1 power supply voltage LED Volt-free outputs 1500 VA 6.82 A 440 V AC 105 operations at 1500 VA resistive 5.105 operations at 500 VA resistive 107 1 internal relay status LED 0 +50 -20 +70 24 V DC 2kV directly acc. to IEC 1000.4.4 4 kV directly for the 230 V <ac> version 2 Kv when coupled Un-30 % for 10 ms every 1 s Un-60 % for 100 ms every 1 s according to IEC 61496-1/97 Un-100 % for 10 ms every 100 ms Un-50 % for 20 ms every 200 ms Un-50 % for 500 ms every 5 s Polycarbonate Self-extinguishing-UL94 class VO IP 40 IP 20 2 x 1.5 mm 2 multicore with ferrule 2 x 2.5 mm 2 solid conductor 2.5 mm2 1.5 mm2
Output specification
Type Breaking capacity (V resistive) Max. breaking current Max. breaking voltage Electrical endurance Mechanical life (operations)
Material Protection Housing Protection Terminal Tightening capacity Spring terminals, 2 terminals per connection point - rigid wire Spring terminals, 2 terminals per connection point - flexible wire
10
309
Two-hand control
Used in conjunction with a "KZH3" safety start module
for two-hand control applications : folding, clipping, punching, rail-cutting, bending, drilling, presses, etc. Supplied with an emergency stop button and 2 springreturn mushroom head pushbuttons. Conforms to EN 574 concerning safety applications
Specifications
Type KSP Designation KSP2 two-hand control console KSP console fixing foot Code 85 100 293 85 100 292
Accessories
Mushroom head emergency stop Spring-return pushbuttons Code 79 697 001 79 697 101
Dimensions
85 100 291
210
85 100 292
79 697 101
70
80
45
130
400
25
~ 800
10
310
100
30
40
34
50
24,5
Micro-PLCs Micro-PLCs
11
www.crouzet.com
311
11
312
RPX micro-PLCs
Compact ... high-performance ... user-friendly, with 10 to 48 modular I/O Extension modules : digital and analogue I/O, 13 kHz high-speed counter and communications Communication using ASI, CBUS (MODBUS compatible), PROFIBUS, and PROFIBUS/MODBUS, MODBUS/ASI and PROFIBUS/ASI gateways ASIO 20 and 67 inputs/outputs using ASI for distributed control system applications Programmed via RPX C1 and C2 consoles or using RPX C3 software under Windows
extension modules
RPX, the standard open-access range, compatible with I/O extension modules : - Digital I/O. - Analogue I/O. - Versions for communication using CBUS (Modbus compatible), Profibus and ASI (Device Net and Interbus S being developed). - Remote I/O using ASI and CBUS protocols. The modular internal design of the RPX using plug-in boards offers the opportunity for multiple special configurations.
RPX, the low-cost range for constructing simple control systems with digital I/O. Compact size, ease of programming and installation make the RPX 10, 15 and 25 three products which can do just about anything!
Approvals
- CE marking (conforming to the low voltage directive 73/23/EEC) - UL and C/UL approval. - Level 3 electromagnetic compatibility in accordance with EN 60204-1 and IEC 801-2/3/4. - Adapted for use in an industrial environment (conforming to IEC 1131-2).
Powerful
- A 16-bit micro-controller. - Non-volatile EEPROM program memory holding 1100 or 2700 program steps depending on the model. More than 50 instructions available (including arithmetic). - Data memory 512 x 16 bit words (256 words for RPX 10, 15 and 25). - 64 pre-programmed timer functions. - 32 counters.
Easy to use
- DIN rail mounted. - Screw terminals able to take 2 x 2.5 mm2 wires. - Compact dimensions, 90 x 104 x 45 or 225 mm depending on the version.
Real-time clock
- Clock - Calendar - Time counter
10 to 48 Inputs/Outputs
- Isolated 24 VDC inputs. For 2 or 3-wire NPN/PNP detectors and volt-free contacts. - 1 x 3.5 kHz high-speed counter input. - Independent, 2 A - 230 VDC relay outputs or 0.5 A - 24 VDC NPN/PNP transistor outputs. - Analogue I/O 0-10 V or 0-20 mA. - Pt 100 inputs - 50C +80C. - Auxiliary power supply modules 24 VDC output, 120 or 230 VAC input.
11
Programming languages
- Relay ladder diagrams. - Function charts. - Natural language.
Diagnostics
- Indicators for I/O states and correct PLC operation.
Flexible
- Extension modules for digital and analogue I/O, communications, etc., for low cost system upgrades.
313
MIDU
User-definable functions filtering and counting up to 500 Hz on digital inputs time delay on digital outputs (steady, pulsed, flashing etc.) from 100 ms to 100 min. threshold check or scaling of analogue inputs freezing or fallback of digital and analogue outputs in the case of a fault Removable reference labels for inputs/outputs Galvanic isolation Sub-base of 1 to 4 terminal blocks with internal pre-wired commons Mechanical location coding for mounting I/O modules on terminal block sub-bases.
INDUSTR
IAL
Removable modules
OPEN
es to fieldbus us*, n to Cb Connectio and DP, fibus FMS Pro Can Open
*Modbus compatible
PC or PLC
MIDU parameters entered via switches
11
314
FLEXIBLE
trol for all con system res architectu
Distributed control system with remote inputs/outputs and local processing by CPU module
PLC or PC card
PLC or PC card
I/O
CPU
I/O
CPU
I/O
I/O
CPU
I/O
Applications
For assembly machines, special production machines, conveyors, rotating machines, etc. CBM, BMS : lighting, security, air conditioning, car parks, etc. On-board control systems : lorries, rail transport etc.
Applications
Adapted to the specific needs of delocalised control-command functions and to processing reflex functions (personnel and machine safety). For modular machines or machines with flexible configuration : design, acceptance tests, simplified operation and maintenance.
Applications
Compact control system applications with a small number of wire-to-wire I/O : lifts, coffee machines, vending machines, animated advertising panels, etc.
11
315
18 000 000
18 372 112 18 373 112 18 373 112
Description Digital temperature controllers MIC 48 Current transformers 10 A / 50 mA Digital temperature controllers MIC 48 Current transformers 25 A / 50 mA Digital temperature controllers MIC 48 Current transformers 50 A / 50 mA Current control - Current transformers for EIT 100 A / 50 mA
25 000 000
25 622 076 25 622 077 25 622 080 25 622 128 25 622 130 25 622 301 Digital TOP 948 - 11-pin solder-connected plug Chronos 2 - 11-pin connector base (for the whole range) Analogue TMR 48 - 11-pin connector base Chronos 2 - 8-pin connector base Analogue TMR 48 - 8-pin connector base Digital 816 - 8-pin solder-connected plug 78 42 74 42 74 82
79 000 000
79 222 640 79 222 640 79 222 640 79 222 640 79 222 641 79 222 641 79 222 641 79 222 641 79 237 709 79 237 790 79 694 002 79 694 005 79 694 016 79 696 006 79 696 014 79 696 030 79 696 031 79 696 032 79 696 033 79 696 034 79 696 035 79 696 036 79 696 037 79 696 038 79 696 039 79 696 040 79 696 041 79 696 042 79 696 043 79 696 044 79 697 001 79 697 101 Striker cams Striker cams Striker cams Striker cams Packet of extra strikers Packet of extra strikers Packet of extra strikers Packet of extra strikers Analogue temperature controllers - Protective cover IP 54 Digital TOP 948 - Spring clips Digital TOP 948 - 11-pole rear base Digital TOP 948 - Asymmetrical adaptor Digital - 8-pin solder-connector base Level control - S5 Level control - S3 Temperature probes - Thermocouple / PT100 Temperature probes - Thermocouple / PT100 Temperature probes - Thermocouple / PT100 Temperature probes - Thermocouple / PT100 Temperature probes - Thermocouple / PT100 Temperature probes - Thermocouple / PT100 Temperature probes - Thermocouple / PT100 Temperature probes - Thermocouple / PT100 Temperature probes - Connection Temperature probes - Connection Temperature probes - Connection Temperature probes - Sub-base Temperature probes - Flange Level control - S7 Level control - S8 Two-hand control console - Mushroom head emergency stop Two-hand control console - Spring-return pushbuttons 274 276 278 280 274 276 278 280 210 78 78 78 86 119 119 220 220 220 220 220 220 220 220 220 220 220 220 220 119 119 310 310
26 000 000
26 532 702 26 532 704 26 532 706 26 532 707 26 532 708 26 532 709 26 532 720 26 532 721 26 532 730 26 532 731 26 532 741 26 532 742 26 532 758 26 532 759 26 532 761 26 532 762 26 532 762 26 532 764 26 532 764 26 532 790 26 532 796 26 532 796 26 532 797 26 532 797 26 532 798 26 532 801 26 546 803 26 546 805 26 546 829 Miniature - Spring clips for teminal base Miniature - Spring clips for P.C.B. base Miniature - Base for DIN rail mounting RTMA4 Miniature - Base for DIN rail mounting RTMA2 Miniature - Base for printed circuit board RTMA4 Miniature - Base for printed circuit board RTMA2 Heat seal Heat seal Fuses for GMS relays Fuses for GMS relays Varistor protection for solid state relays Varistor protection for solid state relays Heatsinks Heatsinks Heatsinks Three-phase alternative current - Heatsink Heatsinks Three-phase changeover, AC - DIN rail heatsinks DIN raIl adaptor Heatsinks Three-phase alternative current - Protective cover Protective cover Three-phase changeover, AC - Protective cover Protective cover Protective cover Adaptors for fixing on panel (set of 4) Electro-mechanical hour counter CH 48 G - DIN socket rail connector Electro-mechanical hour counter CH 48 G - Bezel (grey) 55 x 55 mm Totalizers - LCD 24 x 48 (Hour counter/ chronometer) - Adaptor for cut-out 50 (dimensions 73 mm) Totalizers - LCD 24 x 48 (Hour counter/ chronometer) - Adaptor for cut-out 45 x 45 mm (dimensions 52 x 52 mm) Totalizers - LCD 24 x 48 (Hour counter/ chronometer) - Adaptor for cut-out 25x50 mm (dimensions 29x54 mm) 46 46 46 46 46 46 194 194 194 194 194 194 195 195 195 190 195 188 196 195 190 196 188 196 196 195 266 266 240
84 000 000
84 028 251 84 028 451 84 028 453 84 028 459 84 028 651 84 028 653 84 060 001 Three-phase alternative current - Range GA3 Three-phase alternative current - Range GA3 Three-phase alternative current - Range GA3 Relay-heatsink assembly - Assembly Three-phase alternative current - Range GA3 Three-phase alternative current - Range GA3 SMART SSR - " hockey puck " 190 190 190 180 190 190 184
26 546 830
240
26 546 831
240
316
84 130 150
162
84 130 152
162
84 130 158
162
84 130 220
168
168
84 130 222
168
84 130 101
166
84 130 102
84 130 103
162
166
84 130 312
166
84 130 111
164
84 130 112
164
84 130 113
164
84 130 114
164
84 130 115
164
84 130 116
162
84 130 117
162
84 130 511 84 132 000 84 132 010 84 132 100 84 132 110 84 132 200 84 132 210 84 132 300 84 132 310 84 132 400 84 132 410 84 132 500 84 132 510 84 132 600 84 132 610 84 132 700 84 132 710 84 134 000 84 134 001 84 134 002 84 134 010 84 134 011 84 134 012 84 134 020 84 134 021 84 134 022 84 134 030 84 134 031 84 134 032 84 134 040 84 134 041 84 134 042 84 134 080 84 134 081
187 186 186 186 186 186 186 186 186 186 186 186 186 186 186 186 186 176 176 176 176 176 176 176 176 176 176 176 176 176 176 176 176 176
317
318
319
85 000 000
85 100 036 85 100 037 85 100 292 85 100 293 85 100 326 85 100 434 85 100 435 85 100 436 85 100 526 85 100 536 85 100 626 85 100 634 85 100 635 85 100 636 85 100 736 85 100 936 85 100 937 85 101 036 85 101 037 85 101 936 85 101 937
87 000 000
87 606 010 87 606 020 87 606 110 87 606 120 87 606 330 87 610 040 87 610 050 87 610 140 87 610 150 87 610 240 87 610 250 87 610 340 87 610 440
320
88 000 000
88 225 011 88 225 012 88 225 013 88 225 014 88 225 015 88 225 016 88 225 017 88 225 019 88 226 011 88 226 012 88 226 013 88 226 014 88 226 015 88 226 016 88 226 017 88 226 019 88 226 501 88 226 502 88 226 503 88 226 504 88 226 505 88 226 506 88 226 507 88 226 508 88 256 4 88 256 401 88 256 402 88 256 403 88 256 404 88 256 405 88 256 406 88 256 407 88 256 408 88 256 5 88 256 506 88 256 507 88 256 508 88 256 509 88 256 510 88 256 511 88 256 512 88 256 513 88 256 9 88 256 906 88 256 907 88 256 908 88 256 909 88 256 910 88 256 911 88 256 912 88 256 913 88 645 0 88 645 0 88 645 1 88 645 2 88 645 2 88 645 3 88 645 4 88 645 4 88 645 5 88 645 6 88 645 6 DIN rail mounted - 6 s 12 min DIN rail mounted - 6 s 12 min DIN rail mounted - 6 s 12 min DIN rail mounted - 6 min 12 h DIN rail mounted - 6 min 12 h DIN rail mounted - 6 min 12 h DIN rail mounted - 6 min 12 h DIN rail mounted - 6 s 12 min Panel-mounted - 6 s 12 mm Panel-mounted - 6 s 12 mm Panel-mounted - 6 s 12 mm Panel-mounted - 6 min 12 h Panel-mounted - 6 min 12 h Panel-mounted - 6 min 12 h Panel-mounted - 6 min 12 h Panel-mounted - 6 s 12 mm Panel-mounted - 6 s 12 mm Panel-mounted - 6 s 12 mm Panel-mounted - 6 s 12 mm Panel-mounted - 6 s 12 mm Panel-mounted - 6 min 12 h Panel-mounted - 6 min 12 h Panel-mounted - 6 min 12 h Panel-mounted - 6 min 12 h Cam timers 1 circuit Panel-mounted - 882564 Panel-mounted - 882564 Panel-mounted - 882564 Panel-mounted - 882564 Panel-mounted - 882564 Panel-mounted - 882564 Panel-mounted - 882564 Panel-mounted - 882564 Cam timers 2 circuits Panel-mounted - 882565 Panel-mounted - 882565 Panel-mounted - 882565 Panel-mounted - 882565 Panel-mounted - 882565 Panel-mounted - 882565 Panel-mounted - 882565 Panel-mounted - 882565 Cam timers 3 circuits Panel-mounted - 882569 Panel-mounted - 882569 Panel-mounted - 882569 Panel-mounted - 882569 Panel-mounted - 882569 Panel-mounted - 882569 Panel-mounted - 882569 Panel-mounted - 882569 Cam timers with external knob 7 circuits Cam timers with internal knob 5 circuits Cam timers with fast cycle-end or 2 speeds 5 circuits Cam timers with external knob 12 circuits Cam timers with internal knob 10 circuits Cam timers with fast cycle-end or 2 speeds 10 circuits Cam timers with external knob 17 circuits Cam timers with internal knob 15 circuits Cam timers with fast cycle-end or 2 speeds 15 circuits Cam timers with external knob 22 circuits Cam timers with internal knob 20 circuits 64 64 64 64 64 64 64 64 92 92 92 92 92 92 92 92 92 92 92 92 92 92 92 92 282 96 96 96 96 96 96 96 96 282 96 96 96 96 96 96 96 96 282 96 96 96 96 96 96 96 96 274 274 274 274 274 274 274 274 274 274 274
321
322
89 000 000
89 420 047 89 420 067 89 420 077 89 420 087 89 420 097
323
99 766 922
262
99 766 924
262
99 000 000
99 761 710 99 761 711 99 761 712 99 761 714 99 761 715 99 761 716 99 761 718 99 766 601 99 766 602 99 766 604 99 766 607 99 766 610 99 766 611 99 766 613 99 766 616 99 766 701 99 766 702 99 766 704 99 766 707 99 766 710 Electro-mechanical hour counter CH 48 G - CH 48 G Electro-mechanical hour counter CH 48 G - CH 48 G Electro-mechanical hour counter CH 48 G - CH 48 G Electro-mechanical hour counter CH 48 G - CH 48 G Electro-mechanical hour counter CH 48 G - CH 48 G Electro-mechanical hour counter CH 48 G - CH 48 G Electro-mechanical hour counter CH 48 G - CH 48 G Electro-mechanical impulse counters totalizing - 36 x 37 - Without zero reset Electro-mechanical impulse counters totalizing - 36 x 37 - Without zero reset Electro-mechanical impulse counters totalizing - 36 x 37 - Without zero reset Electro-mechanical impulse counters totalizing - 36 x 37 - Without zero reset Electro-mechanical impulse counters totalizing - 36 x 37 - With zero reset Electro-mechanical impulse counters totalizing - 36 x 37 - With zero reset Electro-mechanical impulse counters totalizing - 36 x 37 - With zero reset Electro-mechanical impulse counters totalizing - 36 x 37 - With zero reset Electro-mechanical impulse counters totalizing - 36 x 48 - Without zero reset Electro-mechanical impulse counters totalizing - 36 x 48 - Without zero reset Electro-mechanical impulse counters totalizing - 36 x 48 - Without zero reset Electro-mechanical impulse counters totalizing - 36 x 48 - Without zero reset Electro-mechanical impulse counters totalizing - 36 x 48 - Without zero reset (manual) Electro-mechanical impulse counters totalizing - 36 x 48 - Without zero reset (manual) Electro-mechanical impulse counters totalizing - 36 x 48 - Without zero reset (manual) Electro-mechanical impulse counters totalizing - 36 x 48 - Without zero reset (manual) Electro-mechanical impulse counters totalizing - 24 x 48 - Without zero reset Electro-mechanical impulse counters totalizing - 24 x 48 - Without zero reset Electro-mechanical impulse counters totalizing - 24 x 48 - Without zero reset Electro-mechanical impulse counters totalizing - 24 x 48 - Without zero reset 266 266 266 266 266 266 266 260 260 260 260 260 260 260 260 264 264 264 264 264
99 766 927
262
99 766 711
264
99 766 713
264
99 766 716
264
324
Memo:
325
Memo:
326
Conditions of sale
1. Acceptance All orders are accepted subject to the following Conditions of Sale which cannot be varied except expressly and in writing by us. These terms and conditions shall prevail over any terms and conditions contained in a purchasers order. Any sale by us to purchaser subsequent to an order or other notification incorporating any Conditions of Purchase of the Purchaser shall not be deemed to constitute an acceptance by us of the purchasers Conditions of Purchase. 2. Prices and discounts All prices and discount rates are subject to alteration without notice and the rate applicable to a particular order will be our price and discount rates current at the date of despatch irrespective of the price and discount rate stated in our acknowledgement. Minimum order charge payable. 3. Payment Payment must be made with the order in cash without any deduction (other than any discount rate previously agreed by us) unless monthly or other terms have been approved by us prior to the order being made. 4. Despatch dates Despatch dates given are based on our best information at the time quoted, but are given as estimates only. We reserve the right to postpone any quoted despatch or delivery dates without prior notice and without liability for any delay. Delivery weeks are numbered 1-52 from January to December. 5. Cancellation or amendment We reserve the right to cancel or amend a purchasers order if it is impractical or impossible for us to fulfil the order by reason of any act of God, war, civil disturbance, strike, lockout, cessation of work, combination of workmen or employees, legislation or restriction of any governmental or other authority, breakdown or interruption of transport, force majeure or any other circumstances beyond our control and in such circumstances the obligations of each part hereunder shall be wholly or partially suspended during the continuance and to the extent of such prevention, interruption or hindrance. 6. Descriptions Technical information relating to our products as set out in our catalogue(s) and description literature may be varied by us from time to time due to manufacturing and other factors. Every effort will be made to keep our literature and catalogues up-to-date but the purchaser should make specific enquiries and satisfy himself that any order given by him is of products and specifications currently available, and supplied by us at the time the order is given. Every endeavour will be made by us to correct and up-date our literature from time to time as the situation shall require but we accept no liability for minor or trifling misdescription. 7. Delivery complaints Non delivery within 10 days of the date of despatch must be reported immediately in writing to us and to the carriers. Any damage or shortfall in delivery must be reported in writing to us within three days of delivery giving a statement of the alleged shortfall or damage. We shall not be liable for any claims in respect of the above complaints unless they have been reported in accordance with this Clause. 8. Warranty We shall repair or, at our option, replace without charge any products manufactured and supplied by us hereunder which prove defective within twelve months from the date of despatch PROVIDED ALWAYS, that a) such products have not been structurally modified or misused or misapplied; b) they are returned to us carriage paid; c) all terms agreed by us for payment of such goods have been strictly complied with; d) any claim hereunder is made within 30 days of the date of discovery of the defect. PROVIDED THAT this Warranty shall not extend to any prototype(s) nor any pre-production batch supplied for customer evaluation. Where it appears to us following an inspection of the return of goods that no defect rendering the goods unmerchantable or fit for their purpose exists or has existed since despatch by us we shall be entitled at our absolute discretion to return the goods henceforth to the buyer who shall thereupon bear and be responsible for cost of carriage thereby incurred. Save as provided above we accept no liability in contract or tort whatsoever in respect of defects in goods sold by us save where such liability cannot be limited or exclused in law. 9. Errors We reserve the right to correct all typographical and clerical errors and the purchaser may not rely on any such information thus erroneously provided. 10. Proper law The parties hereby agree that any contract made between them and any question thereby arising shall be governed by English law. 11. Intellectual property The purchaser hereby agrees and undertakes not to copy, publicise or make available to any third party any drawings, designs, patterns, tooling written instructions, software specifications etc produced and supplied by us in connection with any order placed under these conditions save in accordance with any licence granted by us and it is hereby agreed that the same shall remain our property and must be returned to us on demand free of charge. Where software is incorporated in our product and sold to the purchaser as a package the software remains our property and the purchaser has a no-exclusive right of use. As a consequence, the purchaser is forbidden to reproduce, except for the purchasers own security copy purposes, alter or publish such software as is marketed by us or otherwise inform unauthorised persons. 12. Title We retain ownership in the goods until full payment has been made and goods supplied that have not been paid for must be held by the purchaser on our behalf as follows : a) It shall be the duty of the purchaser to preserve and store goods delivered in an identifiable form and not to mix or make the said goods until payment is received by us in full, unless written consent is other-wise given. Further if such written consent is given, it is agreed that you will hold the proceeds of sale on trust for us in a separate identifiable bank account until the payment is made in full. b) It is further hereby agreed that in the event of the purchaser becoming bankrupt or having a Receiving Order or Administration Order made or making arrangements with creditors for commencing to be wound up then the purchaser will notify us forthwith and we shall be entitled to give notices and instructions to the purchaser in accordance with clause (a) above. Nothing in this sub-clause shall prejudice our rights with regard to clause (a) above. 13. Minimum order charge 100 (excluding Post and Packing)+VAT. Orders for less than 100 will be charged as 100. VAT will be added at the relevant rate.
OTHER COUNTRIES Crouzet Automatismes SAS Division Ventes Internationales 2, rue du docteur Abel - BP 59 26902 Valence cedex 9 - Fr Tel. : +33 475 448 936 Fax : +33 475 448 105 E-mail : com-dvi@crouzet.com www.crouzet.com Customer services Tel. : +33 475 802 102 Fax : +33 475 802 120 E-mail : infocom@crouzet.com
Warning: The product information contained in this catalogue is given purely as information and does not constitute a representation, warrantly or any form of contractual commitment. CROUZET Automatismes and its subsidiaries reserve the right to modify their products without notice. It is imperative that we should be consulted over any particular use or application of our products and it is the responsability of the buyer to establish, particularly through all the appropriate tests, that the product is suitable for the use or application.Under no circumstances will our warranty apply, nor shall we be held responsible for any application (such as any modification, addition, deletion, use in conjunction with other electrical or electronic components, circuits or assemblies, or any other unsuitable material or substance) which has not been expressly agreed by us prior to the sale of our products.
Distributed by :
www.crouzet.com
Rf. 67 100 14 G (Published November 2003) - Communication Crouzet Automatismes - Dpot lgal en cours - Peillon & Associs - Photos : Ginko - Daniel Lattard
Customer Services Tel.: +33 475 802 102 Fax : +33 475 802 120 E-mail : infocom@crouzet.com